Burlington Coat Factory--Form 10-K
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM 10-K

 

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended January 28, 2012

OR

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from              to             

333-137916-110

(Commission File Number)

 

 

LOGO

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Delaware   20-4663833

(State or Other Jurisdiction of

Incorporation or Organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification No.)

1830 Route 130 North

Burlington, New Jersey

  08016
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)   (Zip Code)

(609) 387-7800

(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: None

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. *    Yes  ¨    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.    x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer   ¨    Accelerated filer   ¨
Non-Accelerated filer   x  (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)    Smaller reporting company   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x

The aggregate market value of the registrant’s voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant is zero. The registrant is a privately held corporation.

As of April 20, 2012, the registrant has 1,000 shares of common stock outstanding, all of which are owned by Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc., registrant’s parent holding company, and are not publicly traded.

 

* The Registrant has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, but is not required to file such reports under such sections.

 

 

Documents Incorporated By Reference

None

 

 

 


Table of Contents

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC.

INDEX TO REPORT ON FORM 10-K

FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED JANUARY 28, 2012

 

         PAGE  

PART I.

  

Item 1.

 

Business

     1   

Item 1A.

 

Risk Factors

     4   

Item 1B.

 

Unresolved Staff Comments

     11   

Item 2.

 

Properties

     11   

Item 3.

 

Legal Proceedings

     12   

Item 4.

 

Mine Safety Disclosures

     12   

PART II.

  

Item 5.

 

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

     12   

Item 6.

 

Selected Financial Data

     13   

Item 7.

 

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

     13   

Item 7A.

 

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

     50   

Item 8.

 

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

     52   

Item 9.

 

Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

     103   

Item 9A.

 

Controls and Procedures

     103   

Item 9B.

 

Other Information

     103   

PART III.

    

Item 10.

 

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

     104   

Item 11.

  Executive Compensation      106   

Item 12.

  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters      123   

Item 13.

  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence      126   

Item 14.

  Principal Accounting Fees and Services      129   

PART IV.

  

Item 15.

 

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

     129   

SIGNATURES

     134   

EXHIBIT INDEX

     135   


Table of Contents

PART I

 

Item 1. Business

Overview

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. (the Company or Holdings) owns Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation (BCFWC), which is a nationally recognized retailer of high-quality, branded apparel at everyday low prices. We opened our first store in Burlington, New Jersey in 1972, selling primarily coats and outerwear. Since then, and as of January 28, 2012, we have expanded our store base to 477 stores in 44 states and Puerto Rico and diversified our product categories by offering an extensive selection of in-season better and moderate brands, fashion-focused merchandise, including: ladies sportswear, menswear, coats, family footwear, baby furniture and accessories, as well as home decor and gifts. We continue to emphasize our rich heritage of coats and outerwear and we believe that we are viewed as the destination for coat shoppers. We acquire a broad selection of desirable, first-quality, branded merchandise primarily from nationally-recognized manufacturers and other suppliers. For the fiscal year ended January 28, 2012, we generated total revenue of $3,887.5 million, net sales of $3,854.1 million, a net loss of $6.3 million, and Adjusted EBITDA (as defined later in this Form 10-K) of $350.0 million.

As used in this Annual Report, the terms “Company,” “we,” “us,” or “our” refer to Holdings and all its subsidiaries. Holdings has no operations and its only asset is all of the stock of BCFWC. BCFWC was initially organized in 1972 as a New Jersey corporation. In 1983, BCFWC was reincorporated in Delaware and currently exists as a Delaware corporation. Holdings was organized in 2006 (and currently exists) as a Delaware corporation. BCFWC became a wholly-owned subsidiary of Holdings in connection with our acquisition on April 13, 2006 by affiliates of Bain Capital in a take private transaction (Merger Transaction). Holdings is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. (Parent).

Change in Fiscal Year End

In order to conform to the predominant fiscal calendar used within the retail industry, on February 25, 2010 our Board of Directors approved a change in our fiscal year from a fiscal year comprised of the twelve consecutive fiscal months ending on the Saturday closest to May 31 to a fiscal year comprised of the twelve consecutive fiscal months ending on the Saturday closest to January 31. This change commenced with the transition period beginning on May 31, 2009 and ending on January 30, 2010 (Transition Period). This Form 10-K is an annual report for the fiscal year ended January 28, 2012 (Fiscal 2011). The Company’s last three complete fiscal years prior to Fiscal 2011 ended on January 29, 2011 (Fiscal 2010), May 30, 2009 (Fiscal 2009), and May 31, 2008 (Fiscal 2008), and each of those years contained 52 weeks.

Debt Refinancing and Dividend

In the first quarter of Fiscal 2011, we completed the refinancing of our $900 million Senior Secured Term Loan (Previous Term Loan Facility), 11.1% Senior Notes (Previous Senior Notes), and 14.5% Senior Discount Notes (Previous Senior Discount Notes). As a result of these transactions, the Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes, with carrying values at February 24, 2011 of $302.0 million and $99.3 million, respectively, were repurchased. These debt instruments were replaced when BCFWC completed the sale of $450 million aggregate principal amount of 10% Senior Notes due 2019 (Notes) at an issue price of 100%. The Previous Term Loan Facility with a carrying value of $777.6 million at February 24, 2011 was replaced with a $1,000.0 million senior secured term loan facility (New Term Loan Facility) under which we borrowed net proceeds of $990.0 million. Borrowings on our $600 million Available Business Line Senior Secured Revolving Facility (ABL Line of Credit) related to these refinancing transactions were $101.6 million. On September 2, 2011, we completed an amendment and restatement of the credit agreement governing the ABL Line of Credit, which, among other things, extended the maturity date to September 2, 2016.

BCFWC, exclusive of subsidiaries (referred to herein as “BCFW”), used the net proceeds from the offering of the Notes, together with borrowings under the New Term Loan Facility and the ABL Line of Credit, to (i) repurchase any and all of the outstanding Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes, pursuant to cash tender offers commenced by BCFW and the Company on February 9, 2011, and to redeem any Previous Notes that remained outstanding after the completion of the cash tender offers, and pay related fees and expenses, including tender or redemption premiums and accrued interest on the Previous Notes, (ii) to repay the indebtedness under the Previous Term Loan Facility and (iii) to pay a special cash dividend of approximately $300.0 million in the aggregate to the equity holders of the Parent on a pro rata basis, and to pay related fees and expenses.

In connection with the issuance of the Notes, on February 24, 2011, BCFW entered into a registration rights agreement relating to the Notes, pursuant to which BCFW agreed to use its reasonable best efforts to file, and did initially file on July 15, 2011, a registration statement with the SEC (as amended, the “Exchange Offer Registration Statement”), enabling holders to exchange the Notes for registered notes with terms substantially identical in all material respects to the Notes, except the exchange notes would be freely tradable. On October 19, 2011, the Exchange Offer Registration Statement was declared effective by the SEC, and we completed the exchange offer on December 2, 2011.

 

1


Table of Contents

The Stores

As of January 28, 2012, we operated 477 stores under the names: “Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse” (461 stores), “MJM Designer Shoes” (13 stores), “Cohoes Fashions” (two stores), and “Super Baby Depot” (one store). Our store base is geographically diversified with stores located in 44 states and Puerto Rico. We believe that our customers are attracted to our stores principally by the availability of a large assortment of first-quality current brand-name merchandise at everyday low prices.

Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse stores (BCF stores) offer customers a complete line of value-priced apparel, including: ladies sportswear, menswear, coats, and family footwear, as well as baby furniture, accessories, home decor and gifts. We continue to emphasize our rich heritage of coats and outerwear and we believe that we are viewed as the destination for coat shoppers. BCF’s broad selection provides a wide range of apparel, accessories and furnishing for all ages. We purchase both pre-season and in-season merchandise, allowing us to respond timely to changing market conditions and consumer fashion preferences. Furthermore, we believe BCF stores’ substantial selection of staple, destination products such as coats and products in our Baby Depot departments, as well as men’s and boys’ suits, attracts customers from beyond our local trade areas. These products drive incremental store-traffic and differentiate us from our competitors. Over 99% of our net sales are derived from our BCF stores.

We opened our first MJM Designer Shoe store in 2002. MJM Designer Shoe stores offer an extensive collection of men’s, women’s and children’s moderate-to higher-priced designer and fashion shoes, sandals, boots and sneakers. MJM Designer Shoe stores also carry accessories such as handbags, wallets, belts, socks, hosiery and novelty gifts. MJM Designer Shoes stores provide a superior shoe shopping experience for the value conscious consumer by offering a broad selection of quality goods at discounted prices in stores with a convenient self-service layout.

In some of our stores, we grant unaffiliated third parties the right to use designated store space solely for the purpose of selling such third parties’ goods, including items such as fragrances and jewelry (Leased Departments). During Fiscal 2011, our rental income from all such arrangements aggregated less than 1% of our total revenues. We do not own or have any rights to any trademarks, licenses or other intellectual property used in connection with the brands sold by such unaffiliated third parties.

We believe the size of our typical BCF store represents a competitive advantage. Most of our stores are approximately 80,000 square feet, occupying significantly more selling square footage than most off-price or specialty store competitors. Major landlords frequently seek us as a tenant because the appeal of our apparel merchandise profile attracts a desired customer base and because we can take on larger facilities than most of our competitors. In addition, we have built long-standing relationships with major shopping center developers. We continue to explore expansion opportunities both within our current market areas and in other regions.

We believe that our ability to find satisfactory locations for our stores is essential for the continued growth of our business. The opening of stores generally is contingent upon a number of factors including, but not limited to, the availability of desirable locations with suitable structures and the negotiation of acceptable lease terms. There can be no assurance, however, that we will be able to find suitable locations for new stores or that even if such locations are found and acceptable lease terms are obtained, we will be able to open the number of new stores presently planned.

Real Estate Strategy

As of January 28, 2012, we owned the land and/or buildings for 40 of our 477 stores. Generally, however, our policy has been to lease our stores with co-tenancy where we believe our stores will be most productive. Our large average store size (generally twice that of our off-price competitors) and ability to attract foot traffic enable us to secure lower rents. Most of our stores are located in malls, strip shopping centers, regional power centers or are freestanding.

Our lease model generally provides for a ten year initial term with a number of five year options thereafter. Typically, our lease strategy includes landlord allowances for leasehold improvements and tenant fixtures. We believe our lease model keeps us competitive with other retailers for desirable locations.

We have a proven track record of new store expansion. Our store base has grown from 13 stores in 1980 to 477 stores as of January 28, 2012. Assuming that appropriate locations are identified, we believe that we will be able to execute our growth strategy without significantly impacting our current stores. The table below shows our store openings and closings since the beginning of our fiscal year ended June 3, 2006.

 

2


Table of Contents

Fiscal Years

   2006     2007     2008     2009     35 weeks
ended
January 30,
2010
     2010     2011  

Stores (Beginning of Period)

     362        368        379        397        433         442        460   

Stores Opened

     12        19        20        37        9         25        20  

Stores Closed

     (6     (8     (2     (1     0         (7     (3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stores (End of Period)

     368        379     397        433        442         460        477  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

* Inclusive of three stores that closed because of hurricane damage, which reopened in 2007.

Distribution

We have two primary distribution centers that ship approximately 86% of merchandise units to our stores. The remaining 14% of merchandise units are drop shipped directly to our stores. The two distribution centers, located in Edgewater Park, New Jersey and San Bernardino, California, occupy an aggregate of 1,088,000 square feet and each includes processing and storage capacity. In addition to our two primary distribution facilities, we also operate distribution facilities in Burlington, New Jersey and Redlands, California. The Burlington, New Jersey facility is a 402,000 square foot facility being used for E-Commerce fulfillment, the processing and storage of goods received on hangers, and remote storage for our Edgewater Park, New Jersey distribution center. The product stored at this facility is processed and shipped through our Edgewater Park, New Jersey facility.

The Redlands, California facility, which we opened in August 2011, is a 295,000 square foot facility being used primarily as remote storage for our San Bernardino, California distribution center. The product stored at this facility is processed and shipped out of our San Bernardino, California distribution center.

 

Location

   Calendar
Year
Operational
  Size (sq.
feet)
   Leased
or
Owned

Edgewater Park, New Jersey

   2004   648,000    Owned

San Bernardino, California

   2006   440,000    Leased

Burlington, New Jersey

   1987*   402,000    Owned

Redlands, California

   2011   295,000    Leased

 

* Distribution activities in this warehouse ceased during the Transition Period. Our current use of this warehouse commenced in Fiscal 2011.

Customer Demographic

Our core customer is the 25–49 year-old woman. The core customer is educated, resides in mid- to large-sized metropolitan areas and has an annual household income of $35,000 to $65,000. This customer shops for herself, her family and her home. We appeal to value seeking and fashion conscious customers who are price-driven but enjoy the style and fit of high-quality, branded merchandise. These core customers are drawn to us not only by our value proposition, but also by our broad selection of styles, our brands and our highly appealing product selection for families.

Customer Service

We are committed to providing our customers with an enjoyable shopping experience and strive to make continuous efforts to improve customer service. In training our employees, our goal is to emphasize knowledgeable, friendly customer service and a sense of professional pride. We offer our customers special services to enhance the convenience of their shopping experience, such as professional tailors, a baby gift registry and layaways.

We have empowered our store teams to provide an outstanding customer experience for every customer in every store, every day. We have streamlined processes and will continue to strive to create opportunities for fast and effective customer interactions. Our stores must reflect clean, organized merchandise presentations that highlight the brands, value, and diversity of selection within our assortments.

 

3


Table of Contents

Marketing and Advertising

We use a variety of broad-based and targeted marketing and advertising strategies to efficiently deliver the right message to the targeted audience at the right time. These strategies include national television and local radio advertising, direct mail, email marketing and targeted digital and magazine advertisements. Broadcast communication and reach is balanced with relevant customer contacts to increase frequency of store visits.

Employees

As of January 28, 2012, we employed 28,729 people, including part-time and seasonal employees. Our staffing requirements fluctuate during the year as a result of the seasonality of our business. We hire additional employees and increase the hours of part-time employees during seasonal peak selling periods. As of January 28, 2012, employees at two of our stores were subject to collective bargaining agreements.

Competition

The retail business is highly competitive. Competitors include off-price retailers, department stores, mass merchants and specialty apparel stores. At various times throughout the year, traditional full-price department store chains and specialty shops offer brand-name merchandise at substantial markdowns, which can result in prices approximating those offered by us at our BCF stores.

Merchandise Vendors

We purchase merchandise from many suppliers, each of which accounted for less than 3% of our net purchases during Fiscal 2011. We have no long-term purchase commitments or arrangements with any of our suppliers, and believe that we are not dependent on any one supplier. We continue to have good working relationships with our suppliers.

Seasonality

Our business, like that of most retailers, is subject to seasonal influences, with the major portion of sales and income typically realized during the back-to-school and holiday seasons (September through January). Weather, however, continues to be an important contributing factor to the sale of our clothing. Generally, our sales are higher if the weather is cold during the Fall and warm during the early Spring.

Tradenames

We have tradename assets such as Burlington Coat Factory, Baby Depot, Luxury Linens and MJM Designs. We consider these tradenames and the accompanying name recognition to be valuable to our business. We believe that our rights to these properties are adequately protected. Our rights in these tradenames endure for as long as they are used.

AVAILABLE INFORMATION

Our website address is www.burlingtoncoatfactory.com. We will provide to any person, upon request, copies of our Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports, free of charge as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish it to, the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). Such requests should be made in writing to the attention of our Corporate Counsel at the following address: Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, 1830 Route 130 North, Burlington, New Jersey 08016.

 

Item 1A. Risk Factors

CAUTIONARY STATEMENT REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This report contains forward-looking statements that are based on current expectations, estimates, forecasts and projections about us, the industry in which we operate and other matters, as well as management’s beliefs and assumptions and other statements regarding matters that are not historical facts. These statements include, in particular, statements about our plans, strategies and prospects. For example, when we use words such as “projects,” “expects,” “anticipates,” “intends,” “plans,” “believes,” “seeks,” “estimates,” “should,” “would,” “could,” “will,” “opportunity,” “potential” or “may,” variations of such words or other words that convey uncertainty of future events or outcomes, we are making forward-looking statements within the

 

4


Table of Contents

meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933 (Securities Act) and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Exchange Act). Our forward-looking statements are subject to risks and uncertainties. Actual events or results may differ materially from the results anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of a variety of factors. While it is impossible to identify all such factors, factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those estimated by us include: competition in the retail industry, seasonality of our business, adverse weather conditions, changes in consumer preferences and consumer spending patterns, import risks, general economic conditions in the United States (U.S.) and in states where we conduct our business, our ability to implement our strategy, our substantial level of indebtedness and related debt-service obligations, restrictions imposed by covenants in our debt agreements, availability of adequate financing, our dependence on vendors for our merchandise, domestic events affecting the delivery of merchandise to our stores, existence of adverse litigation and risks, and each of the factors discussed in this Item 1A, Risk Factors as well as risks discussed elsewhere in this report.

Many of these factors are beyond our ability to predict or control. In addition, as a result of these and other factors, our past financial performance should not be relied on as an indication of future performance. The cautionary statements referred to in this section also should be considered in connection with any subsequent written or oral forward-looking statements that may be issued by us or persons acting on our behalf. We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required by law. In light of these risks and uncertainties, the forward-looking events and circumstances discussed in this report might not occur. Furthermore, we cannot guarantee future results, events, levels of activity, performance or achievements.

Set forth below are certain important risks and uncertainties that could adversely affect our results of operations or financial condition and cause our actual results to differ materially from those expressed in forward-looking statements made by us. Although we believe that we have identified and discussed below the key risk factors affecting our business, there may be additional risks and uncertainties that are not presently known or that are not currently believed to be significant that may adversely affect our performance or financial condition. More detailed information regarding certain risk factors described below is contained in other sections of this report.

Risks Related to Our Business

Our growth strategy includes the addition of a significant number of new stores each year. We may not be able to implement this strategy successfully, on a timely basis, or at all.

Our growth will largely depend on our ability to successfully open and operate new stores. We intend to continue to open new stores in future years, while remodeling a portion of our existing store base annually. The success of this strategy is dependent upon, among other things, the current retail environment, the identification of suitable markets and sites for store locations, the negotiation of acceptable lease terms, the hiring, training and retention of competent sales personnel, and the effective management of inventory to meet the needs of new and existing stores on a timely basis. Our proposed expansion also will place increased demands on our operational, managerial and administrative resources. These increased demands could cause us to operate our business less effectively, which in turn could cause deterioration in the financial performance of our existing stores. In addition, to the extent that our new store openings are in existing markets, we may experience reduced net sales volumes in existing stores in those markets. We expect to fund our expansion through cash flow from operations and, if necessary, by borrowings under our ABL Line of Credit; however, if we experience a decline in performance, we may slow or discontinue store openings. We may not be able to execute any of these strategies successfully, on a timely basis, or at all. If we fail to implement these strategies successfully, our financial condition and results of operations would be adversely affected.

If we are unable to renew or replace our store leases or enter into leases for new stores on favorable terms, or if one or more of our current leases are terminated prior to the expiration of their stated term and we cannot find suitable alternate locations, our growth and profitability could be negatively impacted.

We currently lease approximately 92% of our store locations. Most of our current leases expire at various dates after five or ten-year terms, the majority of which are subject to our option to renew such leases for several additional five-year periods. Our ability to renew any expiring lease or, if such lease cannot be renewed, our ability to lease a suitable alternative location, and our ability to enter into leases for new stores on favorable terms will depend on many factors which are not within our control, such as conditions in the local real estate market, competition for desirable properties and our relationships with current and prospective landlords. If we are unable to renew existing leases or lease suitable alternative locations, or enter into leases for new stores on favorable terms, our growth and our profitability may be negatively impacted.

Our net sales, operating income and inventory levels fluctuate on a seasonal basis and decreases in sales or margins during our peak seasons could have a disproportionate effect on our overall financial condition and results of operations.

Our net sales and operating income fluctuate seasonally, with a significant portion of our operating income typically realized during the five-month period from September through January. Any decrease in sales or margins during this period could have a disproportionate effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Seasonal fluctuations also affect our inventory levels. We must carry a significant amount of inventory, especially before the holiday season selling period. If we are not

 

5


Table of Contents

successful in selling our inventory, we may have to write down our inventory or sell it at significantly reduced prices or we may not be able to sell such inventory at all, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Fluctuations in comparative store sales and results of operations could cause our business performance to decline substantially.

Our results of operations for our individual stores have fluctuated in the past and can be expected to continue to fluctuate in the future. Since the beginning of the fiscal year ended May 29, 2005, our quarterly comparative store sales rates have ranged from 8.9% to negative 8.0%.

Our comparative store sales and results of operations are affected by a variety of factors, including:

 

   

fashion trends;

 

   

calendar shifts of holiday or seasonal periods;

 

   

the effectiveness of our inventory management;

 

   

changes in our merchandise mix;

 

   

weather patterns, including, among other things, changes in year-over-year temperatures;

 

   

availability of suitable real estate locations at desirable prices and our ability to locate them;

 

   

our ability to effectively manage pricing and markdowns;

 

   

changes in general economic conditions and consumer spending patterns;

 

   

our ability to anticipate, understand and meet consumer trends and preferences;

 

   

actions of competitors; and

 

   

the attractiveness of our inventory and stores to customers.

If our future comparative store sales fail to meet expectations, then our cash flow and profitability could decline substantially.

Because inventory is both fashion and season sensitive, extreme and/or unseasonable weather conditions could have a disproportionately large effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations because we would be forced to mark down inventory.

Extreme weather conditions in the areas in which our stores are located could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. For example, heavy snowfall or other extreme weather conditions over a prolonged period might make it difficult for our customers to travel to our stores. In addition, natural disasters such as hurricanes, tornados and earthquakes, or a combination of these or other factors, could severely damage or destroy one or more of our stores or facilities located in the affected areas, thereby disrupting our business operations. Our business is also susceptible to unseasonable weather conditions. For example, extended periods of unseasonably warm temperatures during the fall or winter season or cool weather during the spring or summer season could render a portion of our inventory incompatible with those unseasonable conditions. These prolonged unseasonable weather conditions could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Historically, a majority of our net sales have occurred during the five-month period from September through January. Unseasonably warm weather during these months could adversely affect our business.

We do not have long-term contracts with any of our vendors and if we are unable to purchase suitable merchandise in sufficient quantities at competitive prices, we may be unable to offer a merchandise mix that is attractive to our customers and our sales may be harmed.

The products that we offer are manufactured by third party vendors. Many of our key vendors limit the number of retail channels they use to sell their merchandise resulting in intense competition among retailers to obtain and sell these goods. In addition, nearly all of the brands of our top vendors are sold by competing retailers and some of our top vendors also have their own dedicated retail stores. Moreover, we typically buy products from our vendors on a purchase order basis. We have no long

 

6


Table of Contents

term purchase contracts with any of our vendors and, therefore, have no contractual assurances of continued supply, pricing or access to products, and any vendor could change the terms upon which they sell to us or discontinue selling to us at any time. If our relationships with our vendors are disrupted, we may not be able to acquire the merchandise we require in sufficient quantities or on terms acceptable to us. Any inability to acquire suitable merchandise would have a negative effect on our business and operating results because we would be missing products from our merchandise mix unless and until alternative supply arrangements were made, resulting in deferred or lost sales.

Our results may be adversely affected by fluctuations in energy prices

Increases in energy costs may result in an increase in our transportation costs for distribution, utility costs for our stores and costs to purchase our products from suppliers, as well as reducing the amount of disposable income available to customers and curtailing the use of automobiles and thereby reducing traffic to our stores. A sustained rise in energy costs could adversely affect consumer spending and demand for our products and increase our operating costs, both of which could have an adverse effect on our performance.

General economic conditions and competition affect our business.

Consumer spending habits, including spending for the merchandise that we sell, are affected by, among other things, prevailing economic conditions, inflation, levels of employment, salaries and wage rates, prevailing interest rates, housing costs, energy costs, commodities pricing, income tax rates and policies, consumer confidence and consumer perception of economic conditions. In addition, consumer purchasing patterns may be influenced by consumers’ disposable income, credit availability and debt levels. A continued or incremental slowdown in the U.S. economy, an uncertain economic outlook or an expanded credit crisis could continue to adversely affect consumer spending habits resulting in lower net sales and profits than expected on a quarterly or annual basis. Consumer confidence is also affected by the domestic and international political situation. Our financial condition and operations could be impacted by changes in government regulations such as taxes, healthcare reform, and other areas. The outbreak or escalation of war, or the occurrence of terrorist acts or other hostilities in or affecting the U.S., could lead to a decrease in spending by consumers. In addition, natural disasters, industrial accidents and acts of war in various parts of the world could have the effect of disrupting supplies and raising prices globally which, in turn, may have adverse effects on the world and U.S. economies and lead to a downturn in consumer confidence and spending.

Retailing is highly competitive, and retailers are constantly adjusting their promotional activity and pricing strategies in response to changing conditions. In order to increase traffic and drive consumer spending in the economic environment of the past several years, competitors, including department stores, mass merchants and specialty apparel stores, have been offering brand-name merchandise at substantial markdowns. Moreover, one national mid-market department store chain has recently announced a new business strategy which entails offering branded goods on a larger scale and a departure from in-house brands, coupled with offering products at everyday, regular prices set at up to 40% below traditional department store prices and limited promotional activity. This will result in more competition for branded goods as well as more price competition. If we are unable to continue to meet changes in the competitive environment and to positively differentiate ourselves from our competitors, our results of operations could be adversely affected.

Parties with whom we do business may be subject to insolvency risks which could negatively impact our liquidity.

Many economic and other factors are outside of our control, including but not limited to commercial credit availability. Also affected are our vendors who, in many cases depend upon commercial credit to finance their operations. If they are unable to secure commercial financing, our vendors could seek to change the terms on which they sell to us, which could negatively affect our liquidity. In addition, the inability of vendors to access liquidity, or the insolvency of vendors, could lead to their failure to deliver merchandise to us.

Although we purchase most of our inventory from vendors domestically, apparel production is located primarily overseas.

Factors which affect overseas production could affect our suppliers and vendors and, in turn, our ability to obtain inventory and the price levels at which they may be obtained. Although such factors apply equally to our competitors, factors that cause an increase in merchandise costs or a decrease in supply could lead to generally lower sales and gross margins in the retail industry.

Such factors include:

 

   

political or labor instability in countries where suppliers are located or at foreign and domestic ports which could result in lengthy shipment delays, which if timed ahead of the Fall and Winter peak selling periods could materially and adversely affect our ability to stock inventory on a timely basis;

 

7


Table of Contents
   

political or military conflict involving the apparel producing countries, which could cause a delay in the transportation of our products to us and an increase in transportation costs;

 

   

heightened terrorism security concerns, which could subject imported goods to additional, more frequent or more thorough inspections, leading to delays in deliveries or impoundment of goods for extended periods;

 

   

disease epidemics and health related concerns, such as the outbreaks of SARS, bird flu, swine flu and other diseases, which could result in closed factories, reduced workforces, scarcity of raw materials and scrutiny or embargoing of goods produced in infected areas;

 

   

natural disasters and industrial accidents, which could have the effect of curtailing production and disrupting supplies;

 

   

increases in labor and production costs in goods-producing countries, which would result in an increase in our inventory costs;

 

   

the migration and development of manufacturers, which can affect where our products are or will be produced;

 

   

fluctuation in our suppliers’ local currency against the dollar, which may increase our cost of goods sold; and

 

   

changes in import duties, taxes, charges, quotas, loss of “most favored nation” trading status with the United States for a particular foreign country and trade restrictions (including the United States imposing antidumping or countervailing duty orders, safeguards, remedies or compensation and retaliation due to illegal foreign trade practices).

Any of the foregoing factors, or a combination thereof could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Our business would be disrupted severely if either of our primary distribution centers were to shut down.

During Fiscal 2011, central distribution services were extended to approximately 86% of our merchandise units through our distribution facilities. Our two primary distribution centers are currently located in Edgewater Park, New Jersey and San Bernardino, California. Most of the merchandise we purchase is shipped directly to our distribution centers, where it is prepared for shipment to the appropriate stores. If either of our current primary distribution centers were to shut down or lose significant capacity for any reason, our operations would likely be disrupted. Although in such circumstances our stores are capable of receiving inventory directly from suppliers via drop shipment, we would incur significantly higher costs and a reduced ability to control inventory levels during the time it takes for us to reopen or replace either of our primary distribution centers.

Software used for our management information systems may become obsolete or conflict with the requirements of newer hardware and may cause disruptions in our business.

We rely on our existing management information systems, including some software programs that were developed in-house by our employees, in operating and monitoring all major aspects of our business, including sales, distribution, purchasing, inventory control, merchandising planning and replenishment, as well as various financial systems. If we fail to update such software to meet the demands of changing business requirements or if we decide to modify or change our hardware and/or operating systems and the software programs that were developed in-house are not compatible with the new hardware or operating systems, disruption to our business may result.

Unauthorized disclosure of sensitive or confidential information, whether through a breach of our computer system or otherwise, could severely hurt our business.

As part of our normal course of business we collect, process and retain sensitive and confidential information in accordance with industry standards. Despite the security measures we have in place, our facilities and systems, and those of our third party service providers may be vulnerable to security breaches, acts of vandalism and theft, computer viruses, misplaced or lost data, programming and/or human errors, or other similar events. Any security breach involving misappropriation, loss or other unauthorized disclosure of confidential information, whether by us or our vendors, could severely damage our reputation, expose us to litigation and liability risks, disrupt our operations and harm our business.

 

8


Table of Contents

Disruptions in our information systems could adversely affect our operating results.

The efficient operation of our business is dependent on our information systems. If an act of God or other event caused our information systems to not function properly, major business disruptions could occur. In particular, we rely on our information systems to effectively manage sales, distribution, merchandise planning and allocation functions. Our disaster recovery site is located within 15 miles of our Burlington, New Jersey headquarters. If a disaster impacts either location, while it most likely would not fully incapacitate us, our operations could be significantly affected. The failure of our information systems to perform as designed could disrupt our business and harm sales and profitability.

Changes in product safety laws may adversely impact our operations.

We are subject to regulations by a variety of state and federal regulatory authorities, including the Consumer Product Safety Commission. The Consumer Product Safety Improvement Act of 2008 (CPSIA) imposes new limitations on the permissible amounts of lead and phthalates allowed in children’s products. These regulations relate principally to product labeling, licensing requirements, flammability testing, and product safety particularly with respect to products used by children. In the event that we are unable to timely comply with regulatory changes, including those pursuant to the CPSIA, significant fines or penalties could result, and could adversely affect our operations.

Our future growth and profitability could be adversely affected if our advertising and marketing programs are not effective in generating sufficient levels of customer awareness and traffic.

We rely on print and television advertising to increase consumer awareness of our product offerings and pricing to drive store traffic. In addition, we rely and will increasingly rely on other forms of media advertising, including, without limitation, social media and e-marketing. Our future growth and profitability will depend in large part upon the effectiveness and efficiency of our advertising and marketing programs. In order for our advertising and marketing programs to be successful, we must:

 

   

manage advertising and marketing costs effectively in order to maintain acceptable operating margins and return on our marketing investment; and

 

   

convert customer awareness into actual store visits and product purchases.

Our planned advertising and marketing expenditures may not result in increased total or comparative net sales or generate sufficient levels of product awareness. Further, we may not be able to manage our advertising and marketing expenditures on a cost-effective basis. Additionally, some of our competitors may have substantially larger marketing budgets, which may provide them with a competitive advantage.

Use of social media may adversely impact our reputation or subject us to fines or other penalties.

There has been a substantial increase in the use of social media platforms and similar devices, including blogs, social media websites, and other forms of Internet-based communications, which allow individuals access to a broad audience of consumers and other interested persons. As laws and regulations rapidly evolve to govern the use of these platforms and devices, the failure by us, our employees or third parties acting at our direction to abide by applicable laws and regulations in the use of theses platforms and devices could adversely impact our reputation or subject us to fines or other penalties.

Consumers value readily available information concerning retailers and their goods and services and often act on such information without further investigation and without regard to its accuracy. Information concerning us may be posted on such platforms and devices at any time and may be adverse to our reputation or business. The harm may be immediate without affording us an opportunity for redress or correction.

The loss of key personnel may disrupt our business and adversely affect our financial results.

We depend on the contributions of key personnel for our future success. Although we have entered into employment agreements with certain executives, we may not be able to retain all of our executive and key employees. These executives and other key employees may be hired by our competitors, some of which have considerably more financial resources than we do. The loss of key personnel, or the inability to hire and retain qualified employees, could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The interests of our controlling stockholders may conflict with the interests of our noteholders or us.

As of March 31, 2012, funds associated with Bain Capital owned approximately 96.9% of the common stock of Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. (Parent), with the remainder held by existing and former members of management. Additionally, management held options to purchase 8.3% of the outstanding shares of Parent’s common stock as of January 28, 2012. Our controlling stockholders may have an incentive to increase the value of their investment or cause us to distribute funds at the expense of our financial condition and impact our ability to make payments on our outstanding notes. In addition, funds associated with Bain Capital have the power to elect a majority of our board of directors and appoint new officers and management and, therefore, effectively control many major decisions regarding our operations.

 

9


Table of Contents

For further information regarding the ownership interest of, and related party transactions involving, Bain Capital and its associated funds, please see Item 12, Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters, and Item 13, Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence.

Changes in legal and accounting rules and regulations may adversely affect our results of operations.

We are subject to numerous legal and accounting requirements. New accounting rules or regulations and varying interpretations of existing accounting rules or regulations have occurred and may occur in the future, including those related to the convergence of GAAP and IFRS. For example, accounting regulatory authorities have indicated that they may begin to require lessees to capitalize operating leases in their financial statements in future periods. If adopted, such a change would require us to record a significant amount of lease related assets and liabilities on our balance sheet and make other changes related to the recording and classification of lease related expenses on our statement of operations and cash flows. Future changes to accounting rules or regulations and failure to comply with laws and regulations could adversely affect our operations and financial results, involve significant expense and divert management’s attention and resources from other matters, which in turn could impact our business.

Risk Factors Related to Our Substantial Indebtedness

Our substantial indebtedness requires a significant amount of cash. Our ability to generate sufficient cash depends on numerous factors beyond our control, and we may be unable to generate sufficient cash flow to service our debt obligations, including making payments on our outstanding notes.

As of January 28, 2012, our total indebtedness was $1,613.1 million, including $450.0 million of 10.0% senior notes due 2019, $949.1 million under our New Term Loan Facility, and $190.0 million under the ABL Line of Credit. Estimated cash required to make minimum debt service payments (including principal and interest) for these debt obligations amounts to $111.5 million for the fiscal year ending February 2, 2013, exclusive of minimum interest payments related to the ABL Line of Credit. The ABL Line of Credit agreement has no annual minimum principal payment requirements.

Our ability to make payments on and to refinance our debt and to fund planned capital expenditures will depend on our ability to generate cash in the future, which is to some extent, subject to general economic, financial, competitive, legislative, regulatory and other factors that are beyond our control. If we are unable to generate sufficient cash flow to service our debt and meet our other commitments, we will be required to adopt one or more alternatives, such as refinancing all or a portion of our debt, including the notes, selling material assets or operations or raising additional debt or equity capital. We may not be able to successfully carry out any of these actions on a timely basis, on commercially reasonable terms or at all, or be assured that these actions would be sufficient to meet our capital requirements. In addition, the terms of our existing or future debt agreements, including the credit agreements governing our senior secured credit facilities and the indenture governing the notes, may restrict us from affecting any of these alternatives.

If we fail to make scheduled payments on our debt or otherwise fail to comply with our covenants, we would be in default and, as a result:

 

   

our debt holders could declare all outstanding principal and interest to be due and payable,

 

   

our secured debt lenders could terminate their commitments and commence foreclosure proceedings against our assets, and

 

   

we could be forced into bankruptcy or liquidation.

The indenture governing our senior notes and the credit agreements governing our senior secured credit facilities impose significant operating and financial restrictions on us and our subsidiaries, which may prevent us from capitalizing on business opportunities.

The indenture governing our senior notes and the credit agreements governing our senior secured credit facilities contain covenants that place significant operating and financial restrictions on us. These covenants limit our ability to, among other things:

 

   

incur additional indebtedness or enter into sale and leaseback obligations;

 

   

pay certain dividends or make certain distributions on capital stock or repurchase capital stock;

 

10


Table of Contents
   

make certain capital expenditures;

 

   

make certain investments or other restricted payments;

 

   

have our subsidiaries pay dividends or make other payments to us;

 

   

engage in certain transactions with stockholders or affiliates;

 

   

sell certain assets or merge with or into other companies;

 

   

guarantee indebtedness; and

 

   

create liens.

As a result of these covenants, we are limited in how we conduct our business and we may be unable to raise additional debt or equity financing to compete effectively or to take advantage of new business opportunities. The terms of any future indebtedness we may incur could include more restrictive covenants. If we fail to maintain compliance with these covenants in the future, we may not be able to obtain waivers from the lenders and/or amend the covenants.

Our failure to comply with the restrictive covenants described above, as well as others that may be contained in the indenture governing our senior notes and the credit agreements governing our senior secured credit facilities, could result in an event of default, which, if not cured or waived, could result in us being required to repay these borrowings before their due date. If we are unable to refinance these borrowings or are forced to refinance these borrowings on less favorable terms, our results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected.

Our failure to comply with the agreements relating to our outstanding indebtedness, including as a result of events beyond our control, could result in an event of default that could materially and adversely affect our results of operations and our financial condition.

If there were an event of default under any of the agreements relating to our outstanding indebtedness, the holders of the defaulted debt could cause all amounts outstanding, with respect to that debt, to be due and payable immediately. Our assets or cash flow may not be sufficient to fully repay borrowings under our outstanding debt instruments if accelerated upon an event of default. Further, if we are unable to repay, refinance or restructure our secured indebtedness, the holders of such debt could proceed against the collateral securing that indebtedness. In addition, any event of default or declaration of acceleration under one debt instrument could also result in an event of default under one or more of our other debt instruments.

 

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

 

Item 2. Properties

As of January 28, 2012, we operated 477 stores in 44 states throughout the U.S. and Puerto Rico. We own the land and/or building for 40 of our stores and lease the other 437 stores. Store leases generally provide for fixed monthly rental payments, plus the payment, in most cases, of real estate taxes and other charges with escalation clauses. In many locations, our store leases contain formulas providing for the payment of additional rent based on sales.

We own three buildings in Burlington, New Jersey and approximately 47 acres of land on which we have constructed our 402,000 square foot corporate headquarters and distribution facility. In addition, we own approximately 50 acres of undeveloped land in Florence, New Jersey. We also own approximately 43 acres of land in Edgewater Park, New Jersey on which we have constructed a distribution center and office facility of approximately 648,000 square feet. We lease a 440,000 square foot distribution facility in San Bernardino, California and a 295,000 square foot distribution facility in Redlands, California. We also lease approximately 35,000 square feet of office space in New York City.

The following table identifies the years in which store leases, existing at January 28, 2012, expire, (exclusive of distribution and corporate leased location), showing both expiring leases for which we have no renewal options available and expiring leases for which we have renewal options available. For purposes of this table, only the expiration dates of the current lease term (exclusive of any available options) are identified. Historically, we have been able to renew a large number of our expiring leases each year.

 

11


Table of Contents

Fiscal Years Ending

   Number of Leases
Expiring with No
Additional
Renewal Options
     Number of Leases
Expiring with
Additional

Renewal Options
 

2012-2013

     8         47   

2014-2015

     15         124   

2016-2017

     10         91   

2018-2019

     4         64   

2020-2021

     5         35   

Thereafter to 2038

     11         25   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     53         386   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

Item 3. Legal Proceedings

We are party to various litigation matters, in most cases involving ordinary and routine claims incidental to our business. We cannot estimate with certainty our ultimate legal and financial liability with respect to such pending litigation matters. However, we believe, based on our examination of such matters, that our ultimate liability will not have a material effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

 

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

PART II

 

Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

No established trading market currently exists for our common stock. As of March 31, 2012, Parent is the only holder of record of our common stock and 96.9% of Parent’s common stock is held by various Bain Capital funds. Payment of dividends is prohibited under our credit agreements, except for certain limited circumstances. Dividends equal to $297.9 million were paid in accordance with our credit agreements during Fiscal 2011 in conjunction with the refinancing of our debt, as further described in Note 10 to our Consolidated Financial Statements, entitled “Long-Term Debt.” Dividends of $0.3 million, $0.2 million and $3.0 million were paid in accordance with our credit agreements during Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively, to Parent in order to repurchase capital stock of the Parent.

 

12


Table of Contents
Item 6. Selected Financial Data

The following table presents selected historical Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income, Balance Sheets and other data for the periods presented and should only be read in conjunction with our audited Consolidated Financial Statements (and the related notes thereto) and Item 7, Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, each of which are included elsewhere in this Form 10-K. The historical financial data for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period, and the fiscal years ended May 30, 2009, May 31, 2008 and June 2, 2007 (Fiscal 2007) have been derived from our historical audited Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

$0,000.0 $0,000.0 $0,000.0 $0,000.0 $0,000.0 $0,000.0
      (in millions)  
     Twelve
Months
Ended
6/2/07
    Twelve
Months
Ended
5/31/08
    Twelve
Months
Ended
5/30/09
    Transition
Period
from
5/31/09 to
1/30/10
    Twelve
Months

Ended
1/29/2011
    Twelve
Months
Ended
1/28/2012
 

Revenues

   $ 3,441.6      $ 3,424.0      $ 3,571.4      $ 2,479.3      $ 3,701.1      $ 3,887.5   

Net (Loss) Income

     (47.2 )(1)      (49.0 )(1)      (191.6 )(1)      18.7 (1)      31.0 (1)      (6.3 )(2) 

Total Comprehensive (Loss) Income

     (47.2     (49.0     (191.6     18.7        31.0        (6.3

 

$0,000.0 $0,000.0 $0,000.0 $0,000.0 $0,000.0 $0,000.0
     As of
6/2/07
    As of
5/31/08
    As of
5/30/09
    As of
1/30/10
    As of
1/29/11
    As of
1/28/12
 

Balance Sheet Data

            

Total Assets

   $ 3,036.5         $ 2,964.5         $ 2,533.4         $ 2,394.0         $ 2,458.0         $ 2,501.1      

Working Capital

     280.6        284.4        312.3        349.7        386.2        337.9   

Long-Term Debt

     1,456.3        1,480.2        1,438.8        1,399.2        1,358.0        1,605.5   

Stockholder’s Equity (Deficit)

     380.5        323.5        135.1        154.5        187.5        (110.9

Notes:

 

(1) Net (Loss) Income during Fiscal 2007, Fiscal 2008, Fiscal 2009, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2010 reflect impairment charges of $24.4 million, $25.3 million, $332.0 million, $46.8 million and $2.1 million, respectively. The impairment charges in Fiscal 2007, Fiscal 2008, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2010 relate entirely to our long-lived assets while the impairment charge in Fiscal 2009 relates to both our tradenames and our long-lived assets (refer to Note 6 entitled “Intangible Assets” and Note 8 entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” to our Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion regarding our impairment charges).
(2) Net Loss during Fiscal 2011 reflects charges related to the loss on extinguishment of debt of $37.8 million and impairment charges of $1.7 million. The loss on extinguishment of debt is related to the refinancing of our Previous Term Loan Facility, Previous Senior Notes, and Previous Senior Discount Notes (refer to Note 10 entitled “Long-Term Debt” to our Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion). The impairment charges relate entirely to our long-lived assets (refer to Note 8 entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” to our Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion regarding our impairment charges).

 

Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

For purposes of the following “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” unless indicated otherwise or the context requires, “we,” “us,” “our,” and “Company” refers to the operations of

 

13


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and its consolidated subsidiaries, and the financial statements of Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries. With the exception of the 35 week period ended January 30, 2010, we maintain our records on the basis of a 52 or 53 week fiscal year ending on the Saturday closest to January 31. The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with the “Selected Financial Data” and our Consolidated Financial Statements, including the notes thereto, appearing elsewhere herein.

In addition to historical information, this discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements based on current expectations that involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions, such as our plans, objectives, expectations, and intentions set forth under the caption entitled “Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements,” which can be found in Item 1A, Risk Factors. Our actual results and the timing of events may differ materially from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of various factors, including those set forth in the Item 1A, Risk Factors and elsewhere in this report.

General

We are a nationally recognized retailer of high-quality, branded apparel at everyday low prices. We opened our first store in Burlington, New Jersey in 1972, selling primarily coats and outerwear. Since then, we have expanded our store base to 477 stores in 44 states and Puerto Rico, and diversified our product categories by offering an extensive selection of in-season, fashion-focused merchandise, including: ladies sportswear, menswear, coats, family footwear, baby furniture and accessories, as well as home decor and gifts. We acquire a broad selection of desirable, first-quality, current-brand, labeled merchandise directly from nationally-recognized manufacturers and other suppliers.

As of January 28, 2012, we operated 477 stores under the names “Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse” (461 stores), “MJM Designer Shoes” (13 stores), “Cohoes Fashions” (two stores), and “Super Baby Depot” (one store) in 44 states and Puerto Rico. For Fiscal 2011, we generated total revenues of approximately $3,887.5 million.

Executive Summary

Overview of Fiscal 2011 Operating Results

We experienced an increase in net sales for Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010. Consolidated net sales increased $184.5 million, or 5.0%, to $3,854.1 million for Fiscal 2011 from $3,669.6 million for Fiscal 2010. This increase was primarily attributable to an increase in net sales from new stores and previously opened stores in non comparative sales periods (non comparative stores) of $167.3 million. Comparative store sales increased 0.7% during the year. We believe that the comparative store sales increase was primarily due to our improved merchandise content and customer experience initiatives. The progress made from these initiatives continues to be positive even though many of our regions experienced unseasonably warm temperatures during the holiday selling period (refer to section below entitled “Performance for the Fiscal Year Ended January 28, 2012 Compared With the Fiscal Year Ended January 29, 2011” for further explanation).

Gross margin as a percentage of net sales increased slightly from 38.6% during Fiscal 2010 to 38.7% during Fiscal 2011. The improvement in gross margin as a percentage of net sales was due to improvements in shrinkage rates, and fewer markdowns, partially offset by increased initial markups.

Selling and administrative expenses as a percentage of net sales during Fiscal 2011 remained in line with Fiscal 2010 at 31.5% for both periods. Total selling and administrative expenses increased $58.7 million from $1,156.6 million during Fiscal 2010 to $1,215.3 million, during Fiscal 2011, which includes the opening of 17 net new stores during Fiscal 2011. The increase in selling and administrative expenses during Fiscal 2011 was primarily due to increases in payroll and payroll related and occupancy expenses due to new stores opened during the year and stores that were opened in the prior year, but did not operate for a full 12 months.

We recorded a net loss of $6.3 million for Fiscal 2011 compared with net income of $31.0 million for Fiscal 2010. The loss recorded during Fiscal 2011 was primarily driven by our debt refinancing in February 2011 which resulted in a $37.8 million loss on extinguishment of debt as well as increased interest expense.

Store Openings, Closings, and Relocations

During Fiscal 2011, we opened 20 new BCF stores and closed one BCF store, one MJM store and one Super Baby Depot. The MJM store and the Super Baby Depot were in the same shopping center as an existing BCF store, which was expanded and remodeled to absorb both businesses. As of January 28, 2012, we operated 477 stores under the names “Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse” (461 stores), “Cohoes Fashions” (two stores), “MJM Designer Shoes” (13 stores) and “Super Baby Depot” (one store).

We continue to pursue our growth plans and invest in capital projects that meet our required financial thresholds. During the fiscal year ending February 2, 2013 (Fiscal 2012), we plan to open between 17 and 25 new stores (exclusive of three relocations).

 

14


Table of Contents

Ongoing Initiatives for Fiscal 2012

We continue to focus on a number of ongoing initiatives aimed at increasing our overall profitability by improving our comparative store sales trends, total sales growth and reducing expenses. These initiatives include, but are not limited to:

 

  I. Continuing to offer a Leading Selection of Branded Apparel at Every Day Low Prices (EDLP): We offer broad product assortments to provide our customers with a wider selection and variety of branded products and categories than that of our off-price competitors. Our selection of youth apparel, including special occasion clothing, as well as our baby clothing, furniture and care items are key offering differentiators from department stores’ selections. In contrast to merchandise at most department and specialty stores, our merchandise is offered at EDLP, allowing customers to obtain the best value at our stores without waiting for sales or promotions. We focus on delivering exceptional values that fit within a good, better and best pricing strategy.

 

  II. Continuing to Execute Our Open to Buy Model and Improve Merchandising: Our “open to buy” paradigm, in which we purchase both pre-season and in-season merchandise, improves our receipt-to-reduction ratio and enables more flexibility for buying “wear-now” products. Our receipt-to-reduction ratio matches forecasted levels of receipts to forecasted inventory outflows (inclusive of sales, markdowns, and inventory shrinkage) on a monthly basis. Our buying model continues to be focused on purchasing less pre-season, with the majority in-season and opportunistically. Less pre-season purchasing allows us to buy more in-season product to capitalize on strong performing categories and businesses as well as to take full advantage of the current levels of highly desirable opportunistic product in the marketplace. We are also able to better appeal to our core female customer by improving product freshness and broadening brand assortments.

 

  III. Continuing to Improve Our Store Experience Through the Eyes of the Customer: We have empowered our store teams to provide an outstanding customer experience for every customer in every store, every day. We will continue to streamline processes to create opportunities for fast and effective customer interactions wherever possible. Our mission is to have stores that reflect clean, organized merchandise presentations that highlight the brands, value and diversity of our selection within our assortments.

We plan to continue execution of this initiative throughout Fiscal 2012 by:

 

  a) Continuing with our in-store customer satisfaction program that measures 13 different aspects of customer satisfaction. Examples include: friendliness of associates, interior cleanliness and selection of merchandise;

 

  b) Continuing the implementation of a store refresh program with respect to stores that we have identified as having certain needs such as new flooring, painting, fitting room improvements and various other improvements. We expect to continue an aggressive refresh program going forward;

 

  c) Continuing to train, develop and recognize our store employees so that they can continue to provide an outstanding customer experience. Our goal is to provide an outstanding customer experience to every customer in every store, every time they enter the store. We expect to accomplish this through enhanced training and education programs, the continuing evolution of our Manager on Duty program and our enhanced associate and store recognition programs. Through these, and other directives, we expect to keep our store managers and store associates focused on core behaviors that will enhance the customer experience and ultimately drive sales; and

 

  d) Continuing to improve our execution within the stores in order to get goods to the floor more quickly in a manner that makes it easier for the customer to find what they are looking for and to improve the efficiency at checkout. We plan to accomplish this through:

 

   

enhancing our store receiving procedures so we can get goods from the loading dock to the floor in a more timely manner;

 

   

enhancing our sizing initiatives to make it easier for customers to find the size of the goods they are looking for and

 

15


Table of Contents
   

enhancing and expanding our queuing project in which customers check out through one line where the next available register checks out the next customer in the line, ultimately improving the speed at which customers can get through the checkout process as well as driving incremental sales related to impulse buys while customers are in the que.

 

  IV. Continuing to Focus on Improving our Customer Loyalty: We continue to focus on enhancing our relationship with our current customer base with the goal of increasing the frequency with which they shop our stores as well as the amount of merchandise they buy during those visits. We intend to accomplish this through:

 

  a) Continuing our improvement in the store experience, as previously described;

 

  b) Continuing to enhance the targeting of our message to our customers. We are developing more tactical ways to better communicate with our customers, both nationally and locally. By tightening the targeting of our message to our customer base and localizing it to the specific markets with which are stores are located, we believe we can capitalize on our advertising dollars and further drive sales.

 

  V. Continuing to Deliver Consistent Gross Margin: We continue to focus on having stable merchandise gross margin as a percentage of net sales.

We plan to continue execution of this initiative by:

 

  a) Continuing the implementation of new software applications which will provide for enhanced functionality during Fiscal 2012 and beyond including:

 

   

refined allocation of goods;

 

   

markdown optimization; and

 

   

more efficient planning and forecasting tools.

The foundation of these systems and the new planning tools were completed during Fiscal 2011. The enhanced functionality related to allocation of goods and markdown optimization are planned to be fully implemented during Fiscal 2012 and Fiscal 2013;

 

  b) Continuing to manage our inventory receipt to reduction ratio. By matching receipt dollars to sales and markdown dollars we believe we will continue to maintain liquidity and will be able to take advantage of in season buying opportunities and to capitalize on those businesses that are trending well;

 

  c) Continuing to ensure adequate open to buy and buying more opportunistically in season. By staying liquid, we believe we will put ourselves in a position to be able to take advantage of opportunistic in-season buys that will maximize our sales;

 

  d) Continuing to improve the amount of current inventory as a percentage of our total inventory. By having more current inventory in our merchandise mix, we believe we will be afforded more pricing flexibility to provide additional value to our customers without reducing our overall merchandise margins; and

 

  e) Reducing our shrink as a percentage of net sales. During Fiscal 2011 we added additional resources to help improve existing controls and processes to reduce our shrink as a percentage of net sales without negatively impacting the store experience. We expect to continue to see improved results from this initiative during Fiscal 2012.

 

16


Table of Contents
  VI. Continuing to Improve Upon Operating Efficiencies:

 

  a) Improve store efficiencies. During Fiscal 2011, we implemented an automated workforce scheduling system in our stores. We believe this new system will provide numerous efficiencies without sacrificing our ability to serve our customers, including, but not limited to, better forecasting of volume and workload, improved allocation of manpower to meet customer demand, and support of our store experience and service initiatives.

 

  b) Supply chain efficiencies. We continue to work on several key initiatives to improve supply chain efficiencies and service levels. We will continue to make prudent investments within our distribution network to handle increased volume with greater flexibility. In turn, this should allow us to better support our off price model and enable our merchants to take advantage of more closeout opportunities.

Additionally, we will continue working towards minimizing costs and improving efficiencies with any expected savings being reinvested into the business. We plan to accomplish this primarily by increasing labor efficiency, strategically reducing our vendor direct to store shipments and reducing our outbound distribution expense through a variety of initiatives.

Uncertainties and Challenges

As management strives to increase profitability through achieving positive comparative store sales and leveraging productivity initiatives focused on improving the in-store experience, more efficient movement of products from the vendors to the selling floors, and modifying our marketing plans to increase our core customer base and increase our share of our current customer’s spending, there are uncertainties and challenges that we face as an off-price retailer of apparel and accessories for men, women and children and home furnishings that could have a material impact on our revenues or income.

General Economic Conditions. Consumer spending habits, including spending for the merchandise that we sell, are affected by, among other things, prevailing economic conditions, inflation, levels of employment, salaries and wage rates, prevailing interest rates, housing costs, energy costs, commodities pricing, income tax rates and policies, consumer confidence and consumer perception of economic conditions. In addition, consumer purchasing patterns may be influenced by consumers’ disposable income, credit availability and debt levels. A weakness in the U.S. economy, an uncertain economic outlook or a credit crisis could adversely affect consumer spending habits resulting in lower net sales and profits than expected on a quarterly or annual basis. Consumer confidence is also affected by the domestic and international political situation. Our financial condition and operations could be impacted by changes in government regulations such as taxes, healthcare reform, and other areas. The outbreak or escalation of war, or the occurrence of terrorist acts or other hostilities in or affecting the U.S., could lead to a decrease in spending by consumers.

Competition and Margin Pressure. We believe that in order to remain competitive with off-price retailers and discount stores, we must continue to offer brand-name merchandise at a discount from traditional department stores as well as an assortment of merchandise that is appealing to our customers.

The U.S. retail apparel and home furnishings markets are highly fragmented and competitive. We compete for business with department stores, off-price retailers, specialty stores, discount stores, wholesale clubs, and outlet stores. We anticipate that competition will increase in the future. Therefore, we will continue to look for ways to differentiate our stores from those of our competitors.

The U.S retail industry continues to face increased pressure on margins as commodity prices increase and the overall challenging retail conditions have led consumers to be more value conscious. Despite a plentiful supply of goods in the market, which historically created downward pricing pressure for wholesale purchases, we expect to continue to see rising costs. Our “open to buy” paradigm, in which we purchase both pre-season and in-season merchandise, allows us the flexibility to purchase less pre-season with the balance purchased in-season and opportunistically. It also provides us the flexibility to shift purchases between suppliers and categories. This enables us to obtain better terms with our suppliers, which we expect to help offset the expected rising costs of goods.

Changes to import and export laws could have a direct impact on our operating expenses and an indirect impact on consumer prices and we cannot predict any future changes in such laws.

Seasonality of Sales and Weather Conditions. Our sales, like most other retailers, are subject to seasonal influences, with the majority of our sales and net income derived during the months of September through January, which includes the back-to-school and holiday seasons.

Additionally, our sales continue to be significantly affected by weather. Generally, our sales are higher if the weather is cold during the Fall and warm during the early Spring. Sales of cold weather clothing are increased by early cold weather during the Fall, while sales of warm weather clothing are improved by early warm weather conditions in the Spring. Although we have diversified our product offerings, we believe traffic to our stores is still heavily driven by weather patterns.

 

17


Table of Contents

Key Performance Measures

We consider numerous factors in assessing our performance. Key performance measures used by management include comparative store sales, gross margin, inventory levels, receipt-to-reduction ratio, liquidity and store payroll as a percentage of net sales. 

Comparative Store Sales. Comparative store sales measure performance of a store during the current reporting period against the performance of the same store in the corresponding period of the previous year. The method of calculating comparative store sales varies across the retail industry. As a result, our definition of comparative store sales may differ from other retailers.

We define comparative store sales as sales of those stores commencing on the first day of the fiscal month one year after the end of their grand opening activities, which normally conclude within the first two months of operations. The table below depicts our comparative store sales during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009.

 

     Comparative
Store Sales
 

Fiscal 2011

     0.7

Fiscal 2010

     (0.2 )% 

Transition Period

     (4.8 )% 

Fiscal 2009

     (2.5 )% 

Various factors affect comparative store sales, including, but not limited to, current economic conditions, weather conditions, the timing of our releases of new merchandise and promotional events, the general retail sales environment, consumer preferences and buying trends, changes in sales mix among distribution channels, competition, and the success of marketing programs. While any and all of these factors can impact comparative store sales, we believe that the increase in comparative store sales during Fiscal 2011 was primarily driven by our improved merchandise content and customer experience initiatives. The progress made from these initiatives was positive even though many of our regions experienced unseasonably warm temperatures during the holiday selling period. The decrease in comparative store sales during Fiscal 2010 was primarily driven by weather conditions. The decrease in comparative store sales during the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 was primarily attributable to weakened consumer demand as a result of the overall challenging retail conditions.

Gross Margin. Gross margin is a measure used by management to indicate whether we are selling merchandise at an appropriate gross profit. Gross margin is the difference between net sales and the cost of sales. Our cost of sales and gross margin may not be comparable to those of other entities, since some entities include all of the costs related to their buying and distribution functions in cost of sales. We include certain of these costs in the “Selling and Administrative Expenses” and “Depreciation and Amortization” line items in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. We include in our “Cost of Sales” line item all costs of merchandise (net of purchase discounts and certain vendor allowances), inbound freight, outbound freight from distribution centers and certain merchandise acquisition costs, primarily commissions and import fees. Gross margin as a percentage of net sales increased slightly from 38.6% during Fiscal 2010 to 38.7% during Fiscal 2011.

Inventory Levels. Inventory at January 28, 2012 increased $38.1 million to $682.3 million at January 28, 2012 from $644.2 million at January 29, 2011. This increase was the result of 17 net new stores opened during Fiscal 2011. Average store inventory (inclusive of stores and warehouse inventory) at January 28, 2012 increased approximately 2.1% to $1.4 million per store compared with average store inventory at January 29, 2011 primarily related to inventory purchased and held as a result of opportunistic buys. Average inventory per comparative store (exclusive of new and non comparative stores and warehouse inventories) decreased 7.4%. This decrease in average inventory per comparative store was the result of our ongoing merchandise and supply chain initiatives.

In order to better serve our customers, and maximize sales, we continue to refine our merchandising mix and inventory levels within our stores. By managing our inventories conservatively we believe we will be better able to deliver a continual flow of fresh merchandise to our customers. We continue to move toward more productive inventories by increasing the amount of current inventory as a percent of total inventory.

Receipt-to-Reduction Ratio. We continue to manage our merchandise flow based on a receipt-to-reduction ratio. By matching forecasted levels of receipts to forecasted inventory outflows (inclusive of sales, markdowns, and inventory shrinkage) on a monthly basis, we believe we will create a more normalized receipt cadence to support sales which will ultimately lead to an improved inventory turnover ratio.

 

18


Table of Contents

Inventory turnover is a measure that indicates how efficiently inventory is bought and sold. It measures the length of time that we own our inventory. This is significant because the longer the inventory is owned, the more likely markdowns may be required to sell the inventory. Inventory turnover is calculated by dividing retail sales before sales discounts by the average retail value of the inventory for the period being measured. The inventory turnover calculation is based on a rolling 13 month average of inventory and the last 12 months’ sales. Our annualized inventory turnover rate (inclusive of stores and warehouse inventory) was 2.8 turns per year at January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011. Our annualized comparative store inventory turnover rate (exclusive of warehouse inventory) increased to 3.1 turns per year during Fiscal 2011 compared with 2.9 turns per year during Fiscal 2010.

Liquidity. Liquidity measures our ability to generate cash. Management measures liquidity through cash flow and working capital position. Cash flow is the measure of cash generated from operating, financing, and investing activities. We generated an increase in cash flow of $5.5 million during Fiscal 2011, increasing our cash and cash equivalents to $35.7 million as of January 28, 2012. This increase was primarily due to cash provided by operations as a result of the continued improvement of our core operations as well as our working capital management strategy. The cash provided by operations was partially offset by cash used in investing and financing activities. Cash used in investing activities was primarily related to capital expenditures as we continue to grow our store base and invest in capital projects in our distribution centers and corporate offices. Cash used in financing activities was primarily related to the payment of dividends during the year of $297.9 million, partially offset by the impact of our debt refinancing during the first quarter of Fiscal 2011.

Changes in working capital also impact our cash flows. Working capital equals current assets (exclusive of restricted cash and cash equivalents) minus current liabilities. Working capital at January 28, 2012 was $337.9 million compared with $386.2 million at January 29, 2011. The decrease in working capital from January 29, 2011 is primarily attributable to increased accounts payable balances at January 28, 2012, related to our working capital management strategy whereby we accelerated less payments in Fiscal 2011 than we did in Fiscal 2010, partially offset by increased inventory, as a result of an increase in inventory which was purchased and held as a result of opportunistic buys as well as new store inventory.

Store Payroll as a Percentage of Net Sales. Store payroll as a percentage of net sales measures our ability to manage our payroll in accordance with increases or decreases in net sales. The method of calculating store payroll varies across the retail industry. As a result, our store payroll as a percentage of net sales may differ from other retailers. We define store payroll as regular and overtime payroll for all store personnel as well as regional and territory store management, loss prevention and human resources, and does not include payroll charges for corporate and warehouse employees. Store payroll as a percentage of net sales was 10.1% and 10.3% during Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010, respectively.

Results of Operations – Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010

The following tables set forth certain items in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income as a percentage of net sales for Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010. Financial information for Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010 was derived from audited financial statements.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
 

REVENUES:

    

Net Sales

     100.0     100.0

Other Revenue

     0.9        0.9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

     100.9        100.9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

COSTS AND EXPENSES:

    

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization as Shown Below)

     61.3        61.4   

Selling and Administrative Expenses

     31.5        31.5   

Restructuring and Separation Costs

     0.2        0.1   

Depreciation and Amortization

     4.0        4.0   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     0.1        0.1   

Other Income, Net

     (0.3     (0.3

Loss on Extinguishment of Debt

     1.0        —     

Interest Expense (Inclusive of Gain/Loss on Interest Rate Cap Agreements)

     3.4        2.7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Costs and Expenses

     101.2        99.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Loss) Income Before Income Tax Expense (Benefit)

     (0.3     1.4   

Income Tax (Benefit) Expense

     (0.1     0.6   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (Loss) Income

     (0.2 )%      0.8
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

19


Table of Contents

Performance for Fiscal Year (52 weeks) Ended January 28, 2012 Compared with Fiscal Year (52 weeks) Ended January 29, 2011

Net Sales

We experienced an increase in net sales for Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010. Consolidated net sales increased $184.5 million, or 5.0%, to $3,854.1 million for Fiscal 2011 from $3,669.6 million for Fiscal 2010. This increase was primarily attributable to

 

   

an increase in net sales of $101.8 million related to 20 new stores opened during Fiscal 2011,

 

   

an increase in net sales of $65.5 million related to our non comparative stores,

 

   

a comparative store sales increase of $26.3 million, or 0.7%, to $3,623.7 million and

 

   

an increase in other sales, inclusive of barter sales of $13.1 million; partially offset by

 

   

a decrease in net sales of $22.2 million from three stores closed since January 30, 2011.

We believe that the comparative store sales increase was primarily due to our improved merchandise content and customer experience initiatives. We believe the progress made from these initiatives was partially offset by the unseasonably warm temperatures experienced in many of our regions during the fall and holiday selling period.

Other Revenue

Other revenue (consisting of rental income from leased departments, subleased rental income, layaway, alterations, other service charges, and miscellaneous revenue items) increased $1.9 million to $33.4 million for Fiscal 2011 compared with $31.5 million for Fiscal 2010. This increase was primarily related to an increase in rental income from leased departments of $1.7 million.

Cost of Sales

Cost of sales increased $111.1 million, or 4.9%, for Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010. Cost of sales as a percentage of net sales improved slightly to 61.3% during Fiscal 2011 compared with 61.4% during Fiscal 2010. The dollar increase of $111.1 million in cost of sales between Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010 was primarily related to the increase in our net sales during the same periods.

During Fiscal 2011 as compared with Fiscal 2010, we experienced a slight increase in gross margin as a percent of net sales to 38.7% from 38.6%. The improvement in our gross margin as a percent of net sales was primarily the result of improvements in shrinkage rates and fewer markdowns, partially offset by increased initial markups.

Selling and Administrative Expenses

Selling and administrative expenses increased $58.7 million, or 5.1%, to $1,215.3 million for Fiscal 2011 from $1,156.6 million for Fiscal 2010. The increase in selling and administrative expenses is summarized in the table below:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Fiscal Years Ended               
  

 

 

      
     January 28,
2012
     January 29,
2011
     $
Variance
    %
Change
 

Payroll and Payroll Related

   $ 554,823       $ 524,120       $ 30,703        5.9

Occupancy

     387,028         373,166         13,862        3.7   

Advertising

     77,595         70,422         7,173        10.2   

Benefit Costs

     19,844         15,326         4,518        29.5   

Other

     145,507         141,430         4,077        2.9   

Business Insurance

     30,504         32,149         (1,645 )     (5.1
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Selling & Administrative Expenses

   $ 1,215,301       $ 1,156,613       $ 58,688        5.1
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

20


Table of Contents

The increase in selling and administrative expense during Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010 was primarily related to increases in payroll and payroll related costs and occupancy costs. The increase in payroll and payroll related costs of approximately $30.7 million was primarily related to the addition of 17 net new stores as well as stores that opened during Fiscal 2010 that did not operate for a full 52 weeks. Amounts related to these stores resulted in an increase in payroll and payroll related expenses of $20.8 million. Also contributing to the increase in payroll and payroll related costs were:

 

   

a $3.3 million increase in relocation expense as a result of our expanded recruiting efforts to attract high quality candidates,

 

   

a $2.9 million increase in regular payroll primarily driven by increased headcount,

 

   

a $2.4 million increase in stock compensation expense related to an adjustment to our forfeiture rate and

 

   

a $2.2 million increase in payroll taxes primarily related to increased rates in the states that we do business.

The increase in occupancy related costs of $13.9 million in Fiscal 2011 as compared with Fiscal 2010 was primarily related to new stores and stores that opened during Fiscal 2010 that did not operate for a full 52 weeks. These stores accounted for $19.0 million of the total increase. This increase was partially offset by a $5.4 million decrease in utilities primarily attributed to savings created as a result of our lighting retrofit and energy management initiatives.

The increase in advertising expense of $7.2 million during Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010 was primarily related to increased national and spot television advertising during the year as well as planned incremental marketing investment during the year. The increase in advertising expense was also attributable to the number of grand opening advertisements primarily related to the opening of 20 new BCF stores.

The increase in benefit costs of $4.5 million during Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010 was primarily the result of increased health insurance claims of $3.6 million primarily as a result of increased participation due to improved benefits as well as increased 401(k) Plan Match expense of $1.1 million related to increased participation in the plan.

The increase in other selling and administrative expenses of $4.1 during Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010 was primarily due to a $3.8 million increase in temporary help related to incremental investments in supply chain to improve support of our opportunistic buying model, a $3.0 million increase in our litigation expense as a result of additional legal reserves and settlements during Fiscal 2011 and a $3.3 million increase in travel and training expenses. These increases were partially offset by a $6.3 million decrease in our legal expense primarily related to fees incurred as part of our aborted debt refinancing in the Fall of Fiscal 2010. Refer to previous discussions describing our successful debt refinancing in February 2011 under section “Debt Refinancing and Dividend” and later in Note 10 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Long-Term Debt.”

The decrease in business insurance costs of $1.6 million in Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010 was the result of decreased claims experience during Fiscal 2011 as well as claim settlements at more favorable amounts during Fiscal 2011. During Fiscal 2010, we experienced an increase in the cost of workers’ compensation claims and an increase in the number of general liability claims, each of which we believe was a result of the economic environment. This trend slowed during Fiscal 2011 and we have returned to a more historical level of claims experience.

Restructuring and Separation Costs

As part of our ongoing effort to ensure that our resources are in line with our business objectives, we regularly review all areas of the business to identify efficiency opportunities to enhance our performance. During Fiscal 2011, we effected a reorganization of certain positions within our stores and corporate locations in an effort to improve workflow efficiencies and realign certain responsibilities. As a result of these reorganizational efforts, we incurred a charge of $7.4 million during Fiscal 2011 compared with a $2.2 million charge in Fiscal 2010.

Depreciation and Amortization

Depreciation and amortization expense related to the depreciation of fixed assets and the amortization of favorable and unfavorable leases amounted to $153.1 million for Fiscal 2011 compared with $146.8 million for Fiscal 2010. The increase in depreciation and amortization expense was primarily driven by depreciation expense related to 17 net new stores opened during Fiscal 2011.

 

21


Table of Contents

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

Impairment charges related to long-lived assets were $1.7 million and $2.1 million during Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010, respectively. During Fiscal 2011, we recorded impairment charges related to seven stores as a result of the decline in the operating performance of those stores. We impaired nine stores during Fiscal 2010 (refer to Note 8 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion).

The recoverability assessment related to these store-level assets requires various judgments and estimates including estimates related to future revenues, gross margin rates, store expenses and other assumptions. We base these estimates upon our past and expected future performance. We believe our estimates are appropriate in light of current market conditions. However, future impairment charges could be required if we do not achieve our current revenue or cash flow projections for each store.

Other Income, net

Other income, net (consisting of investment income, gains and losses on disposition of assets, breakage income and other miscellaneous items) decreased $1.4 million to $9.9 million during Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010. The decrease in other income during Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010 was primarily related to the following:

 

   

A decrease in miscellaneous income of $1.5 million,

 

   

a decrease of $1.5 million related to insurance recoveries in Fiscal 2010, partially offset by;

 

   

an increase in breakage income of $1.4 million (refer to Note 1 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies for further discussion).

Loss on Extinguishment of Debt

As discussed in more detail in Note 10 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Long Term Debt,” on February 24, 2011 we completed the refinancing of our Previous Term Loan, Previous Senior Notes, and Previous Senior Discount Notes. As a result of these transactions, the Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes, with carrying values at February 24, 2011 of $302.0 million and $99.3 million, respectively, were replaced with a $450.0 million aggregated principal amount of 10% Senior Notes due 2019 at an issue price of 100%. Additionally, the Previous Term Loan with a carrying value of $777.6 million at February 24, 2011 was replaced with a $1,000.0 million New Term Loan Facility. Borrowings on the ABL Line of Credit related to the refinancing transactions were $101.6 million. In connection with the offering of the Notes and the refinancing of the Term Loan facility, the Company declared a dividend of approximately $300.0 million, in the aggregate, on a pro rata basis to the equity holders of Parent.

In accordance with ASC Topic No. 470, “Debt – Modifications and Extinguishments” (Topic 470), the transactions noted above were determined to be an extinguishment of the existing debt and an issuance of new debt. As a result, we recorded a loss on the extinguishment of debt in the amount of $37.8 million in the line item “Loss on Extinguishment of Debt” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Of the $37.8 million loss on the extinguishment of debt, $21.4 million represented early call premiums that we paid to the holders of our Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes. The remaining $16.4 million represented the write off of deferred financing fees related to the extinguished debt facilities.

Interest Expense

Interest expense was $129.1 million during Fiscal 2011 compared with $99.3 million during Fiscal 2010. The $29.8 million increase in interest expense was primarily driven by increases resulting from our refinancing transactions, offset by other items described below. In Fiscal 2011 we had higher average balances on our New Term Loan and our ABL Line of Credit and higher interest rates related to our New Term Loan and ABL Line of Credit, as a result of our refinancing transactions, resulting in a $41.2 million increase in interest expense. These increases were partially offset by:

 

   

a $3.7 million decrease related to our Notes as a result of our refinancing transactions completed in February 2011,

 

   

a $3.4 million decrease in non-recurring interest charges related to a litigation reserve adjustment during Fiscal 2010 that did not repeat;

 

22


Table of Contents
   

a $2.3 million decrease related to an adjustment of our interest rate cap agreements to fair value; and

 

   

a $1.3 million decrease in our commitment fees due to higher average balances on our ABL Line of Credit borrowings.

Our average interest rates and average balances related to our Term Loans and our ABL Line of Credit, for Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010 are summarized in the table below:

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     January 28, 2012     January 29,
2011
 

Average Interest Rate – ABL Line of Credit(b)

     3.3     2.7

Average Interest Rate – Term Loan (a)

     6.2     2.6

Average Balance – ABL Line of Credit

   $ 79.2 million      $  10.5 million   

Average Balance – Term Loan (a)

   $ 974.4 million      $ 854.8 million   

 

(a) As of January 29, 2011, the Term Loan interest rate and average balance were related to the Previous Term Loan Facility. As of January 28, 2012, the Term Loan interest rate and average balance were related to the New Term Loan Facility.
(b) As of January 29, 2011, the ABL Line of Credit interest rate was related to the ABL Line of Credit before the refinancing transaction on September 2, 2011. As of January 28, 2012, the ABL Line of Credit interest rate was related to the ABL Line of Credit after the September 2, 2011 refinancing transaction.

Income Tax (Benefit) Expense

The income tax benefit was $4.1 million for Fiscal 2011 compared with an income tax expense of $22.1 million for Fiscal 2010. The effective tax rate was 39.8% related to the pre-tax loss of $10.4 million for Fiscal 2011, and the effective tax rate was 41.7% related to pre-tax income of $53.1 million for Fiscal 2010. The decrease in the effective tax rate for Fiscal 2011 was primarily due to an increased benefit from the recognition of tax credits and the reversal of uncertain tax positions, offset by changes in the valuation allowance, foreign taxes related to Puerto Rico and the impact of changes in tax laws. The Fiscal 2010 tax rate reflects pre-tax income impacted by state income taxes. Refer to Note 15 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Income Taxes” for further discussion.

Net (Loss) Income

Net loss amounted to $6.3 million for Fiscal 2011 compared with net income of $31.0 during Fiscal 2010. The decrease in our operating results of $37.3 million was primarily driven by our debt refinancing in February 2011 which resulted in a $37.8 million loss on extinguishment of debt as well as increased interest expense, partially offset by increased sales.

Results of Operations – Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period

The following tables set forth certain items in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income in both actual dollars and as a percentage of net sales for Fiscal 2010, the comparable 52 week period ended January 30, 2010, the Transition Period and the comparable 35 week period ended January 31, 2009 used in connection with the subsequent discussion. Financial information for Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period were derived from audited financial statements. Financial information for the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010 and the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009, were derived from unaudited financial statements.

 

23


Table of Contents
     (in thousands)  
     52 Weeks Ended     35 Weeks Ended  
     January 29,
2011
    January  30,
2010

(Unaudited)
    January 30,
2010
    January  31,
2009

(Unaudited)
 

REVENUES:

        

Net Sales

   $ 3,669,602      $ 3,522,914      $ 2,457,567      $ 2,476,635   

Other Revenue

     31,487        30,840        21,730        20,277   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

     3,701,089        3,553,754        2,479,297        2,496,912   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

COSTS AND EXPENSES:

        

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization as Shown Below)

     2,252,346        2,181,707        1,492,349        1,510,409   

Selling and Administrative Expenses

     1,156,613        1,113,960        759,774        761,062   

Restructuring and Separation Costs

     2,200        7,452        2,429        1,929   

Depreciation and Amortization

     146,759        156,388        103,605        106,823   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     2,080        56,141           46,776           28,134      

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

     —          15,250        —          279,300   

Other Income, Net

     (11,346     (16,635     (15,335 )     (4,698

Interest Expense (Inclusive of Gain/Loss on Interest Rate Cap Agreements)

     99,309        84,423        59,476        74,263   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Costs and Expenses

     3,647,961        3,598,686        2,449,074        2,757,222   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (Loss) Before Income Tax Expense (Benefit)

     53,128        (44,932     30,223        (260,310

Income Tax Expense (Benefit)

     22,130        (29,753     11,570        (104,667
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Income (Loss)

     30,998        (15,179     18,653        (155,643
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Comprehensive (Loss) Income

   $ 30,998         $ (15,179   $ 18,653      $ (155,643
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     52 Weeks Ended     35 Weeks Ended  
     January 29,
2011
    January  30,
2010

(Unaudited)
    January 30,
2010
    January  31,
2009

(Unaudited)
 

Statement of Operations Data:

      

Net Sales

              100.0               100.0             100.0              100.0

Other Revenue

     0.9        0.9        0.9        0.8   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

     100.9        100.9        100.9        100.8   

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization, As Shown Below)

     61.4        61.9        60.7        61.0   

Selling & Administrative Expenses

     31.5        31.6        30.9        30.7   

Restructuring and Separation Costs

     0.1        0.2        0.1        0.1   

Depreciation and Amortization

     4.0        4.4        4.2        4.3   

Impairment Charges – Long Lived Assets

     0.1        1.6        1.9        1.1   

Impairment Charges – Trademark

     —          0.4        —          11.3   

Other Income, Net

     (0.3     (0.5     (0.6     (0.2

Interest Expense (Inclusive of Gain/Loss on Interest Rate Cap Agreements)

     2.7        2.4        2.4        3.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Expense

     99.5        102.0        99.6        111.3   

Income (Loss) Before Income Tax Expense (Benefit)

     1.4        (1.1     1.3        (10.5

Income Tax Expense (Benefit)

     0.6        (0.8 )     0.5        (4.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Income (Loss)

     0.8     (0.3 )%      0.8     (6.3 )% 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

24


Table of Contents

Performance for the Fiscal Year (52 weeks) Ended January 29, 2011 Compared with the 52 weeks Ended January 30, 2010

Net Sales

We experienced an increase in net sales for Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. Consolidated net sales increased $146.7 million, or 4.2%, to $3,669.6 million for Fiscal 2010 from $3,522.9 million for the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. This increase was primarily attributable to:

 

   

an increase in net sales of $145.3 million related to 25 new stores opened during Fiscal 2010,

 

   

an increase in net sales of $29.0 million related to our non comparative stores, and

 

   

an increase in other sales of $3.0 million, partially offset by

 

   

a decrease in net sales of $24.3 million from seven stores closed since January 31, 2010 and

 

   

a comparative store sales decrease of $6.3 million, or 0.2%, to $3,460.1 million.

We believe the comparative store sales decrease was primarily due to warmer weather in September and October of 2010 as compared with the same period in the prior year.

Other Revenue

Other revenue (consisting of rental income from Leased Departments, subleased rental income, layaway, alterations, other service charges, and miscellaneous revenue items) increased $0.7 million to $31.5 million for Fiscal 2010 compared with $30.8 million for the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. This increase was primarily related to an increase in layaway fees of $1.4 million, partially offset by a $0.8 million decrease in rental income.

Cost of Sales

Cost of sales increased $70.6 million, or 3.2%, for Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. Cost of sales as a percentage of net sales improved to 61.4% during Fiscal 2010 compared with 61.9% during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. The dollar increase of $70.6 million in cost of sales between Fiscal 2010 and the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was primarily related to the increase in our net sales during the same periods.

During Fiscal 2010 as compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010, we experienced an increase in gross margin as a percent of net sales to 38.6% from 38.1%. The improvement in our gross margin as a percent of net sales was primarily the result of fewer markdowns, decreased freight expense incurred during Fiscal 2010 as compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010, and a slight improvement in shrink expense.

Selling and Administrative Expenses

Selling and administrative expenses increased $42.6 million, or 3.8% to $1,156.6 million for Fiscal 2010 from $1,114.0 million for the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. The increase in selling and administrative expenses is summarized in the table below:

 

     (in thousands)  
     52 Weeks Ended               
  

 

 

      
     January 29,
2011
     January 30,
2010
     $
Variance
    %
Change
 

Payroll and Payroll Related

   $ 524,120       $ 497,234       $ 26,886        5.4

Occupancy

     373,166         362,103         11,063        3.1   

Benefit Costs

     15,326         9,927         5,399        54.4   

Advertising

     70,422         67,283         3,139        4.7   

Other

     141,430         139,012         2,418        1.7   

Business Insurance

     32,149         38,401         (6,252 )     (16.3 )
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Selling & Administrative Expenses

   $ 1,156,613       $ 1,113,960       $ 42,653        3.8
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The increase in selling and administrative expense during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was primarily caused by increases in payroll and payroll related costs and occupancy costs. The increase in payroll and payroll related costs of approximately $26.9 million was primarily related to the addition of 18 net new stores as well as stores that opened during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 that did not operate for a full 52 weeks. Amounts related to these stores resulted in an increase in payroll and payroll related expenses of $23.3 million. Also contributing to the increase in payroll and payroll related costs was an increase in bonus expense of $6.1 million and an increase in state unemployment tax expense of $4.1

 

25


Table of Contents

million. As we exceeded our bonus target for the June 2009 through May 2010 bonus period, our bonus expense increased and was recognized during the final quarter of the bonus year, which coincided with the first and second quarters of Fiscal 2010. Additionally, we had an increase in recruiting bonuses as we continued to enhance the talent of our organization during Fiscal 2010. The increase in state unemployment tax was due to rate increases in many of the states where we conduct business.

These increases were partially offset by a decrease in Fiscal 2010 of $4.2 million in payroll and payroll tax expense related to stores that were opened for the full 52 week periods ended January 29, 2011 and January 30, 2010 and a decrease in vacation expense of $2.2 million. The decrease in payroll and payroll tax expense related to stores that were opened for the full 52 week periods ended January 29, 2011 and January 30, 2010 was due to our ongoing initiative to reduce store payroll costs.

The increase in occupancy related costs of $11.1 million in Fiscal 2010 as compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was primarily related to new store openings during Fiscal 2010. New BCF stores opened during Fiscal 2010 accounted for $16.3 million of the total increase. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in utilities expense of $3.3 million as a result of our ongoing initiative to reduce costs as well as a $1.2 million decrease in real estate taxes.

The increase in benefit costs of $5.4 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was primarily the result of increased 401(k) Plan Match expense of $6.2 million and increased employee moving expenses of $2.4 million, partially offset by decreased health insurance claims of $3.3 million. The increase in 401(k) Plan expense during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was due to our ability to utilize less money recovered through forfeitures during Fiscal 2010 to fund some, or all, of our matching contribution obligation as compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. A “forfeiture” is the portion of our contribution that is lost by a 401(k) Plan participant who terminates employment prior to becoming fully vested in such contribution. Based on the forfeitures available to us, we were not required to record any 401(k) Plan expense during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010.

The increase in advertising expense of $3.1 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was primarily related to shifts in the media used for marketing communications and an increase in the number of grand opening advertisements. During the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 we opened 15 new BCF stores. During Fiscal 2010, we incurred an additional $3.1 million in marketing and advertising expense primarily related to the opening of 25 new BCF stores.

The increase in other selling and administrative expenses of $2.4 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was primarily due to an increase in credit card fees of $3.9 million, a $3.4 million increase in temporary help, a $3.0 million increase related to fees incurred as part of our initial unsuccessful debt refinancing in the Fall of 2010, and a $1.5 million charge to miscellaneous taxes, partially offset by a $6.1 million decrease in our legal expense related to legal costs incurred in the prior year that did not repeat in the current year and $3.5 million in expense savings related to costs incurred with respect to our change in year end during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 that did not repeat during Fiscal 2010.

The decrease in business insurance of $6.3 million in Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was the result of increased claims experienced during the prior period. During the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010, we experienced an increase in the cost of workers’ compensation claims and an increase in the number of general liability claims, each of which we believe was a result of the economic environment. This trend slowed during Fiscal 2010 and has returned to a more historical level of claims experience.

Restructuring and Separation Costs

In an effort to better align our resources with our business objectives, in Fiscal 2009, we reviewed all areas of the business to identify efficiency opportunities to enhance our performance. In light of the then challenging economic and retail sales environments, we accelerated the implementation of several initiatives, including some that resulted in the elimination of certain positions and the restructuring of certain other jobs and functions. Our restructuring and separation efforts commenced in the third quarter of Fiscal 2009 and continued through the Transition Period and Fiscal 2010. We incurred $2.2 million and $7.5 million in restructuring and separation costs during Fiscal 2010 and the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010, respectively.

Depreciation and Amortization

Depreciation and amortization expense related to the depreciation of fixed assets and the amortization of favorable and unfavorable leases amounted to $146.8 million for Fiscal 2010 compared with $156.4 million for the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. The decrease in depreciation and amortization expense was primarily related to various assets that became fully depreciated during the 12 months ended January 30, 2010, which resulted in less depreciation expense during Fiscal 2010.

 

26


Table of Contents

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

Impairment charges related to long-lived assets were $2.1 million and $56.1 million during Fiscal 2010 and the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010, respectively. The decrease in impairment charges was primarily related to the stabilization of our operating stores’ performance year over year. During Fiscal 2010, we recorded impairments related to nine stores as a result of the decline in the operating performance of those stores (refer to Note 8 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion).

The recoverability assessment related to these store-level assets requires judgments and estimates of future revenues, gross margin rates and store expenses. We base these estimates upon our past and expected future performance. We believe our estimates are appropriate in light of current market conditions. However, future impairment charges could be required if we do not achieve our current revenue or cash flow projections for each store.

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

There was no impairment charge related to our tradenames during Fiscal 2010. Impairment charges related to our tradenames during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 amounted to $15.3 million. In accordance with ASC Topic No. 350, “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other,” (Topic 350), we perform our annual impairment testing of goodwill and indefinite-lived assets at the beginning of each May.

In connection with the preparation of our Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for the third quarter of Fiscal 2009 (relating to the three months ended February 28, 2009) as well as our Fiscal 2009 financial statements (relating to the year ended May 30, 2009), we concluded that it was appropriate to test our goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets for recoverability in light of the following factors:

 

   

Significant declines in the U.S. and international financial markets and the resulting impact of such events on then anticipated future macroeconomic conditions and customer behavior;

 

   

The determination that these macroeconomic conditions were impacting our sales trends as evidenced by the decreases in comparative store sales that we were experiencing;

 

   

Decreased comparative store sales results of the peak holiday and winter selling seasons in the third quarter of Fiscal 2009 which were significant to our financial results for the year;

 

   

Declines in market valuation multiples of peer group companies used in the estimate of our business enterprise value; and

 

   

Our expectation that comparative store sales trends during Fiscal 2009 would continue for an extended period. As a result, we developed a more moderate store opening plan which reduced our future projections of revenue and operating results offset by initiatives (which have since been implemented) to reduce our cost structure.

The recoverability assessment with respect to the tradenames used in our operations requires us to estimate the fair value of the tradenames as of the assessment date. Such determination is made using the “relief from royalty” valuation method. Inputs to the valuation model include:

 

   

Future revenue and profitability projections associated with the tradenames;

 

   

Estimated market royalty rates that could be derived from the licensing of our tradenames to third parties in order to establish the cash flows accruing to our benefit as a result of ownership of the tradenames; and

 

   

The rate used to discount the estimated royalty cash flow projections to their present value (or estimated fair value) based on the risk and nature of our cash flows.

During the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010, we recorded an impairment charge related to our tradenames in the amount of $15.3 million. Of this amount, $9.0 million was attributable to lower revenues and profitability projections associated with our tradenames in the near term and lower estimated market royalty rate expectations in light of the then current general economic conditions compared with the analysis we performed during Fiscal 2008. Our projected revenues within the model were based on comparative store sales and new store assumptions over a nine year period. A less aggressive new store opening plan combined with revised comparative store sales assumptions for the first fiscal year of the projection had a significant negative impact on the valuation. We believe our estimates were appropriate based upon the then current market conditions.

The remaining $6.3 million of the $15.3 million impairment was related to our acquisition of certain tradename rights during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. During that period, we purchased $6.3 million of tradename rights based on our

 

27


Table of Contents

belief that these tradename rights would ultimately provide us with substantial marketing benefits. Historically, we were restricted in our advertising campaigns such that we could only refer to ourselves as Burlington Coat Factory and were required to note that we were not affiliated with Burlington Industries. The purchase of these tradename rights allows us to shorten our name as appropriate based on the current marketing campaign and eliminates the requirement to note that we are not affiliated with Burlington Industries. Based on our tradenames impairment assessment, we could not support an increase in the asset value of our tradenames related to this acquisition on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. As a result, we immediately impaired the acquired asset.

In accordance with Topic 350, there were no triggering events that required us to test goodwill for impairment during Fiscal 2010. We believe our estimates were appropriate based upon current market conditions. However, future impairment charges could be required if we do not achieve our current cash flow, revenue and profitability projections or our weighted average cost of capital increases or market valuation multiple associated with peer group companies decline.

Other Income, net

Other income, net (consisting of investment income, gains and losses on disposition of assets, breakage income and other miscellaneous items) decreased $5.3 million to $11.3 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010.

The decrease in other income during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 was primarily related to the following:

 

   

A decrease in miscellaneous income of $4.9 million primarily related to a gain on a legal settlement in our favor during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010,

 

   

a decrease in breakage income of $3.3 million (refer to Note 1 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” for further discussion),

 

   

a decrease of $1.5 million related to insurance recoveries, and

 

   

a decrease in our gain on investment of $0.6 million related to higher recoveries of previously written off investments during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 compared with Fiscal 2010, partially offset by;

 

   

a $4.4 million increase related to a loss on the disposal of various fixed assets primarily related to our conversion to a new warehouse management system in Edgewater Park, New Jersey during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010, and

 

   

a $0.6 million increase in income received from vending machines and recycling.

Interest Expense

Interest expense was $99.3 million and $84.4 million during Fiscal 2010 and the 52 week periods ended January 30, 2010, respectively. The increase in interest expense was primarily driven by increased expense related to our interest rate cap agreements, other interest expense and our commitment fees. Adjustments of the interest rate cap agreements to fair value resulted in a loss of $5.5 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with a gain of $5.4 million for the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010, respectively. These charges resulted in a year over year increase in non-cash interest expense of $10.9 million, which was recorded through the line item “Interest Expense” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss). Our interest rate cap agreements are discussed in more detail in Item 7A, Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk and Note 9 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Derivatives and Hedging Activities.”

Other interest expense increased $2.8 million during Fiscal 2010 as compared with the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010 which was primarily driven by interest incurred as part of a legal settlement. The increase in commitment fees of $2.5 million was primarily related to a higher commitment fee charged on our ABL Line of Credit combined with a lower average outstanding balance on the ABL Line of Credit during Fiscal 2010 as compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010.

 

28


Table of Contents

These increases were partially offset by lower average interest rates on our Term Loan and ABL Line of Credit and a lower average balance on our Term Loan and our ABL Line of Credit as follows:

 

     52 weeks Ended  
     January 29, 2011     January 30, 2010  

Average Interest Rate – ABL Line of Credit

     2.7     3.0

Average Interest Rate – Term Loan

     2.6     2.7

Average Balance – ABL Line of Credit

   $ 10.5 Million      $ 27.2 Million   

Average Balance – Term Loan

   $ 854.8 Million      $ 868.9 Million   

Income Tax Expense

Income tax expense was $22.1 million for the 52 week period ended January 29, 2011 compared with an income tax benefit of $29.8 million for the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. The effective tax rates were 41.7% and 66.2%, respectively, for Fiscal 2010 and the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010. The decrease in the effective tax rate was primarily due to the fact that the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 had a pre-tax loss with a reduction in the valuation allowance for state net operating losses and reduced state blended tax rates, which had the effect of creating an income tax benefit for this period ended January 30, 2010. Due to the pre-tax loss, the tax benefits created by the reduction in the valuation allowance for state net operating losses and reduced state blended tax rates have the effect of increasing the effective tax rate (refer to Note 15 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Income Taxes” for further information).

Net Income

Net income amounted to $31.0 million for Fiscal 2010 compared with a net loss of $15.2 during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. The increase in our operating results of $46.2 million was primarily attributable to fewer impairments.

Performance During Fiscal 2010 (52 Weeks Ended January 29, 2011) Compared with the Transition Period (35 Weeks Ended January 30, 2010)

Net Sales

We experienced an increase in net sales for Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period. Consolidated net sales increased $1,212.0 million, or 49.3%, to $3,669.6 million for Fiscal 2010 from $2,457.6 million for the Transition Period. Comparative store sales during Fiscal 2010 decreased 0.2% compared with a decrease of 4.8% during the Transition Period. The overall increase in net sales during Fiscal 2010 as compared with the Transition Period is primarily driven by the additional 17 weeks of sales during Fiscal 2010. During that period, we generated $1,134.8 million of net sales.

Other Revenue

Other revenue (consisting of rental income from Leased Departments, subleased rental income, layaway, alterations, other service charges, and miscellaneous revenue items) increased $9.8 million to $31.5 million for Fiscal 2010 compared with $21.7 million for the Transition Period. This increase was primarily due to the additional 17 weeks included in Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period. Other revenue generated during the additional 17 weeks of Fiscal 2010 amounted to $9.5 million. As a percentage of net sales, other revenue remained in line with the prior year at 0.9%.

Cost of Sales

Cost of sales increased $760.0 million, or 50.9% during Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period. Cost of sales as a percentage of net sales increased to 61.4% during Fiscal 2010 compared with 60.7% during the Transition Period. The dollar increase of $760.0 million in cost of sales during Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period was primarily related to the additional 17 weeks included in Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period which resulted in $701.1 million of additional cost of sales during Fiscal 2010. During Fiscal 2010 as compared with the Transition Period, gross margin as a percent of net sales declined to 38.6% from 39.3%, respectively, reflecting the seasonality of the Transition Period.

 

29


Table of Contents

Selling and Administrative Expenses

Selling and administrative expenses increased $396.8 million, or 52.2%, to $1,156.6 million for Fiscal 2010 from $759.8 million for the Transition Period. The increase in selling and administrative expenses is summarized in the table below:

 

     (in thousands)  
     52 Weeks Ended      35 Weeks Ended                
     January 29,
2011
     January 30,
2010
     $ Variance      % Change  

Payroll and Payroll Related

   $ 524,120       $ 337,057       $ 187,063         55.5

Occupancy

     373,166         246,082         127,084         51.6   

Other

     141,430         95,248         46,182         48.5   

Advertising

     70,422         49,378         21,044         42.6   

Business Insurance

     32,149         22,955         9,194         40.1   

Benefit Costs

     15,326         9,054         6,272         69.3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Selling & Administrative Expenses

   $ 1,156,613       $ 759,774       $ 396,839         52.2
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The increase in selling and administrative expense during Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period was primarily caused by the additional 17 weeks included Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period as well as the addition of 18 net new stores during Fiscal 2010. During the 17 week period, the Company incurred selling and administrative expenses of $363.4 million and new stores opened in Fiscal 2010 contributed $43.6 million to the increase in selling and administrative expenses.

As a percentage of net sales, selling and administrative expenses increased to 31.5% for Fiscal 2010 from 30.9% for the Transition Period.

Restructuring and Separation Costs

In an effort to better align our resources with our business objectives, in Fiscal 2009, we reviewed all areas of the business to identify efficiency opportunities to enhance our performance. In light of the challenging economic and retail sales environments, we accelerated the implementation of several initiatives, including some that resulted in the elimination of certain positions and the restructuring of certain other jobs and functions. Our restructuring and separation efforts commenced in the third quarter of Fiscal 2009, and continued through the Transition Period and Fiscal 2010. We incurred $2.2 million and $2.4 million in restructuring and separation costs during Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period, respectively.

Depreciation and Amortization

Depreciation and amortization expense related to the depreciation of fixed assets and the amortization of favorable and unfavorable leases amounted to $146.8 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with $103.6 million during the Transition Period. The increase in depreciation and amortization expense was primarily the result of the additional 17 weeks included in Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period which amounted to additional depreciation and amortization expense of $48.4 million.

As a percentage of net sales, depreciation and amortization decreased to 4.0% during Fiscal 2010 from 4.2% during the Transition Period.

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

Impairment charges related to long-lived assets were $2.1 million and $46.8 million for Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period, respectively. The decrease in impairment charges during Fiscal 2010 as compared with the Transition Period is primarily related to the stabilization of the operating stores’ performance during Fiscal 2010 as compared with the Transition Period (refer to Note 8 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion).

The recoverability assessment related to these store-level assets requires judgments and estimates of future revenues, gross margin rates and store expenses. We base these estimates upon our past and expected future performance. We believe our estimates are appropriate in light of current market conditions. However, future impairment charges could be required if we do not achieve our current revenue or cash flow projections for each store.

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

There was no impairment charge related to our tradenames during Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period. In accordance with ASC Topic No. 350, “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other,” (Topic 350), we perform our annual impairment testing of goodwill and indefinite-lived assets at the beginning of each May. In accordance with Topic 350, there were no triggering events that required us to test goodwill for impairment during Fiscal 2010 or the Transition Period.

 

30


Table of Contents

Other Income, net

Other income, net (consisting of investment income, gains and losses on disposition of assets, breakage income and other miscellaneous items) decreased $4.0 million to $11.3 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period. The decrease in other income during Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period was primarily related to a $4.1 million decrease in the loss on the sale of fixed assets from January 30, 2010 as compared with January 29, 2011.

Interest Expense

Interest expense was $99.3 million and $59.5 million during Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period, respectively. The $39.8 million increase in interest expense was primarily the result of the additional 17 weeks included in Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period which amounted to an additional $34.3 million in interest expense. In addition to the additional 17 weeks, interest expense increased further due to increased expense related to our interest rate cap agreements, other interest expense, and our commitment fees. Adjustments of the interest rate cap agreements to fair value resulted in a loss of $5.5 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with a gain of $0.5 million during the Transition Period, respectively. These charges resulted in a period over period increase in non-cash interest expense of $6.0 million, which was recorded through the line item “Interest Expense” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Our interest rate cap agreements are discussed in more detail in Item 7A, Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About market Risk and Note 9 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Derivatives and Hedging Activities.”

Other interest expense increased $2.8 million during Fiscal 2010 as compared with the Transition Period, which was primarily driven by interest incurred as part of a legal settlement. The increase in commitment fees of $3.0 million was primarily related to a higher commitment fee charged to our new ABL Line of Credit combined with a lower average outstanding balance on the ABL Line of Credit during Fiscal 2010 as compared with the Transition Period.

These increases were partially offset by a lower average balance on our Term Loan and our ABL Line of Credit as follows:

 

     52 Weeks Ended     35 Weeks Ended  
     January 29, 2011     January 30, 2010  

Average Interest Rate – ABL Line of Credit

     2.7     2.7

Average Interest Rate – Term Loan

     2.6     2.6

Average Balance – ABL Line of Credit

   $ 10.5 Million      $ 31.5 Million   

Average Balance – Term Loan

   $ 854.8 Million      $ 867.0 Million   

Income Tax Expense

Income tax expense was $22.1 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with income tax expense of $11.6 million during the Transition Period. The effective tax rates were 41.7% and 38.3%, respectively, during Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period. The increase in the effective tax rate was primarily due to a reduction in the valuation allowance for state net operating losses and an increase in the state tax prior year adjustment, which had the effect of increasing our income tax expense (refer to Note 15 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Income Taxes” for further information).

Net Income

Net income amounted to $31.0 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with a net income of $18.7 million during the Transition Period. The increase in our operating results of $12.3 million was primarily attributable to fewer impairments.

 

31


Table of Contents

Performance for the 35 Weeks Ended January 30, 2010 (Transition Period) Compared with the 35 Weeks Ended January 31, 2009

Net Sales

We experienced a decrease in net sales for the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. Consolidated net sales decreased $19.0 million, or 0.8%, to $2,457.6 million during the Transition Period from $2,476.6 million during the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. This decrease was primarily attributable to:

 

   

a comparative store sales decrease of $114.2 million, or 4.8%, to $2,263.2 million,

 

   

a decrease in barter sales of $10.8 million, and

 

   

a decrease in net sales of $2.5 million from stores closed since the comparable period in Fiscal 2009, partially offset by

 

   

an increase in net sales of $63.2 million for stores previously opened that were not included in our comparative store sales,

 

   

an increase in net sales of $34.1 million related to nine new stores opened during the Transition Period, and

 

   

an increase in layaway and other sales of $10.8 million.

We believe the comparative store sales decrease was due to weather conditions and weakened consumer demand. November of 2009 was the warmest November in the prior eight years. The weakened consumer demand was a result of the contraction of credit available to consumers and the overall challenging retail conditions.

Other Revenue

Other revenue (consisting of rental income from Leased Departments, subleased rental income, layaway, alterations, other service charges, and miscellaneous revenue items) increased $1.4 million to $21.7 million during the Transition Period compared with $20.3 million for the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. This increase was primarily related to an increase in layaway fees of $1.8 million.

Cost of Sales

Cost of sales decreased $18.1 million or 1.2% during the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. Cost of sales as a percentage of net sales decreased to 60.7% during the Transition Period compared with 61.0% during the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. The dollar decrease of $18.1 million in cost of sales between the Transition Period and the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 was primarily related to the decrease in our net sales during the same periods.

During the Transition Period, as compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009, we experienced an increase in gross margin as a percent of net sales from 39.0% to 39.3%. The improvement in our gross margin as a percent of net sales was primarily the result of fewer markdowns during the Transition Period as compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. Markdowns improved 0.7% as a percentage of net sales as a result of our ongoing initiative to increase the amount of current inventory as a percent of our total inventory, ultimately leading to fewer markdowns. The improvement in markdowns was almost entirely offset by increased shrink of 0.6% as a percentage of net sales during the Transition Period as compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009.

Selling and Administrative Expenses

Selling and administrative expenses decreased $1.3 million, or 0.2%, to $759.8 million for the Transition Period from $761.1 million for the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. The decrease in selling and administrative expenses is summarized in the table below:

 

     (in thousands)  
     35 Weeks Ended               
     January 30,
2010
     January 31,
2009
     $ Variance     % Change  

Payroll and Payroll Related

   $ 337,057       $ 358,074       $ (21,017     (5.9 )% 

Advertising

     49,378         57,283         (7,905     (13.8

Benefit Costs

     9,054         12,176         (3,122     (25.6

Business Insurance

     22,955         17,071         5,884        34.5   

Occupancy

     246,082         235,534         10,548        4.5   

Other

     95,248         80,924         14,324        17.7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Selling & Administrative Expenses

   $ 759,774       $ 761,062       $ (1,288     (0.2 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

32


Table of Contents

The decrease in selling and administrative expense during the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 was primarily caused by decreases in payroll and payroll related costs. The decrease in payroll and payroll related costs of approximately $21.0 million was primarily related to a decrease in our store payroll as a percentage of net sales to 10.2% during the Transition Period from 10.9% during the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 and a corresponding decrease in payroll taxes of $1.8 million as a result of our initiative to reduce store payroll costs including the reduction of janitorial payroll in conjunction with our initiative to replace janitorial payroll with a third party provider.

The decrease in advertising expense of $7.9 million during the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 was primarily related to shifts in the media used for marketing communications and a decrease in the number of grand opening advertisements. During the Transition Period we opened nine new BCF stores. During the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009, we incurred additional marketing and advertising expense in connection with the opening of 34 new BCF stores.

The decrease in benefit costs of $3.1 million during the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 was primarily a result of decreased 401(k) Plan expense. Under our 401(k) Plan, we are able to utilize monies recovered through forfeitures to fund some or all of our annual matching contribution obligation. A “forfeiture” is the portion of our contribution that is lost by a 401(k) Plan participant who terminates employment prior to becoming fully vested in such contribution. Based on the forfeitures available to us, we were not required to record any 401(k) Plan expense during the Transition Period. We used $3.5 million of 401(k) Plan forfeitures to fund our entire 401(k) Plan matching contribution for the 2009 401(k) Plan year.

The increase in business insurance of $5.9 million during the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 was the result of our claims experience for the period. During the Transition Period, we experienced an increase in the cost of workers’ compensation claims and an increase in the number of general liability claims, each of which we believe was a result of the economic environment.

The increase in occupancy related costs of $10.5 million during the Transition Period as compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 was primarily related to new store openings. New BCF stores opened during the Transition Period accounted for $4.2 million of the total increase; new BCF stores opened during this period that were not operating for a full 35 weeks during the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009 incurred incremental occupancy costs of $4.5 million during the Transition Period. Janitorial service expense increased $4.5 million ($0.4 million related to new stores) during the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 due to our initiative to replace janitorial payroll with a third party provider. Real estate taxes increased $1.0 million due primarily to annual tax rate increases. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in utilities expense of $2.7 million as a result of our ongoing initiative to reduce costs.

The increase in other selling and administrative expenses of $14.3 million during the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 was primarily due to a $7.5 million increase in our legal reserve, and a $3.0 million increase associated with the acceleration of fees associated with store physical inventories related to our change in fiscal year end.

Restructuring and Separation Costs

In an effort to better align our resources with our business objectives we reviewed all areas of the business to identify efficiency opportunities to enhance our performance in Fiscal 2009. In light of the challenging economic and retail sales environments, we accelerated the implementation of several initiatives, including some that resulted in the elimination of certain positions and the restructuring of certain other jobs and functions. Our restructuring and separation efforts commenced in the third quarter of Fiscal 2009, and continued during the Transition Period. We incurred $2.4 million and $1.9 million in restructuring and separation costs during the Transition Period and the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009, respectively.

Depreciation and Amortization

Depreciation and amortization expense related to the depreciation of fixed assets and the amortization of favorable and unfavorable leases amounted to $103.6 million during the Transition Period compared with $106.8 for the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. The decrease in depreciation and amortization expense was primarily a result of various assets that were recorded pursuant to purchase accounting in conjunction with the Merger Transaction. These assets became fully depreciated during Fiscal 2009, which resulted in less depreciation expense during the Transition Period.

 

33


Table of Contents

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

Impairment charges related to long-lived assets were $46.8 million and $28.1 million for the Transition Period and January 31, 2009, respectively. The increase in impairment charges was primarily related to the decline in the operating performance of 33 stores as a result of decreased comparative store sales.

The recoverability assessment related to these store-level assets requires judgments and estimates of future revenues, gross margin rates and store expenses. We base these estimates upon our past and expected future performance. We believe our estimates are appropriate in light of current market conditions. However, future impairment charges could be required if we do not achieve our current revenue or cash flow projections for each store.

The majority of the impairment charges during the Transition Period were related to the impairment of favorable leases in the amount of $34.6 million related to 24 of our stores. We also impaired $9.5 million of leasehold improvements, $2.3 million of furniture and fixtures and $0.4 million of other long-lived assets.

The majority of the impairment charges for the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009 was related to the impairment of favorable leases in the amount of $20.9 million related to 15 of our stores. We also impaired $5.8 million of leasehold improvements and $1.4 million of furniture and fixtures.

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

There was no impairment charge related to our tradenames during the Transition Period. Impairment charges related to our tradenames during the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 amounted to $279.3 million. In accordance with ASC Topic No. 350, “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other,” (Topic 350), we perform our annual impairment testing of goodwill and indefinite-lived assets at the beginning of each May.

In connection with the preparation of our Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for the third quarter of Fiscal 2009 (relating to the three months ended February 28, 2009) as well as our Fiscal 2009 financial statements (relating to the year ended May 30, 2009), we concluded that it was appropriate to test our goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets for recoverability in light of the following factors:

 

   

Significant declines in the U.S. and international financial markets and the resulting impact of such events on then anticipated future macroeconomic conditions and customer behavior;

 

   

The determination that these macroeconomic conditions were impacting our sales trends as evidenced by the decreases in comparative store sales that we were experiencing;

 

   

Decreased comparative store sales results of the peak holiday and winter selling seasons in the third quarter of Fiscal 2009 which were significant to our financial results for the year;

 

   

Declines in market valuation multiples of peer group companies used in the estimate of our business enterprise value; and

 

   

Our expectation that then current comparative store sales trends would continue for an extended period. As a result, we developed a more moderate store opening plan which reduced our future projections of revenue and operating results offset by initiatives (which have since been implemented) to reduce our cost structure.

The recoverability assessment with respect to the tradenames used in our operations requires us to estimate the fair value of the tradenames as of the assessment date. Such determination is made using the “relief from royalty” valuation method. Inputs to the valuation model include:

 

   

Future revenue and profitability projections associated with the tradenames;

 

   

Estimated market royalty rates that could be derived from the licensing of our tradenames to third parties in order to establish the cash flows accruing to our benefit as a result of ownership of the tradenames; and

 

   

The rate used to discount the estimated royalty cash flow projections to their present value (or estimated fair value) based on the risk and nature of our cash flows.

 

34


Table of Contents

During the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009, we recorded an impairment charge related to our tradenames in the amount of $279.3 million. This impairment charge reflected lower revenues and profitability projections associated with our tradenames at the time and lower estimated market royalty rate expectations in light of the then current general economic conditions compared with the analysis we performed during Fiscal 2008. Our projected revenues within the model were based on comparative store sales and new store assumptions over a nine year period. A less aggressive new store opening plan combined with revised comparative store sales assumptions for the first fiscal year of the projection had a significant negative impact on the valuation. We believe our estimates were appropriate based upon the then current market conditions (refer to Note 6 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Intangible Assets” for further discussion).

Other Income, net

Other income, net (consisting of investment income, gains and losses on disposition of assets, breakage income and other miscellaneous items) increased $10.6 million to $15.3 million during the Transition Period as compared with the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009.

The increase in other income during the Transition Period compared with the 35 weeks ended January 30, 2009 was primarily related to the following:

 

   

An increase in miscellaneous income of $6.0 million primarily related to a gain on a legal settlement in our favor and other miscellaneous income,

 

   

an increase in gain on investment of $5.5 million related to additional distributions received from the Reserve Primary Fund (Fund) in excess of those anticipated,

 

   

an increase of $2.1 million related to insurance recoveries, and

 

   

an increase in breakage income of $2.8 million; partially offset by

 

   

a $5.1 million decrease related to a loss on the disposal of various fixed assets primarily related to our conversion to a new warehouse management system in Edgewater Park, New Jersey.

Interest Expense

Interest expense was $59.5 million and $74.3 million during the Transition Period and the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009, respectively. The decrease in interest expense was primarily driven by lower average interest rates on our Term Loan and ABL Line of Credit and a lower average balance on our ABL Line of Credit as follows:

 

     35 Weeks Ended  
     January 30, 2010     January 31, 2009  

Average Interest Rate – ABL Line of Credit

     2.7     4.4

Average Interest Rate – Term Loan

     2.6     4.8

Average Balance – ABL Line of Credit

   $ 31.5 Million      $ 219.5 Million   

Average Balance – Term Loan

   $ 867.0 Million      $ 872.8 Million   

Offsetting the decrease in interest expense were smaller gains on the adjustments of our interest rate cap agreements to fair value during the Transition Period as compared to the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. Our interest rate cap agreements are discussed in more detail in Item 7A, Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk and Note 9 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Derivatives and Hedging Activities.” Adjustments of the interest rate cap agreements to fair value resulted in gains of $0.5 million and $2.7 million during the Transition Period and the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009, respectively, each of which were recorded in the line item “Interest Expense” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income.

 

35


Table of Contents

Income Tax Expense

Income tax expense was $11.6 million during the Transition Period compared with an income tax benefit of $104.7 million for the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. The effective tax rates were 38.3% and 40.2%, respectively, for the Transition Period and the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009. The decrease in the effective tax rate was primarily due to a change in the valuation allowance for state net operating losses and lower state blended tax rates, which had the effect of reducing our net deferred tax liability and decreasing our income tax expense.

Net Income

Net income amounted to $18.7 million during the Transition Period compared with a net loss of $155.6 million for the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. The increase in our operating results of $174.3 million was primarily attributable to fewer impairments.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

We fund inventory expenditures during normal and peak periods through cash flows from operating activities, available cash, and our ABL Line of Credit. Liquidity may be affected by the terms we are able to obtain from vendors and their factors. Our working capital needs follow a seasonal pattern, peaking each October and November when inventory is received for the Fall selling season. Our largest source of operating cash flows is cash collections from our customers. In general, our primary uses of cash are providing for working capital, which principally represents the purchase of inventory, the payment of operating expenses, debt servicing, and opening of new stores and remodeling of existing stores. As of January 28, 2012, we had unused availability on our ABL Line of Credit of $242.6 million.

Our ability to satisfy our interest payment obligations on our outstanding debt and maintain compliance with our debt covenants, as discussed below, will depend largely on our future performance which, in turn, is subject to prevailing economic conditions and to financial, business and other factors beyond our control. If we do not have sufficient cash flow to service interest payment obligations on our outstanding indebtedness and if we cannot borrow or obtain equity financing to satisfy those obligations, our business and results of operations will be materially adversely affected. We cannot be assured that any replacement borrowing or equity financing could be successfully completed on terms similar to our current financing agreements, or at all.

We closely monitor our net sales, gross margin, expenses and working capital. We have performed scenario planning such that if our net sales decline, we have identified variable costs that could be reduced to partially mitigate the impact of these declines and maintain compliance with our debt covenants. We believe that cash generated from operations, along with our existing cash and our ABL Line of Credit, will be sufficient to fund our expected cash flow requirements and planned capital expenditures for at least the next twelve months as well as the foreseeable future. However, there can be no assurance that we would be able to offset declines in our comparative store sales with savings initiatives in the event that the economy declines.

As discussed previously under section “Debt Refinancing and Dividend” and later in Note 10 to the our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Long Term Debt,” during the first quarter of Fiscal 2011 we completed the refinancing of our Previous Term Loan Facility, Previous Senior Notes, and Previous Senior Discount Notes. As a result of these transactions, the Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes were repurchased. In addition, BCFWC completed the sale of the Notes at an issue price of 100%. Additionally, the Previous Term Loan was replaced with our New Term Loan Facility. In connection with the offering of the Notes and the refinancing of the Previous Term Loan Facility, a cash dividend of $300.0 million in the aggregate was declared to the equity holders of Parent on a pro rata basis. In addition, on September 2, 2011, we completed an amendment and restatement of the credit agreement governing our $600 million ABL Line of Credit, which, among other things, extended the maturity date to September 2, 2016.

Our New Term Loan agreement contains financial, affirmative and negative covenants and requires that we, among other things, maintain on the last day of each fiscal quarter a consolidated leverage ratio not to exceed a maximum amount and maintain a consolidated interest coverage ratio of at least a certain amount. The consolidated leverage ratio compares our total debt to Adjusted EBITDA, as each term is defined in the credit agreement governing the New Term Loan, for the trailing twelve months most recently ended, and such ratio may not exceed 6.75 to 1 through October 27, 2012; 6.25 to 1 through November 2, 2013; 5.50 to 1 through November 1, 2014; 5.00 to 1 through October 31, 2015; and 4.75 to 1 at January 30, 2016 and thereafter. The consolidated interest coverage ratio compares our consolidated interest expense to Adjusted EBITDA, as each term is defined in the credit agreement governing the New Term Loan, for the trailing twelve months most recently ended, and such ratio must exceed 1.75 to 1 through October 27, 2012; 1.85 to 1 through November 2, 2013; 2.00 to 1 through October 31, 2015; and 2.10 to 1 at January 30, 2016 and thereafter.

Adjusted EBITDA is a non-GAAP financial measure of our liquidity. Adjusted EBITDA, as defined in the credit agreement governing our Term Loan, starts with consolidated net income (loss) for the period and adds back (i) depreciation, amortization, impairments and other non-cash charges that were deducted in arriving at consolidated net income (loss), (ii) the provision (benefit) for taxes, (iii) interest expense, (iv) advisory fees, and (v) unusual, non-recurring or extraordinary

 

36


Table of Contents

expenses, losses or charges as reasonably approved by the administrative agent for such period. Adjusted EBITDA is used to calculate the consolidated leverage ratio and the consolidated interest coverage ratio. We present Adjusted EBITDA because we believe it is a useful supplemental measure in evaluating the performance of our business and provides greater transparency into our results of operations. Adjusted EBITDA provides management, including our chief operating decision maker, with helpful information with respect to our operations such as our ability to meet our future debt service, fund our capital expenditures and working capital requirements, and comply with various covenants in each indenture governing our outstanding notes and the credit agreements governing our senior secured credit facilities which are material to our financial condition and financial statements. As of January 28, 2012, we were in compliance with all of our covenants under our New Term Loan Facility.

Given the importance Adjusted EBITDA has on our operations, achievement at a predetermined threshold Adjusted EBITDA level is required for the payment of incentive awards to our corporate employees under our Management Incentive Bonus Plan (Bonus Plan) for Fiscal 2011. The Bonus Plan is more fully described under the caption “Annual Incentive Awards” in Item 11, Executive Compensation.

Adjusted EBITDA has limitations as an analytical tool, and should not be considered either in isolation or as a substitute for net income or other data prepared in accordance with GAAP or for analyzing our results or cash flows from operating activities, as reported under GAAP. Some of these limitations include:

 

   

Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect changes in, or cash requirements for, our working capital needs;

 

   

Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect our interest expense, or the cash requirements necessary to service interest or principal payments, on our debt;

 

   

Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect our income tax expense or the cash requirements to pay our taxes;

 

   

Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect historical cash expenditures or future requirements for capital expenditures or contractual commitments;

 

   

Although depreciation and amortization are non-cash charges, the assets being depreciated and amortized will likely have to be replaced in the future, and Adjusted EBITDA measures do not reflect any cash requirements for such replacements; and

 

   

Other companies in our industry may calculate Adjusted EBITDA differently such that our calculation may not be directly comparable.

Adjusted EBITDA for Fiscal 2011 increased $11.9 million, or 3.5%, to $350.0 million from $338.1 million for Fiscal 2010. This improvement in Adjusted EBITDA was primarily the result of increased net sales.

Adjusted EBITDA for Fiscal 2010 increased $31.3 million, or 10.2%, to $338.1 million from $306.8 million for the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. This improvement in Adjusted EBITDA was primarily the result of increased net sales and the cost reductions realized during Fiscal 2010.

Adjusted EBITDA for Fiscal 2010 increased $77.6 million, or 29.8%, to $338.1 million from $260.5 million for the Transition Period. This improvement in Adjusted EBITDA was primarily the result of an additional 17 weeks of operations during Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period.

Adjusted EBITDA for the Transition Period increased $12.0 million, or 4.8%, to $260.5 million from $248.5 million for the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. This improvement in Adjusted EBITDA was primarily the result of the cost reductions realized during the Transition Period.

 

37


Table of Contents

The following table shows our calculation of Adjusted EBITDA for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010, the Transition Period, the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 and Fiscal 2009, each of which were derived from audited and unaudited financial information.

 

     (in thousands)  
     Years Ended     52 Weeks
Ended
    35 Weeks Ended     Year
Ended
 
     January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
    January 30,
2010
    January 30,
2010
    January 31,
2009
    May 30,
2009
 

Reconciliation of Net Income (Loss) to Adjusted EBITDA:

            

Net (Loss) Income

   $ (6,272   $ 30,998      $ (15,179   $ 18,653      $ (155,643     (191,583

Interest Expense

     129,121        99,309        84,423        59,476        74,263        102,716   

Income Tax (Benefit) Expense

     (4,148     22,130        (29,753     11,570        (104,667     (147,389

Depreciation and Amortization

     153,070        146,759        156,388        103,605        106,823        159,607   

Impairment Charges - Long-Lived Assets

     1,735        2,080        56,141        46,776        28,134        37,498   

Impairment Charges - Tradenames

     —          —          15,250        —          279,300        294,550   

Interest Income

     (82     (384     (303     (196     (535     (641

Non Cash Straight-Line Rent Expense (a)

     9,211        10,639        5,320        4,196        6,236        7,358   

Advisory Fees (b)

     4,285        4,289        4,198        2,879        3,342        4,660   

Stock Compensation Expense (c)

     5,797        2,230        4,391        994        2,728        6,124   

SOX Compliance (d)

     —          —          112        —          1,077        1,189   

(Gain) Loss on Investment in Money Market Fund (e)

     —          (240     (859     (3,849     1,669        4,661   

Amortization of Purchased Lease Rights (f)

     901        857        896        560        620        893   

Severance (g)

     7,438        81        3,097        2,264        1,929        2,737   

Franchise Taxes (h)

     1,498        1,172        1,620        751        631        1,500   

Insurance Reserve (i)

     —          3,916        9,037        3,731        255        5,561   

Advertising Expense Related to Barter Transactions (j)

     4,864        2,644        2,275        1,816        1,875        2,334   

CEO Transition Costs (k)

     —          —          2,147        —          —          2,173   

Loss on Disposal of Fixed Assets (l)

     2,673        1,740        6,160        5,824        468        805   

Change in Fiscal Year End Costs (m)

     —          587        1,445        1,445        —          —     

Litigation Reserve (n)

     2,618        4,923        —          —          —          —     

Transfer Tax (o)

     (20     1,358        —          —          —          —     

Refinancing Fees (p)

     (473     3,040        —          —          —          —     

Loss on Extinguishment of Debt (q)

     37,764        —          —          —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 349,980      $ 338,128      $ 306,806      $ 260,495      $ 248,505        294,753   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities:

            

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 349,980      $ 338,128        306,806      $ 260,495      $ 248,505      $ 294,753   

Interest Expense

     (129,121     (99,309     (84,423     (59,476     (74,263     (102,716

Changes in Operating Assets and Liabilities

     37,311        (27,405     (220,884     (72,323     118,846        (30,929

Other Items, Net

     (8,187     (2,710     6,481        (25,169     (25,245     11,188   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities

   $ 249,983      $ 208,704        7,980      $ 103,527      $ 267,843      $ 172,296   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

   $ (158,773   $ (159,962     (89,465   $ (54,074   $ (109,887   $ (145,280
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash (Used in) Provided by Financing Activities

   $ (85,760   $ (43,278     64,529      $ (50,513   $ (156,351   $ (41,307
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

During Fiscal 2011, with approval from the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit, we changed the components comprising Adjusted EBITDA such that specific charges associated with our debt refinancing transaction were added back to consolidated net (loss) income when calculating Adjusted EBITDA. These changes, summarized in footnote (q) below, resulted in approximately $37.8 million in Adjusted EBITDA during Fiscal 2011 and had no impact on the prior periods presented. We believe that these add-backs provide a more accurate comparison to the comparative periods’ performance.

 

(a) Represents the difference between the actual base rent and rent expense calculated in accordance with GAAP (on a straight line basis), in accordance with the credit agreements governing the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.

 

38


Table of Contents
(b) Represents the annual advisory fee of Bain Capital expensed during the fiscal periods, in accordance with the credit agreements governing the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(c) Represents expenses recorded under ASC No. 718 “Stock Compensation” during the fiscal periods, in accordance with the credit agreements governing the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(d) As a voluntary non-accelerated filer, we furnished our initial management report on Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for Fiscal 2008. These costs represent professional fees related to this compliance effort that were incurred during Fiscal 2008 and the first quarter of Fiscal 2009, as well as fees incurred as part of our ongoing internal controls compliance effort for Fiscal 2009, as approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(e) Represents the (gain) loss on our investment in the Reserve Primary Fund (Fund), related to recoveries/declines in the fair value of the underlying securities held by the Fund, as approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(f) Represents amortization of purchased lease rights which are recorded in rent expense within our selling and administrative line items, in accordance with the credit agreements governing the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(g) Represents a severance charge resulting from a reorganization of certain positions within our stores and corporate locations in Fiscal 2011 and reduction of our workforce during Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, in accordance with the credit agreements governing the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(h) Represents franchise taxes paid based on our equity, as approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(i) Represents the non-cash change in reserves based on estimated general liability, workers compensation and health insurance claims as approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(j) Represents non-cash advertising expense based on the usage of barter advertising credits obtained as part of a non-cash exchange of inventory, as approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(k) Represents recruiting costs incurred in connection with the hiring of our new President and Chief Executive Officer on December 2, 2008, and other benefits payable to our former President and Chief Executive Officer pursuant to the separation agreement we entered into with him on February 16, 2009. Both of these adjustments were approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(l) Represents the gross non-cash loss recorded on the disposal of certain assets in the ordinary course of business, in accordance with the credit agreements governing the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(m) Represents costs incurred in conjunction with changing our fiscal year end from the Saturday closest to May 31 to the Saturday closest to January 31 commencing with the 35 weeks ended January 30, 2010. This change was approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and ABL Line of Credit.
(n) Represents charges incurred in conjunction with a non-recurring litigation reserve as approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and the ABL Line of Credit.
(o) Represents one-time transfer taxes incurred on certain leased properties as approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and the ABL Line of Credit.
(p) Represents refinancing fees that reduce Adjusted EBITDA per the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and the ABL Line of Credit.
(q) Represents charges incurred in accordance with Topic No. 470, resulting from a loss on the settlement of the old debt instruments as approved by the administrative agents for the New Term Loan Facility and the ABL Line of Credit.

Cash Flows

Cash Flows for Fiscal 2011 Compared with Fiscal 2010

We generated $5.5 million of cash flow for both Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010. Net cash provided by operating activities amounted to $250.0 million and $208.7 million for Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010, respectively. The increase in net cash provided by operating activities was primarily the result of our working capital management strategy employed at the end of Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period in which we accelerated $237.7 million and $274.8 million, respectively, of payments that typically would not have been made until the first quarters of Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010, respectively. In comparison, during Fiscal 2011, we made accelerated payments of $152.9 million that would not have been made until the first quarter of Fiscal 2012.

Net cash used in investing activities decreased $1.2 million to $158.8 million during Fiscal 2011 from $160.0 million during Fiscal 2010. This decrease was primarily the result of $23.1 million less cash being designated as restricted during Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010 partially offset by $21.3 million of additional capital expenditures primarily related to new stores opened during Fiscal 2011. During Fiscal 2010, the Company reclassified $27.8 million as restricted cash related to the establishment of collateral for self-insurance in lieu of a letter of credit for certain insurance contracts.

 

39


Table of Contents

Net cash used in financing activities increased $42.5 million to $85.8 million during Fiscal 2011 compared with Fiscal 2010. Increased use of cash in financing activities was primarily related to the payment of $297.9 million of dividends paid in conjunction with our February 2011 debt refinancing transaction. This increase was partially offset by the net impact of the increase in borrowings in conjunction with the debt refinancing transaction.

Cash flow and working capital levels assist management in measuring our ability to meet our cash requirements. Working capital measures our current financial position. Working capital is defined as current assets (exclusive of restricted cash) less current liabilities. Working capital at January 28, 2012 was $337.9 million compared with $386.2 million at January 29, 2011. The decrease in working capital from January 29, 2011 is primarily attributable to increased accounts payable balances at January 28, 2012, related to our working capital management strategy whereby we accelerated less payments in Fiscal 2011 than we did in Fiscal 2010, partially offset by increased inventory, as a result of increased purchases related to opportunistic buys as well as new store inventory.

Net cash flows for Fiscal 2010, as derived from audited financial statements, the 52 week period January 30, 2010, as derived from unaudited financial statements, the Transition Period, as derived from audited financial statements, and the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009, as derived from unaudited financial statements, were as follows:

 

     Year Ended
January 29,
2011
    52 Weeks
Ended
January 30,

2010
    35 Weeks
Ended
January 30,

2010
    35 Weeks
Ended
January 31,
2009
 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

        

Net Income (Loss)

   $ 30,998      $ (15,179 )   $ 18,653      $ (155,643

Adjustments to Reconcile Net Income (Loss) to Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities:

        

Depreciation and Amortization

     146,759        156,388        103,605        106,823   

Amortization of Debt Issuance Costs

     12,346        11,616        8,238        6,957   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     2,080        56,141        46,776        28,134   

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

     —          15,250        —          279,300   

Accretion of Senior Notes and Senior Discount Notes

     733        655        449        402   

Interest Rate Cap Contracts-Adjustment to Market

     5,500        (5,443     (455     (2,692

Provision for Losses on Accounts Receivable

     2,098        2,799        1,993        2,026   

Provision for Deferred Income Taxes

     886        (25,931     (19,815     (137,494

Loss on Disposition of Fixed Assets and Leasehold Improvements

     1,539        5,417        5,386        266   

(Gain) Loss on Investments in Money Market Fund

     (240     (857     (3,849     1,669   

Non-Cash Stock Option Expense

     2,230        4,390        994        2,728   

Non-Cash Rent Expense

     (1,485     (5,334     (3,327     1,711   

Changes in Assets and Liabilities:

        

Accounts Receivable

     (1,168     (1,316     (3,638     (5,649

Merchandise Inventories

     (30,933     81,743        28,538        24,491   

Prepaid and Other Current Assets

     (18,272     (6,763 )     2,013        1,238   

Accounts Payable

     50,659        (258,826     (89,955     61,588   

Other Current Liabilities and Income Tax Payable

     (28,183     (23,510     (8,737     24,517   

Deferred Rent Incentives

     19,429        13,285        7,649        36,246   

Other Long-Term Assets and Long-Term Liabilities

     13,728        3,455        9,009        (8,775
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Provided by Operations

     208,704        7,980        103,527        267,843   

INVESTING ACTIVITIES

        

Cash Paid for Property and Equipment

     (132,131     (94,070     (60,035     (95,922

Change in Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     (27,659     (315 )     17        402   

(Expenses) Proceeds From Sale of Property and Equipment and Assets Held for Sale

     (38     1,320        1,062        111   

Lease Acquisition Costs

     (422     (1,337 )     —          (2,391

Lease Rights Acquired

     —          —          —          (250

Purchase of Tradename Rights

     —          (6,250     —          —     

Issuance of Notes Receivable

     —          —          —          —     

Redesignation of Cash Equivalents to Investment in Money Market Fund

     —          —          —          (56,294

Redemption of Investment in Money Market Fund

     240        11,115        4,844        44,367   

Purchase of Tradenames Rights

     —          —          —          —     

Other

     48        72        38        90   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

     (159,962     (89,465     (54,074     (109,887

FINANCING ACTIVITIES

        

Proceeds from Long Term Debt—ABL Line of Credit

     204,200        715,115        444,315        601,851   

Principal Payments on Long Term Debt—ABL Line of Credit

     (156,800     (623,915     (473,422     (753,451

Principal Payments on Long Term Debt

     (1,998     (1,743     (1,537     (1,391

Principal Payments on Long Term Debt—Term Loan

     (87,202     (8,055     (5,998     —     

Purchase of Interest Rate Cap Contract

     —          —          —          —     

Payment of Dividends

     (251     (3,214     (212     (3,360

Debt Issuance Costs

     (1,227     (13,659     (13,659     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash (Used in) Provided by Financing Activities

     (43,278     64,529        (50,513     (156,351
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents

     5,464        (16,956     (1,060     1,605   

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Period

     24,750        41,706        25,810        40,101   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period

   $ 30,214      $ 24,750      $ 24,750      $ 41,706   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information:

        

Interest Paid

   $ 79,187      $ 80,610      $ 47,963      $ 55,110   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income Tax Payment (Refund), Net

   $ 41,505      $ 34,979      $ 48,764      $ 8,444   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-Cash Investing Activities:

        

Accrued Purchases of Property and Equipment

   $ 17,606      $ 10,667      $ 10,667      $ 1,064   

Notes Receivable from Sale of Assets Held for Sale

   $ —        $ (2,000   $ (2,000   $ —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

40


Table of Contents

Cash Flows for the 52 Weeks Ended January 29, 2011 (Fiscal 2010) Compared with the 52 Weeks Ended January 30, 2010

We generated $5.5 million of cash flow for Fiscal 2010 compared with using $17.0 million of cash flow for the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010. Net cash provided by operating activities amounted to $208.7 million for Fiscal 2010. For the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010, net cash provided by operating activities was $8.0 million. The increase in net cash provided by operating activities was primarily the result of our working capital management strategy at the end of Fiscal 2010 and the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 in which we accelerated $237.7 million and $274.8 million, respectively, of payments that typically would not have been made until the first quarters of Fiscal 2010 and Fiscal 2011, respectively. Because our fiscal year end had not changed at the time, there was no working capital management strategy employed at January 31, 2009. The working capital management strategy resulted in a significant amount of cash outflows during the twelve months ended January 30, 2010 as the result of paying accounts payable in the normal course during the period and then accelerating payments at the end of the period that typically would not have been paid until after January 30, 2010. The repeat of the working capital management strategy at the end of Fiscal 2010, which accelerated Fiscal 2011 payments into Fiscal 2010 did not have as great an impact on cash flow in Fiscal 2010 as it did in the prior fiscal year because there were fewer accounts payable paid during Fiscal 2010 due to the fact that the working capital management strategy during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 had advanced payment of approximately the first two months of the accounts payable for Fiscal 2010.

 

41


Table of Contents

The increase in net cash flows provided by operating activities was partially offset by an increase in net cash used in investing and financing activities. Net cash used in investing activities increased to $160.0 million during Fiscal 2010 from $89.5 million for the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. This increase was primarily the result of increased capital expenditures during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010. Capital expenditures increased $38.1 million for Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010 due to more store openings during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. Also contributing to the increased use of cash in investing activities was $27.7 million of cash being designated as restricted cash used as collateral, in lieu of a letter of credit, related to certain self-insurance contracts.

Net cash used in financing activities increased $107.8 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010. Increased use of cash in financing activities was primarily related to repayments on our Term Loan, which amounted to $87.2 million and $8.1 million, respectively, for Fiscal 2010 and the 52 week period ended January 30, 2010. Also contributing to the increased use of cash in financing activities was a decrease in our ABL borrowings, net of repayments. During Fiscal 2010 we borrowed $47.4 million, net of repayments, compared with $91.2 million of borrowings, net of repayments, during the 52 weeks ended January 30, 2010.

Cash flow and working capital levels assist management in measuring our ability to meet our cash requirements. Working capital measures our current financial position. Working capital is defined as current assets (exclusive of restricted cash) less current liabilities. Working capital at January 29, 2011 was $386.2 million compared with $349.7 million at January 30, 2010. The increase in working capital was primarily the result of increased inventory and accounts receivable balances as of January 29, 2011 compared with January 30, 2010 due to new stores opened during Fiscal 2010.

Cash Flows for the 52 Weeks Ended January 29, 2011 (Fiscal 2010) Compared with the 35 Weeks Ended January 30, 2010 (Transition Period)

Cash and cash equivalents increased $5.5 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with a decline of $1.1 million during the Transition Period. Net cash provided by operating activities increased to $208.7 million during Fiscal 2010 from $103.5 million during the Transition Period. The $105.2 million increase in net cash provided by operating activities was primarily the result of the acceleration of $237.7 million and $274.8 million of accounts payable payments at the end of Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period, respectively, as part of our working capital management strategy. As the working capital management strategy was not employed at January 31, 2009, the Transition Period had a higher accounts payable balance during the year as compared with Fiscal 2010, resulting in a larger decrease in the accounts payable balance after the accelerated payment was made at January 30, 2010. The decrease in accounts payable due to the working capital management strategy was partially offset by an increase in inventory due to more new stores opened during Fiscal 2010.

The increase in net cash provided by operating activities was partially offset by increased net cash used in investing activities. Net cash used in investing activities increased $105.9 million to $160.0 million during Fiscal 2010 from $54.1 million used during the Transition Period. The increase in net cash used in investing activities was primarily related to increased capital expenditures related to 18 net new stores opened during Fiscal 2010 compared with 9 new stores opened during the Transition Period. Also contributing to the increased use of cash in investing activities was an additional $27.7 million of cash being designated as restricted cash used as collateral, in lieu of a letter of credit, related to certain self-insurance contracts.

Net cash used in financing activities decreased $7.2 million during Fiscal 2010 compared with the Transition Period. The decreased use of cash in financing activities was primarily related to repayments on our Term Loan partially offset by ABL borrowings. Repayments on our Term Loan amounted to $87.2 million and $6.0 million, respectively, for Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period. The decreased use of cash in financing activities was a partially offset by an increase in our ABL borrowings, net of repayments. During Fiscal 2010 we borrowed $47.4 million, net of repayments, compared with $29.1 million of repayments, net of borrowings, during the Transition Period.

Cash Flows for the 35 Weeks Ended January 30, 2010 (Transition Period) Compared with the 35 Weeks Ended January 31, 2009

Cash and cash equivalents declined $1.1 million during the Transition Period compared with generating $1.6 million of cash flow for the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009. Net cash provided by operating activities amounted to $103.5 million during the Transition Period. For the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009, net cash provided by operating activities was $267.8 million. The decrease in net cash provided by operating activities was primarily the result of our working capital management strategy at the end of the Transition Period in which we accelerated $274.8 million of payments that typically would not have been made until the first quarter of Fiscal 2010. This lowered our accounts payable balance at the end of the Transition Period which resulted in a decrease in accounts payable for the 35 weeks ended January 30, 2010 of $151.5 million compared with the 35 week period of Fiscal 2009. There was no such working capital management strategy in place during the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009.

 

42


Table of Contents

The decrease in net cash flows provided by operating activities was partially offset by improvements in net cash used in investing and financing activities. Net cash used in investing activities decreased to $54.1 million for the 35 weeks ended January 30, 2010 from $109.9 million for the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. This reduction was primarily the result of decreased capital expenditures during the 35 weeks ended January 30, 2010 compared with the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009. Capital expenditures decreased $35.9 million for the 35 weeks ended January 30, 2010 compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009 due to fewer store openings during the 35 weeks ended January 30, 2010 compared with the first 35 weeks of Fiscal 2009.

Net cash used in financing activities decreased $105.8 million during the 35 weeks ended January 30, 2010 compared with the 35 weeks ended January 31, 2009. The decreased use of cash in financing activities was primarily related to repayments, net of borrowings, on our ABL Line of Credit. Repayments, net of borrowings, on our ABL Line of Credit amounted to $29.1 million and $151.6 million, respectively, during the Transition Period and the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009.

Working capital at January 30, 2010 was $349.7 million compared with $179.7 million at January 31, 2009. The increase in working capital was primarily the result of decreased accounts payable as of January 30, 2010 compared with January 31, 2009 due to our working capital management strategy.

Operational Growth

During Fiscal 2011, we opened 20 new BCF stores, and closed one BCF store, one MJM store and one Super Baby Depot. The MJM store and the Super Baby Depot were in the same shopping center as an existing BCF store, which was expanded and remodeled to absorb both businesses. As of January 28, 2012, we operated 477 stores under the names “Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse” (461 stores), “Cohoes Fashions” (two stores), “MJM Designer Shoes” (13 stores) and “Super Baby Depot” (one store).

We monitor the availability of desirable locations for our stores by, among other things, presentations by brokers, real estate developers and existing landlords, evaluating dispositions by other retail chains and bankruptcy auctions. Most of our stores are located in malls, strip shopping centers, regional power centers or are freestanding. We also lease existing space and have opened a limited number of built-to-suit locations. For most of our new leases, we provide for a minimum initial ten year term with a number of five year options thereafter. Typically, our lease strategy includes obtaining landlord allowances for leasehold improvements. We believe our lease model makes us competitive with other retailers for desirable locations. We may seek to acquire a number of such locations either through transactions to acquire individual locations or transactions that involve the acquisition of multiple locations simultaneously.

From time to time we make available for sale certain assets based on current market conditions. These assets are recorded in the line item “Assets Held for Disposal” in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. Based on prevailing market conditions, we may determine that it is no longer advantageous to continue marketing certain assets and will reclassify those assets out of the line item “Assets Held for Disposal” and into the respective asset category based on the lesser of their carrying value or fair value less cost to sell.

Debt

Holdings and each of our current wholly owned subsidiaries, except one subsidiary which is considered minor, have fully, jointly, severally and unconditionally guaranteed BCFWC’s obligations pursuant to the $600 million ABL Line of Credit, $1,000 million New Term Loan Facility and the $450 million of Notes due in 2019. As of January 28, 2012, we were in compliance with all of our debt covenants. Significant changes in our debt consist of the following:

Senior Notes and Senior Discount Notes

Senior Notes Offering and Extinguishment of Previous Notes

On February 24, 2011, BCFW issued $450.0 million aggregate principal amount of 10% Senior Notes due 2019 at an issue price of 100% (the Notes). The Notes were issued pursuant to an indenture, dated February 24, 2011 (the Indenture), among BCFWC, the guarantors signatory thereto, and Wilmington Trust FSB.

The Notes are senior unsecured obligations of BCFW and are guaranteed on a senior basis by BCFW, the Company and each of BCFW’s U.S. subsidiaries to the extent such guarantor is a guarantor of BCFW’s obligations under the New Term Loan Facility (as defined below). Interest is payable on the Notes on each February 15 and August 15, commencing August 15, 2011.

In connection with the issuance of the Notes, on February 24, 2011, BCFW entered into a registration rights agreement relating to the Notes, pursuant to which BCFW agreed to use its reasonable best efforts to file, and did initially file on July 15, 2011, the Exchange Offer Registration Statement, enabling holders to exchange the Notes for registered notes with terms

 

43


Table of Contents

substantially identical in all material respects to the Notes, except the exchange notes would be freely tradable. On October 19, 2011, the Exchange Offer Registration Statement was declared effective by the SEC, and we completed the exchange offer on December 2, 2011. The Previous Notes were purchased or redeemed in connection with the issuance of the Notes.

$1 Billion Senior Secured Term Loan Facility

In connection with the offering of the Notes, on February 24, 2011, BCFW refinanced its Previous Term Loan Facility with the proceeds of a $1,000.0 million New Term Loan Facility.

Like the Previous Term Loan Facility, the New Term Loan Facility is secured by (a) a perfected first priority lien on BCFW’s real estate, favorable leases, and machinery and equipment and (b) a perfected second priority lien on BCFW’s inventory and receivables, in each case subject to various limitations and exceptions. The New Term Loan Facility is to be repaid in quarterly payments of $2.5 million from January 30, 2016 to January 28, 2017, with the balance of the New Term Loan Facility due upon maturity on February 23, 2017. Beginning with the fiscal year ending on January 28, 2012, at the end of each fiscal year, BCFW is required to make a payment based on its available free cash flow (as defined in the credit agreement governing the New Term Loan Facility). This payment offsets future mandatory quarterly payments. During Fiscal 2011 the Company made $42.5 million of prepayments on the New Term Loan which will offset the mandatory quarterly payments through the second quarter of the Fiscal 2015. Based on our free cash flow calculation as of January 28, 2012, we were required to make an additional payment of $7.0 million. This payment further offsets our future mandatory quarterly payments through October 31, 2015 as well as a portion of the mandatory quarterly payment due on January 30, 2016.

The New Term Loan Facility contains financial, affirmative and negative covenants and requires that BCFW, among other things, maintain on the last day of each fiscal quarter a consolidated leverage ratio not to exceed a maximum amount and maintain a consolidated interest coverage ratio of at least a certain amount. The consolidated leverage ratio compares our total debt to Adjusted EBITDA, as each term is defined in the credit agreement governing the New Term Loan Facility (the New Term Loan Credit Agreement), for the trailing twelve months most recently ended and such ratios may not exceed 6.75 to 1 through October 27, 2012; 6.25 to 1 through November 2, 2013; 5.50 to 1 through November 1, 2014; 5.00 to 1 through October 31, 2015; and 4.75 to 1 at January 30, 2016 and thereafter.

The consolidated interest coverage ratio compares our consolidated interest expense to Adjusted EBITDA, as each term is defined in the New Term Loan Credit Agreement, for the trailing twelve months most recently ended, and such ratios must exceed 1.75 to 1 through October 27, 2012; 1.85 to 1 through November 2, 2013; 2.00 to 1 through October 31, 2015; and 2.10 to 1 at January 30, 2016 and thereafter. Adjusted EBITDA is a non-GAAP financial measure of our liquidity. Adjusted EBITDA, as defined in the credit agreement governing our New Term Loan, starts with consolidated net (loss) income for the period and adds back (i) depreciation, amortization, impairments and other non-cash charges that were deducted in arriving at consolidated net loss, (ii) the (benefit) provision for taxes, (iii) interest expense, (iv) advisory fees, and (v) unusual, non-recurring or extraordinary expenses, losses or charges as reasonably approved by the administrative agent for such period.

The interest rates for the New Term Loan Facility are based on: (i) for LIBO rate loans for any interest period, at a rate per annum equal to (a) the greater of (x) the LIBO rate as determined by the Term Loan Administrative Agent, for such interest period multiplied by the Statutory Reserve Rate (as defined in the New Term Loan Credit Agreement) and (y) 1.50% (the New Term Loan Adjusted LIBO Rate), plus an applicable margin; and (ii) for prime rate loans, a rate per annum equal to the highest of (a) the variable annual rate of interest then announced by JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. at its head office as its “prime rate,” (b) the federal funds rate in effect on such date plus 0.50% per annum, and (c) the New Term Loan Adjusted LIBO Rate for the applicable class of term loans for one-month plus 1.00%, plus, in each case, an applicable margin. The interest rate on the New Term Loan Facility was 6.3% as of January 28, 2012.

In addition, the New Term Loan Facility provides for an uncommitted incremental term loan facility of up to $150.0 million that is available subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions. The New Term Loan Facility has a six year maturity, except that term loans made in connection with the incremental term loan facility or extended in connection with the extension mechanics of the New Term Loan Facility have the maturity dates set forth in the amendments applicable to such term loans.

BCFW used the net proceeds from the offering of the Notes, together with borrowings under the New Term Loan Facility and the ABL Line of Credit, to (i) repurchase any and all of the outstanding Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes, pursuant to cash tender offers commenced by BCFW and the Company on February 9, 2011, and to redeem any Previous Notes that remained outstanding after the completion of the cash tender offers, and pay related fees and expenses, including tender or redemption premiums and accrued interest on the Previous Notes, (ii) to repay the indebtedness under the Previous Term Loan Facility and (iii) to pay a special cash dividend of approximately $300.0 million in the aggregate to the equity holders of the Parent on a pro rata basis, and to pay related fees and expenses.

In accordance with ASC Topic No. 470-50, “Debt – Modifications and Extinguishments” (Topic No. 470), the transactions noted above were determined to be an extinguishment of the existing debt and an issuance of new debt. As a result, the Company recorded a loss on the extinguishment of debt in the amount of $37.8 million in the line item “Loss on Extinguishment of Debt” in

 

44


Table of Contents

its Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss. Of the $37.8 million loss on the extinguishment of debt, $21.4 million represented early call premiums that the Company paid to the holders of its Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes as a result of repurchasing both notes prior to their maturity. The remaining $16.4 million represented the write off of deferred financing fees related to the extinguished debt facilities.

In conjunction with the issuance of the new debt facilities, the Company paid $25.3 million of legal, consulting, audit related and placement fees. These costs were all deferred and recorded in the line item “Other Assets” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets and will be amortized through the line item “Interest Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss over the respective lives of the new debt facilities using the interest method.

ABL Line of Credit

On September 2, 2011, the Company completed an amendment and restatement of the credit agreement governing the Company’s $600 million ABL Line of Credit, which, among other things, extended the maturity date to September 2, 2016. The aggregate amount of commitments under the amended and restated credit agreement is $600 million and, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, the Company may increase the aggregate amount of commitments up to $900 million. Interest rates under the amended and restated credit agreement are based on LIBO rates as determined by the administrative agent plus an applicable margin of 1.75% to 2.25% based on daily availability, or various prime rate loan options plus an applicable margin of 0.75% to 1.25% based on daily availability. The fee on the average daily balance of unused loan commitments is 0.375%.

The Company believes that the amended and restated credit agreement provides the liquidity and flexibility to meet its operating and capital requirements over the next five years. Further, the calculation of the borrowing base under the amended and restated credit agreement has been amended to allow for increased availability, particularly during the September 1st through December 15th period of each year. As a result of the amended and restated credit agreement, the Company capitalized $4.2 million in deferred debt charges that will be expensed over the life of the amended and restated credit agreement and has written off $4.7 million in deferred charges from the existing credit agreement.

Capital Expenditures

We incurred capital expenditures of $116.4 million, net of $32.4 million of landlord allowances, during Fiscal 2011. These capital expenditures include $62.2 million (net of the $32.4 million of landlord allowances) for store expenditures, $14.2 million for upgrades of distribution facilities, and $40.0 million for IT software and other capital expenditures.

For Fiscal 2012, we estimate that we will spend between $130 million and $140 million, net of the benefit of landlord allowances of approximately $30 million, for store openings, improvements to distribution facilities, information technology upgrades, and other capital expenditures. Of the total planned expenditures, approximately $90 million, net of the benefit of $30 million of landlord allowances, is currently expected for expenditures related to new stores, relocations and other store requirements. Capital of approximately $20 million is expected to support information technology and the remaining capital is currently expected to support continued distribution facility enhancements and other initiatives. As part of our growth strategy, we plan to open between 17 and 25 new BCF stores (exclusive of three relocations) and remodel/expand approximately 25 BCF stores during Fiscal 2012.

Dividends

Payment of dividends is prohibited under our credit agreements except in limited circumstances. Dividends equal to $297.9 million, $0.3 million, $0.2 million, and $3.0 million were paid during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively. During Fiscal 2011, in connection with the offering of the Notes and the refinancing of the New Term Loan Facility, a cash dividend of approximately $300.0 million, in the aggregate, was declared payable to the equity holders of Parent on a pro rata basis. The dividend was approved by the Parent’s Board of Directors in February 2011 and $297.9 million of the dividend declared was paid in Fiscal 2011 and the remaining $2.1 million was recorded in “Current Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet as of January 28, 2012 and will be paid during Fiscal 2012. Dividend payments during Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 were paid to Holdings in order to repurchase capital stock of the Parent from executives who left our employment.

 

45


Table of Contents

Certain Information Concerning Contractual Obligations

The following table sets forth certain information regarding our obligations to make future payments under current contracts as of January 28, 2012:

 

     Payments Due By Period
(in thousands)
 
     Total      Less Than
1 Year
     2-3 Years      4-5 Years      Thereafter  

Long-Term Debt Obligations (1)

   $ 1,407,500       $ 6,953       $ —         $ 10,547       $ 1,390,000   

Interest on Long-Term Debt (2)

     638,566         104,518         208,818         208,533         116,697   

Capital Lease Obligations (3)

     42,266         2,724         5,488         5,730         28,324   

Operating Lease Obligations (4)

     1,267,887         203,571         377,990         197,715         488,611   

Related Party Fees (5)

     16,830         4,000         8,000         4,830         —     

Purchase Obligations (6)

     471,621         470,029         1,592         —           —     

Topic No. 740 and Other Tax Liabilities (7)

     —           —           —           —           —     

Letters of Credit (8)

     35,300         35,300         —           —           —     

Other (9)

     1,004         1,004         —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,880,974       $ 828,099       $ 601,888       $ 427,355       $ 2,023,632   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Notes:

 

(1) Excludes interest on Long-Term Debt and the ABL Line of Credit balance as of January 28, 2012 of $190.0 million, which is not required to be paid until maturity in 2016, but may be repaid at any time prior.
(2) The interest rate related to the New Term Loan Facility was 6.3% as of January 28, 2012. The ABL Line of Credit agreement has no annual minimum principal payment requirements, and therefore principal and interest payments are excluded from the table above. Based on the ABL Line of Credit balance outstanding at January 28, 2012, interest payments would be $6.2 million within the next fiscal year, $12.4 million in the next 2 to 3 years and $9.8 million in the next 4 to 5 years.
(3) Capital Lease Obligations include future interest payments.
(4) Represents minimum rent payments for operating leases under the current terms.
(5) Represent fees to be paid to Bain Capital under the terms of our advisory agreement with them (refer to Note 18 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Related Party Transactions” for further detail).
(6) Represents commitments to purchase goods or services that have not been received as of January 28, 2012.
(7) The Topic No. 740 liabilities represent uncertain tax positions related to temporary differences. The total Topic No. 740 liability was $22.1 million exclusive of $12.5 million of interest and penalties included in our total Topic No. 740 liability neither of which is presented in the table above as we are not certain if and when these payments would be required.
(8) Represents irrevocable letters of credit guaranteeing payment and performance under certain leases, insurance contracts, debt agreements and utility agreements as of January 28, 2012 (refer to Note 17 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Commitments and Contingencies” for further discussion).
(9) Represents severance agreements with former members of management. Our agreements with each of three former employees (including our former President and Chief Executive Officer) to pay their beneficiaries $1.0 million upon their deaths for a total of $3.0 million which is not reflected in the table above because the timing of the payments is unpredictable.

During Fiscal 2007, we sold lease rights for three store locations that were previously operated by us. In the event of default by the assignee, we could be liable for obligations associated with these real estate leases which have future lease related payments (not discounted to present value) of approximately $2.4 million through the end of our fiscal year ending February 1, 2014, and which are not reflected in the table above. The scheduled future aggregate minimum rentals for these leases over the two consecutive fiscal years following Fiscal 2011 are $1.6 million and $0.8 million, respectively. We believe the likelihood of a material liability being triggered under these leases is remote, and no liability has been accrued for these contingent lease obligations as of January 28, 2012.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

Our Consolidated Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (GAAP). We believe there are several accounting policies that are critical to understanding our historical and future performance as these policies affect the reported amounts of revenues and other significant areas that involve management’s judgments and estimates. The preparation of our financial statements requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect (i) the reported amounts of assets and liabilities; (ii) the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the

 

46


Table of Contents

date of the Consolidated Financial Statements; and (iii) the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. On an ongoing basis, management evaluates its estimates and judgments, including those related to revenue recognition, inventories, long-lived assets, intangible assets, goodwill impairment, insurance reserves and income taxes. Historical experience and various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances form the basis for making estimates and judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions. A critical accounting estimate meets two criteria: (1) it requires assumptions about highly uncertain matters and (2) there would be a material effect on the financial statements from either using a different, although reasonable, amount within the range of the estimate in the current period or from reasonably likely period-to-period changes in the estimate.

While there are a number of accounting policies, methods and estimates affecting our Consolidated Financial Statements as addressed in Note 1 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies,” areas that are particularly critical and significant include:

Revenue Recognition. We record revenue at the time of sale and delivery of merchandise, net of allowances for estimated future returns. We present sales, net of sales taxes, in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. We account for layaway sales and leased department revenue in compliance with ASC Topic No. 605, Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements. Layaway sales are recognized upon delivery of merchandise to the customer. The amount of cash received upon initiation of the layaway is recorded as a deposit liability within the line item “Other Current Liabilities” in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. Store value cards (gift cards and store credits issued for merchandise returns) are recorded as a liability at the time of issuance, and the related sale is recorded upon redemption.

We estimate and recognize store value card breakage income in proportion to actual store value card redemptions and record such income in the line item “Other Income, Net” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. We determine an estimated store value card breakage rate by continuously evaluating historical redemption data. Breakage income is recognized on a monthly basis in proportion to the historical redemption patterns for those store value cards for which the likelihood of redemption is remote.

Inventory. Our inventory is valued at the lower of cost or market using the retail inventory method. Under the retail inventory method, the valuation of inventory at cost and resulting gross margin are calculated by applying a calculated cost to retail ratio to the retail value of inventory. The retail inventory method is an averaging method that is widely used in the retail industry due to its practicality. Additionally, the use of the retail inventory method results in valuing inventory at the lower of cost or market if markdowns are currently taken as a reduction of the retail value of inventory. Inherent in the retail inventory method calculation are certain significant management judgments and estimates including merchandise markon, markups, markdowns and shrinkage, which significantly impact the ending inventory valuation at cost as well as the resulting gross margin. Management believes that our retail inventory method and application of the average cost method provides an inventory valuation which approximates cost using a first-in, first-out assumption and results in carrying value at the lower of cost or market. Typically, estimates are used to record inventory shrinkage for the first three quarters of a fiscal year. Actual physical inventories are typically conducted during the fourth quarter of each fiscal year to calculate actual shrinkage. While we make estimates on the basis of the best information available to us at the time the estimates are made, over accruals or under accruals of shrinkage may be identified as a result of the physical inventory requiring fourth quarter adjustments in a typical fiscal year. During the fourth quarter of Fiscal 2011, we recorded shrinkage adjustments of $5.7 million, as a result of actual shrink being less than what we had estimated.

We also estimate required aged inventory reserves. If actual market conditions are less favorable than those projected by management, additional markdowns may be required.

Long-Lived Assets. We test for recoverability of long-lived assets in accordance with Topic 360 whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that their carrying amount may not be recoverable. This includes performing an analysis of anticipated undiscounted future net cash flows of long-lived assets. If the carrying value of the related assets exceeds the undiscounted cash flow, we reduce the carrying value to its fair value, which is generally calculated using discounted cash flows. The recoverability assessment related to these store-level assets requires judgments and estimates of future revenues, gross margin rates and store expenses. We base these estimates upon our past and expected future performance. We believe our estimates are appropriate in light of current market conditions. To the extent these future projections change, our conclusions regarding impairment may differ from the estimates. Future adverse changes in market conditions or poor operating results of underlying assets could result in losses or an inability to recover the carrying value of the assets that may not be reflected in an asset’s current carrying value, thereby possibly requiring an impairment charge in the future. During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, we recorded $1.2 million, $2.0 million, $12.0 million and $10.0 million, respectively, in impairment charges related to long-lived assets (exclusive of finite-lived intangible assets).

 

47


Table of Contents

Intangible Assets. As discussed above, the Merger Transaction was completed on April 13, 2006 and was financed by a combination of borrowings under our senior secured credit facilities, the issuance of senior notes and senior discount notes and the equity investment of affiliates of Bain Capital and management. The purchase price, including transaction costs, was approximately $2.1 billion. All assets and liabilities were recorded at fair value on the acquisition date, including identifiable intangible assets separate from goodwill. Identifiable intangible assets include tradenames, and net favorable lease positions. The fair values and useful lives of identified intangible assets are based on many factors, including estimates and assumptions of future operating performance, estimates of cost avoidance, the specific characteristics of the identified intangible assets and our historical experience. Goodwill represents the excess of cost over the fair value of net assets acquired.

On an annual basis we compare the carrying value of our tradenames, which we consider to be indefinite-lived intangible assets to their estimated fair value. The determination of fair value is made using the “relief from royalty” valuation method. Inputs to the valuation model include:

 

   

Future revenue and profitability projections associated with the tradenames;

 

   

Estimated market royalty rates that could be derived from the licensing of our tradenames to third parties in order to establish the cash flows accruing to our benefit as a result of ownership of the tradenames; and

 

   

Rate used to discount the estimated royalty cash flow projections to their present value (or estimated fair value) based on the risk and nature of our cash flows.

During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period, we did not record any impairment charges related to our indefinite-lived intangible assets. During Fiscal 2009 we recorded $294.6 million of impairment charges related to our indefinite-lived intangible assets in the line item “Impairment Charges – Tradenames” in our Consolidated Statement of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income.

Our favorable leases, which we consider to be finite-lived intangible assets, are amortized over their respective lease terms, and are reviewed for impairment whenever circumstances change, in conjunction with the impairment testing of our long-lived assets as described above. If the carrying value is greater than the respective estimated fair value, we then determine if the asset is impaired, and whether some, or all, of the asset should be written off as a charge to operations, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial results. Impairment charges of $0.1 million, $34.6 million and $26.1 million were recorded related to our favorable leases during Fiscal 2011, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively, and are included in the line item “Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. There were no impairment charges related to our finite-lived intangible assets during Fiscal 2010.

Goodwill Impairment. Goodwill represents the excess of cost over the fair value of net assets acquired. Topic No. 350 requires periodic tests of the impairment of goodwill. Topic No. 350 requires a comparison, at least annually, of the net book value of the assets and liabilities associated with a reporting unit, including goodwill, with the fair value of the reporting unit, which corresponds to the discounted cash flows of the reporting unit, in the absence of an active market. Our impairment analysis includes a number of assumptions around our future performance, which may differ from actual results. When this comparison indicates that impairment exists, the impairment recognized is the amount by which the carrying amount of the assets exceeds the fair value of these assets. Our annual goodwill impairment review is typically performed during the beginning of May of the fiscal year. For Fiscal 2009, in response to several factors, including, but not limited to declines in the U.S. and international financial markets, decreased comparative store sales results of the peak holiday and winter selling seasons and our expectation that the then current comparative store sales trends would continue for an extended period, we determined that it was appropriate to perform our annual goodwill impairment testing in the third and fourth quarters of Fiscal 2009. There were no impairment charges recorded on the carrying value of our goodwill during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period, or Fiscal 2009.

Insurance Reserves. We have risk participation agreements with insurance carriers with respect to workers’ compensation, general liability insurance and health insurance. Pursuant to these arrangements, we are responsible for paying individual claims up to designated dollar limits. The amounts included in our costs related to these claims are estimated and can vary based on changes in assumptions or claims experience included in the associated insurance programs. For example, changes in legal trends and interpretations, as well as changes in the nature and method of how claims are settled, can impact ultimate costs. An increase in workers’ compensation claims by employees, health insurance claims by employees or general liability claims may result in a corresponding increase in our costs related to these claims. Insurance reserves amounted to $49.6 million at both January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011.

Income Taxes. We account for income taxes in accordance with ASC Topic No. 740 “Income Taxes” (Topic No. 740). Our provision for income taxes and effective tax rates are based on a number of factors, including our income, tax planning strategies, differences between tax laws and accounting rules, statutory tax rates and credits, uncertain tax positions, and valuation allowances, by legal entity and jurisdiction. We use significant judgment and estimations in evaluating our tax positions. Topic No. 740 clarifies the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in an entity’s financial statements, and prescribes a

 

48


Table of Contents

recognition threshold and measurement attributes for financial statement disclosure of tax positions taken or expected to be taken on a tax return. Topic No. 740 requires that we recognize in our financial statements the impact of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return, if that position is “more likely than not” of being sustained upon examination by the relevant taxing authority, based on the technical merits of the position. The tax benefits recognized in the financial statements from such a position are measured based on the largest benefit that has a greater than fifty percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate resolution. Additionally, Topic No. 740 provides guidance on de-recognition, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods and disclosure.

U.S. federal and state tax authorities regularly audit our tax returns. We establish tax reserves when it is considered more likely than not that we will not succeed in defending our positions. We adjust these tax reserves, as well as the related interest and penalties, based on the latest facts and circumstances, including recently published rulings, court cases, and outcomes of tax audits. To the extent our actual tax liability differs from our established tax reserves our effective tax rate may be materially impacted. While it is often difficult to predict the final outcome of, the timing of, or the tax treatment of any particular tax position or deduction, we believe that our tax reserves reflect the most likely outcome of known tax contingencies.

We record deferred tax assets and liabilities for any temporary differences between the tax reflected in our financial statements and tax presumed rates. We establish valuation allowances for our deferred tax assets when we believe it is more likely than not that the expected future taxable income or tax liabilities thereon will not support the use of a deduction or credit. For example, we would establish a valuation allowance for the tax benefit associated with a loss carryover in a tax jurisdiction if we did not expect to generate sufficient taxable income to utilize the loss carryover.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Refer to Note 3 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Recent Accounting Pronouncements” for a discussion of recent accounting pronouncements and their impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.

Fluctuations in Operating Results

We expect that our revenues and operating results may fluctuate from fiscal quarter to fiscal quarter or over the longer term. Certain of the general factors that may cause such fluctuations are discussed in Item 1A, Risk Factors and elsewhere in the Annual Report.

Seasonality

Our business is seasonal, with our highest sales occurring in the months of September through January of each year. For the past 60 months, an average of approximately 50% of our net sales occurred during the period from September through January. Weather, however, continues to be an important contributing factor to our sales. Generally, our sales are higher if the weather is cold during the Fall and warm during the early Spring.

Inflation

We do not believe that our operating results have been materially affected by inflation during Fiscal 2011. Historically, as the costs of merchandising and related operating expenses have increased, the Company has been able to mitigate the effect of such impact on the Company’s operations.

The U.S retail industry continues to face increased pressure on margins as commodity prices increase and the overall challenging retail conditions have led consumers to be more value conscious. Despite a plentiful supply of goods in the market, which historically created downward pricing pressure for wholesale purchases, we expect to continue to experience rising costs. Our “open to buy” paradigm, in which we purchase both pre-season and in-season merchandise, allows us the flexibility to purchase less pre-season with the balance purchased in-season and opportunistically. It also provides us the flexibility to shift purchases between suppliers and categories. This enables us to obtain better terms with our suppliers which we expect to help offset the expected rising costs of goods.

Market Risk

We are exposed to market risks relating to fluctuations in interest rates. Our senior secured credit facilities contain floating rate obligations and are subject to interest rate fluctuations. The objective of our financial risk management is to minimize the negative impact of interest rate fluctuations on our earnings and cash flows. Interest rate risk is managed through the use of a combination of fixed and variable interest debt as well as the periodic use of interest rate cap agreements.

 

49


Table of Contents

As more fully described in Note 9 to our Consolidated Financial Statements entitled, “Derivatives and Hedging Activities,” we enter into interest rate cap agreements to manage interest rate risks associated with our long-term debt obligations. Gains and losses associated with these contracts are accounted for as interest expense and are recorded under the caption “Interest Expense” on our Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. We continue to have exposure to interest rate risks to the extent they are not hedged.

Off-Balance Sheet Transactions

Other than operating leases consummated in the normal course of business and letters of credit, as more fully described above under the caption “Certain Information Concerning Contractual Obligations,” we are not involved in any off-balance sheet arrangements that have or are reasonably likely to have a material current or future impact on our financial condition, changes in financial condition, revenues or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.

 

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

We are exposed to certain market risks as part of our ongoing business operations. Primary exposures include changes in interest rates, as borrowings under our ABL Line of Credit and Term Loan bear interest at floating rates based on LIBOR or the base rate, in each case plus an applicable borrowing margin. We will manage our interest rate risk by balancing the amount of fixed-rate and floating-rate debt. For fixed-rate debt, interest rate changes do not affect earnings or cash flows. Conversely, for floating-rate debt, interest rate changes generally impact our earnings and cash flows, assuming other factors are held constant.

At January 28, 2012, we had $474.0 million principal amount of fixed-rate debt and $1,139.1 million of floating-rate debt. Based on $1,139.1 million outstanding as floating rate debt, an immediate increase of one percentage point would cause an increase to cash interest expense of approximately $11.3 million per year, resulting in $11.3 million less in our pre-tax earnings. As of January 29, 2011, we estimated that an immediate increase of one percentage point would cause an increase to cash interest expense of approximately $9.5 million per year. This sensitivity analysis assumes our mix of financial instruments and all other variables will remain constant in future periods. These assumptions are made in order to facilitate the analysis and are not necessarily indicative of our future intentions.

If a one point increase in interest rate were to occur over the next four fiscal quarters (excluding the effect of our interest rate cap agreements discussed below), such an increase would result in the following additional interest expenses (assuming our current ABL Line of Credit borrowing level remains constant with fiscal year end levels):

 

     (in thousands)  

Floating-Rate Debt

   Principal
Outstanding at
January 28,
2012
     Additional
Interest
Expense
Q1 2012
     Additional
Interest
Expense
Q2 2012
     Additional
Interest

Expense
Q3 2012
     Additional
Interest
Expense
Q4 2012
 

ABL Line of Credit

   $ 190,000       $ 475       $ 475       $ 475       $ 475   

Term Loan

     949,123         2,349         2,350         2,351         2,352   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,139,123       $ 2,824       $ 2,825       $ 2,826       $ 2,827   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

We have two interest rate cap agreements for a maximum principal amount of $900.0 million which limit our interest rate exposure to 7% for our first $900.0 million of borrowings under our variable rate debt obligations. If interest rates were to increase up to the 7% cap rate from the rates in effect as of January 28, 2012, for a full fiscal year, then our maximum interest rate exposure would be $12.8 million on borrowing levels of up to $900.0 million. Currently, we have unlimited interest rate risk related to our variable rate debt in excess of $900.0 million. At January 28, 2012, our borrowing rate related to our ABL Line of Credit was 2.2%. At January 28, 2012, the borrowing rate related to our Term Loan was 6.3%.

We and our subsidiaries, affiliates, and significant shareholders may from time to time seek to retire or purchase our outstanding debt (including publicly issued debt) through cash purchases and/or exchanges, in open market purchases, privately negotiated transactions, by tender offer or otherwise. Such repurchases or exchanges, if any, will depend on prevailing market conditions, liquidity requirements, contractual restrictions and other factors. The amounts involved may be material. During Fiscal 2009, an affiliate of Bain Capital, LLC, our indirect controlling stockholder, purchased a portion of Holdings’ 14 1/2% Previous Senior Discount Notes due 2014 (the Purchased Notes). The Purchased Notes were sold in October of 2009.

 

50


Table of Contents

Our ability to satisfy our interest payment obligations on our outstanding debt will depend largely on our future performance, which in turn, is subject to prevailing economic conditions and to financial, business and other factors beyond our control. If we do not have sufficient cash flow to service interest payment obligations on our outstanding indebtedness and if we cannot borrow or obtain equity financing to satisfy those obligations, our business and results of operations will be materially adversely affected. We cannot be assured that any replacement borrowing or equity financing could be successfully completed.

A change in interest rates generally does not have an impact upon our future earnings and cash flow for fixed-rate debt instruments. As fixed-rate debt matures, however, and if additional debt is acquired to fund the debt repayment, future earnings and cash flow may be affected by changes in interest rates. This effect would be realized in the periods subsequent to the periods when the debt matures.

 

51


Table of Contents
Item 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

 

     Page  

Consolidated Financial Statements

  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     53   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011

     54   

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income for the fiscal years ended January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the 35 week period ended January 30, 2010 and the fiscal year ended May 30, 2009

     55   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the fiscal years ended January 28, 2012 and January  29, 2011, the 35 week period ended January 30, 2010 and the fiscal year ended May 30, 2009

     56   

Consolidated Statements of Stockholder’s Equity for the fiscal years ended January  28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the 35 week period ended January 30, 2010 and the fiscal year ended May 30, 2009

     58   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the fiscal years ended January  28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the 35 week period ended January 30, 2010 and the fiscal year ended May 30, 2009

     59   

 

52


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Stockholder of Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc.

Burlington, NJ

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of January 28, 2012 and January 30, 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive (loss) income, stockholder’s (deficit) equity, and cash flows for the years ended January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the 35 week period ended January 30, 2010 and the year ended May 30, 2009. Our audits also included the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at Item 15(a)(2). These financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and subsidiaries as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the years ended January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the 35 week period ended January 30, 2010 and the year ended May 30, 2009, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also, in our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

 

/s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Parsippany, New Jersey
April 20, 2012

 

53


Table of Contents

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(All amounts in thousands, except share amounts)

 

     January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
 

ASSETS

    

Current Assets:

    

Cash and Cash Equivalents

   $ 35,664      $ 30,214   

Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     34,800        30,264   

Accounts Receivable (Net of Allowances for Doubtful Accounts of $85 at January 28, 2012, and $175 at January 29, 2011)

     40,119        49,875   

Merchandise Inventories

     682,260        644,228   

Deferred Tax Assets

     23,243        24,835   

Prepaid and Other Current Assets

     40,062        36,109   

Prepaid Income Taxes

     21,319        16,447   

Assets Held for Disposal

     521        2,156   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current Assets

     877,988        834,128   

Property and Equipment—Net of Accumulated Depreciation

     865,215        857,589   

Tradenames

     238,000        238,000   

Favorable Leases—Net of Accumulated Amortization

     359,903        389,986   

Goodwill

     47,064        47,064   

Other Assets

     112,973        91,241   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

   $ 2,501,143      $ 2,458,008   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDER’S (DEFICIT)/EQUITY

    

Current Liabilities:

    

Accounts Payable

   $ 276,285      $ 190,460   

Income Taxes Payable

     2,501        4,429   

Other Current Liabilities

     218,842        208,515   

Current Maturities of Long Term Debt

     7,659        14,264   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current Liabilities

     505,287        417,668   

Long Term Debt

     1,605,464        1,358,021   

Other Liabilities

     224,352        215,528   

Deferred Tax Liabilities

     276,985        279,279   

Commitments and Contingencies (Note 10, 12, 17, and 18)

    

Stockholder’s (Deficit)/Equity:

    

Common Stock, Par Value $0.01; Authorized 1,000 Shares; 1,000 Issued and Outstanding at January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011

    

Capital in Excess of Par Value

     474,569        466,754   

Accumulated (Deficit)/Equity

     (585,514     (279,242
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Stockholder’s (Deficit)/Equity

     (110,945     187,512   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Stockholder’s (Deficit)/Equity

   $ 2,501,143      $ 2,458,008   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

54


Table of Contents

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE (LOSS) INCOME

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     Year Ended
January 28,
2012
    Year Ended
January 29,
2011
    35 Weeks
Ended
January 30,
2010
    Year Ended
May 30,
2009
 

REVENUES:

        

Net Sales

   $ 3,854,134      $ 3,669,602      $ 2,457,567      $ 3,541,981   

Other Revenue

     33,397        31,487        21,730        29,386   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

     3,887,531        3,701,089        2,479,297        3,571,367   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

COSTS AND EXPENSES:

        

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization as Shown Below)

     2,363,464        2,252,346        1,492,349        2,199,766   

Selling and Administrative Expenses

     1,215,301        1,156,613        759,774        1,115,248   

Restructuring and Separation Costs (Note 14)

     7,438        2,200        2,429        6,952   

Depreciation and Amortization

     153,070        146,759        103,605        159,607   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     1,735        2,080        46,776        37,498   

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

     —          —          —          294,550   

Other Income, Net

     (9,942     (11,346     (15,335     (5,998

Loss on Extinguishment of Debt

     37,764        —          —          —     

Interest Expense (Inclusive of (Gain)/Loss on Interest Rate Cap Agreements)

     129,121        99,309        59,476        102,716   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Costs and Expenses

     3,897,951        3,647,961        2,449,074        3,910,339   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Loss)/Income Before Income Tax (Benefit)/Expense

     (10,420     53,128        30,223        (338,972

Income Tax (Benefit)/Expense

     (4,148     22,130        11,570        (147,389
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (Loss)/Income

     (6,272     30,998        18,653        (191,583
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Comprehensive (Loss)/Income

   $ (6,272   $ 30,998      $ 18,653      $ (191,583
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

55


Table of Contents

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     Year Ended
January 28,
2012
    Year Ended
January 29,
2011
    35 Weeks Ended
January  30,

2010
    Year Ended
May  30,
2009
 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

        

Net (Loss) Income

   $ (6,272   $ 30,998      $ 18,653      $ (191,583

Adjustments to Reconcile Net (Loss) Income to Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities:

        

Depreciation and Amortization

     153,070        146,759        103,605        159,607   

Amortization of Debt Issuance Costs

     11,904        12,346        8,238        10,335   

Impairment Charges—Long-Lived Assets

     1,735        2,080        46,776        37,498   

Impairment Charges—Tradenames

     —          —          —          294,550   

Accretion of Senior Notes and Senior Discount Notes

     59        733        449        608   

Interest Rate Cap Contracts-Adjustment to Market

     3,165        5,500        (455     (4,173

Provision for Losses on Accounts Receivable

     1,211        2,098        1,993        2,832   

Provision for Deferred Income Taxes

     (701     886        (19,815     (144,106

Loss on Disposition of Fixed Assets and Leasehold Improvements

     2,261        1,539        5,386        297   

(Gain) Loss on Investments in Money Market Fund

     —          (240     (3,849     4,661   

Loss on Extinguishment of Debt—Write-off of Deferred Financing Fees

     16,435        —          —          —     

Non-Cash Stock Compensation Expense

     5,797        2,230        994        6,124   

Non-Cash Rent Expense

     (5,363     (1,485     (3,327     (296

Excess Tax Benefit from Stock Based Compensation

     32        —          —          —     

Changes in Assets and Liabilities:

        

Accounts Receivable

     (1,650     (1,168     (3,638     (175

Merchandise Inventories

     (38,033     (30,933 )     28,538        77,696   

Prepaid and Other Current Assets

     (8,845     (18,272 )     2,013        (7,538

Accounts Payable

     85,824        50,659        (89,955     (107,283

Other Current Liabilities and Income Tax Payable

     6,959        (28,183     (8,737     8,345   

Deferred Rent Incentives

     32,427        19,429        7,649        38,730   

Other Long-Term Assets and Long-Term Liabilities

     (10,032     13,728        9,009        (13,833
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Provided by Operations

     249,983        208,704        103,527        172,296   

INVESTING ACTIVITIES

        

Cash Paid for Property and Equipment

     (153,373     (132,131     (60,035     (129,957

Change in Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     (4,536     (27,659     17        70   

Proceeds (Expenses) From Sale of Property and Equipment and Assets Held for Sale

     757        (38 )     1,062        369   

Lease Acquisition Costs

     (557     (422 )     —          (3,978

Redesignation of Cash Equivalents to Investment in Money Market Fund

     —          —          —          (56,294

Redemption of Investment in Money Market Fund

     —          240        4,844        50,637   

Purchase of Tradenames Rights

     —          —          —          (6,250

Other

     (1,064     48        38        123   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

     (158,773     (159,962     (54,074     (145,280

 

56


Table of Contents

FINANCING ACTIVITIES

        

Proceeds from Long Term Debt—ABL Line of Credit

     1,073,700        204,200        444,315        857,051   

Proceeds from Long Term Debt—Notes Payable

     450,000        —          —          —     

Proceeds from Long Term Debt—Term Loan

     991,623        —          —          —     

Principal Payments on Long Term Debt—ABL Line of Credit

     (1,052,300     (156,800     (473,422     (888,344

Principal Repayments on Long Term Debt—Senior Discount Notes

     (302,056     —          —          —     

Principal Repayments on Long Term Debt—Senior Notes

     (99,309     —          —          —     

Principal Payments on Long Term Debt

     (829     (1,998     (1,537     (1,597

Principal Payments on Long Term Debt—Term Loan

     (42,500     (87,202     (5,998     (2,057

Principal Repayments on Previous Term Loan

     (777,550      

Purchase of Interest Rate Cap Contract

     —          —          —          (3,360

Payment of Dividends

     (297,917     (251     (212     (3,000

Stock Option Exercise and Related Tax Benefits

     2,018        —          —          —     

Debt Issuance Costs

     (30,640     (1,227     (13,659     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Financing Activities

     (85,760     (43,278     (50,513     (41,307
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents

     5,450        5,464        (1,060     (14,291

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Period

     30,214        24,750        25,810        40,101   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period

   $ 35,664      $ 30,214      $ 24,750      $ 25,810   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information:

        

Interest Paid

   $ 102,304      $ 79,187      $ 47,963      $ 96,543   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income Tax Payment (Refund), Net

   $ 5,697      $ 41,505      $ 48,764      $ (5,341
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-Cash Investing Activities:

        

Accrued Purchases of Property and Equipment

   $ 12,969      $ 17,606      $ 10,667      $ (1,849

Notes Receivable from Sale of Assets Held for Sale

   $ —        $ —        $ (2,000    $ —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

57


Table of Contents

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDER’S DEFICIT

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     Common
Stock
     Capital in
Excess of
Par Value
     Retained
Earnings
(Accumulated
Deficit)
    Total  

Balance at May 31, 2008

   $ —         $ 457,371       $ (133,847   $ 323,524   

Net Loss

           (191,583     (191,583

Stock Based Compensation

     —           6,124           6,124   

Dividend

     —           —           (3,000     (3,000
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at May 30, 2009

     —           463,495         (328,430     135,065   

Net Income

     —           —           18,653        18,653   

Stock Based Compensation

     —           994         —          994  

Dividend

     —           —           (212     (212
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at January 30, 2010

     —           464,489         (309,989     154,500   

Net Income

     —           —           30,998        30,998   

Excess Tax Benefit of Vested Restricted Stock

     —           35         —          35   

Stock Based Compensation

     —           2,230         —          2,230   

Dividend

     —           —           (251     (251
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at January 29, 2011

     —           466,754         (279,242     187,512   

Net Loss

     —           —           (6,272     (6,272

Stock Options Exercised and Related Tax Benefits

     —           2,018         —          2,018   

Stock Based Compensation

     —           5,797         —          5,797   

Dividend

     —           —           (300,000     (300,000
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at January 28, 2012

   $ —         $ 474,569       $ (585,514   $ (110,945
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

58


Table of Contents

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Business and Current Conditions

As of January 28, 2012, Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries (the Company or Holdings) operated 477 stores in 44 states and Puerto Rico, selling apparel, shoes and accessories for men, women and children. A majority of those stores offer a home furnishing and linens department and a juvenile furniture department. As of January 28, 2012, the Company operated stores under the names “Burlington Coat Factory” (461 stores), “Cohoes Fashions” (two stores), “MJM Designer Shoes” (13 stores), and “Super Baby Depot” (one store). Cohoes Fashions offers products similar to that of Burlington Coat Factory. MJM Designer Shoes offers moderately priced designer and fashion shoes. The Super Baby Depot store offers baby clothing, accessories, furniture and other merchandise in the middle to higher price range. During Fiscal 2011, the Company opened 17 net new Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse stores.

The primary subsidiary of the Company is Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation (BCFWC), which was initially organized in 1972 as a New Jersey corporation. In 1983, BCFWC was reincorporated in Delaware and currently exists as a Delaware corporation. The Company was incorporated in 2006 (and currently exists) as a Delaware corporation. In 2006, BCFWC became a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company in a take private transaction (the Merger Transaction).

In the first quarter of Fiscal 2011, the Company completed the refinancing of its $900 million Senior Secured Term Loan (Previous Term Loan Facility), 11.1% Senior Notes (Previous Senior Notes), and 14.5% Senior Discount Notes (Previous Senior Discount Notes). As a result of these transactions, the Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes, with carrying values at February 24, 2011 of $302.0 million and $99.3 million, respectively, were repurchased. These debt instruments were replaced when BCFWC completed the sale of $450 million aggregate principal amount of 10% Senior Notes due 2019 (the Notes) at an issue price of 100%. The Previous Term Loan Facility with a carrying value of $777.6 million at February 24, 2011 was replaced with a $1,000.0 million senior secured term loan facility (New Term Loan Facility) under which we borrowed net proceeds of $990.0 million. In connection with the offering of the Notes and the refinancing of the Previous Term Loan Facility, a cash dividend of $300.0 million in the aggregate was declared to the equity holders of Parent on a pro rata basis. Borrowings on our $600 million Available Business Line Senior Secured Revolving Facility (ABL Line of Credit) related to these refinancing transactions were $101.6 million. In addition, on September 2, 2011, the Company completed an amendment and restatement of the credit agreement governing the ABL Line of Credit, which, among other things, extended the maturity date to September 2, 2016.

Significant declines in the United States and international financial markets and the resulting impact of such events on macroeconomic conditions have impacted customer behavior and consumer spending at retailers which impacts the Company’s sales trends. In response to these economic conditions, the Company implemented several initiatives to restructure its workforce (refer to Note 14 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Restructuring and Separation Costs” for further discussion). The Company continues to focus on a number of ongoing initiatives aimed at improving its comparative store sales and operating results. The Company believes it is prudently managing its capital spending and operating expenses in response to the current macroeconomic conditions.

Despite the current trends in the retail environment and their negative impact on the Company’s comparative store sales, the Company believes that cash generated from operations will be sufficient to fund its expected cash flow requirements and planned capital expenditures for at least the next twelve months as well as the foreseeable future. However, there can be no assurance that, should the economy decline, the Company would be able to continue to offset decreases in its comparative store sales with continued savings initiatives. At January 28, 2012, working capital was $337.9 million, cash and cash equivalents were $35.7 million and unused availability under the Company’s ABL Senior Secured Revolving Facility (ABL Line of Credit) was $242.6 million.

Fiscal Years

In order to conform to the predominant fiscal calendar used within the retail industry, on February 25, 2010 the Company’s Board of Directors approved a change in the Company’s fiscal year from a fiscal year comprised of the twelve consecutive fiscal months ending on the Saturday closest to May 31 to a fiscal year comprised of the twelve consecutive fiscal months ending on the Saturday closest to January 31. As a result, these Consolidated Financial Statements include the 52 week periods ended January 28, 2012 (Fiscal 2011) and January 29, 2011 (Fiscal 2010), the 35 week period ended January 30, 2010 (the Transition Period) and the 52 week period ended May 30, 2009 (Fiscal 2009). See Note 2 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Fiscal Year End Change” for the comparative Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income for the Transition Period compared with the 35 week period ended January 31, 2009.

 

59


Table of Contents

Basis of Presentation

The Consolidated Financial Statements include the subsidiaries of the Company, in which it has controlling financial interest through direct ownership. The Company has no operations and its only asset is 100% of the stock of BCFWC. All discussions of operations in this report relate to BCFWC, which are reflected in the Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company.

Principles of Consolidation

The Consolidated Financial Statements include the subsidiaries of the Company in which it has controlling financial interest through direct ownership. All intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated.

The Company was incorporated in the State of Delaware on April 10, 2006. The Company’s Certificate of Incorporation authorizes 1,000 shares of common stock, par value of $0.01 per share. All 1,000 shares are issued and outstanding and Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. (Parent) is the only holder of record of this stock.

Use of Estimates

The Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements have been prepared in conformity with GAAP. Certain amounts included in the Consolidated Financial Statements are estimated based on historical experience, currently available information and management’s judgment as to the outcome of future conditions and circumstances. While every effort is made to ensure the integrity of such estimates, actual results could differ from these estimates, and such differences could have a material impact on the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents represent cash and short-term, highly liquid investments with maturities of three months or less at the time of purchase. Book cash overdrafts are included in the line item “Accounts Payable” on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets for financial reporting purposes.

Accounts Receivable

Accounts receivable consists of credit card receivables, lease incentive receivables and other receivables. Accounts receivable are recorded at net realizable value, which approximates fair value. The Company provides for an allowance for doubtful accounts for amounts deemed uncollectible.

Inventories

Merchandise inventories are valued at the lower of cost, on an average cost basis, or market, as determined by the retail inventory method. The Company records its cost of merchandise (net of purchase discounts and certain vendor allowances), certain merchandise acquisition costs (primarily commissions and import fees), inbound freight, outbound freight from distribution centers, and freight on internally transferred merchandise in the line item “Cost of Sales” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Costs associated with the Company’s distribution, buying, and store receiving functions are included in the line items “Selling and Administrative Expenses” and “Depreciation and Amortization” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Distribution and purchasing costs included in the line item “Selling and Administrative Expenses” amounted to $84.6 million, $74.1 million, $40.1 million and $63.3 million for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively. Depreciation and amortization related to the distribution and purchasing functions for the same periods amounted to $8.9 million, $9.6 million, $12.3 million and $9.3 million, respectively.

Assets Held for Disposal

Assets held for disposal represent assets owned by the Company that management has committed to sell in the near term. The Company has either identified or is actively seeking out potential buyers for these assets as of the balance sheet dates. The asset listed in the line item “Assets Held for Disposal” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets, as of January 28, 2012, is a plot of land adjacent to one of the Company’s stores. As of January 29, 2011, the assets listed in the line item

 

60


Table of Contents

“Assets Held for Disposal” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets was comprised of three owned parcels of land adjacent to three of the Company’s stores and an owned building which is currently vacant. Assets held for disposal as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011 amounted to $0.5 million and $2.2 million, respectively.

Based on prevailing market conditions, the Company may determine that it is no longer advantageous to continue marketing certain assets and reclassify those assets out of the line item “Assets Held for Disposal” and into the respective asset category based on the lesser of their carrying value or fair value less cost to sell.

Property and Equipment

Property and equipment are recorded at cost, and depreciation is computed using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets. The estimated useful lives are between 20 and 40 years for buildings, depending upon the expected useful life of the facility, and three to ten years for store fixtures and equipment. Leasehold improvements are depreciated over the lease term including any reasonably assured renewal options or the expected economic life of the improvement, whichever is less. Repairs and maintenance expenditures are expensed as incurred. Renewals and betterments, which significantly extend the useful lives of existing property and equipment, are capitalized. Assets recorded under capital leases are recorded at the present value of minimum lease payments and are amortized over the lease term. Amortization of assets recorded as capital leases is included in the line item “Depreciation and Amortization” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. The carrying value of all long-lived assets are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of an asset may not be recoverable, in accordance with ASC Topic No. 360 “Property, Plant, and Equipment” (Topic No. 360). Refer to the section below entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” and Note 8 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion around impairment of long-lived assets.

Capitalized Computer Software Costs

The Company accounts for capitalized software in accordance with ASC Topic No. 350 “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other” (Topic No. 350). Topic No. 350 requires the capitalization of certain costs incurred in connection with developing or obtaining software for internal use. The Company capitalized $23.0 million and $22.9 million relating to these costs during Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010, respectively.

Purchased and internally developed software is amortized on a straight line basis over the product’s estimated economic life, which is generally three to five years. The net carrying value of software is included in the line item “Property and Equipment – Net of Accumulated Depreciation” on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets and software amortization is included in the line item “Depreciation and Amortization” on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income.

Intangible Assets

The Company accounts for intangible assets in accordance with Topic No. 350. The Company’s intangible assets primarily represent tradenames and favorable lease positions. The tradename asset, Burlington Coat Factory, is expected to generate cash flows indefinitely and does not have an estimable or finite useful life and, therefore, is accounted for as an indefinite-lived asset not subject to amortization. The values of favorable and unfavorable lease positions are amortized on a straight-line basis over the expected lease terms. Amortization of net favorable lease positions is included in the line item “Depreciation and Amortization” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income.

Indefinite-lived intangible assets: The Company tests identifiable intangible assets with an indefinite life for impairment on an annual basis, or when a triggering event occurs, relying on a number of factors that include operating results, business plans and projected future cash flows. The impairment test consists of a comparison of the fair value of the indefinite-lived intangible asset with its carrying amount. The Company determines fair value through multiple valuation techniques. During Fiscal 2009, the Company recorded impairment charges related to its tradenames of $294.6 million. See Note 6 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Intangible Assets” for further discussion of impairment charges recorded as part of the Company’s review.

Finite-lived intangible assets: Identifiable intangible assets that are subject to amortization are evaluated for impairment in accordance with Topic No. 360 using a process similar to that used to evaluate other long-lived assets as described in Note 8 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets.” An impairment loss is

 

61


Table of Contents

recognized for the amount by which the carrying value exceeds the fair value of the asset. For the favorable lease positions, if the carrying amount exceeds the estimated expected undiscounted future cash flows, the Company measures the amount of the impairment by comparing the carrying amount of the asset to its fair value. The estimation of fair value is measured by discounting expected future cash flows using the Company’s risk adjusted rate of interest. During Fiscal 2011, the Company recorded $0.1 million of impairment charges related to identifiable intangible assets. There were no charges related to identifiable intangible assets during Fiscal 2010. The Company recorded impairment charges related to identifiable intangible assets of $34.6 million and $26.1 million during the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively. These charges are recorded in the line item “Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income.

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the acquisition cost over the estimated fair value of tangible assets and other identifiable intangible assets acquired less liabilities assumed. Topic No. 350 requires a comparison, at least annually, of the carrying value of the assets and liabilities associated with a reporting unit, including goodwill, with the fair value of the reporting unit. The Company determines fair value through multiple valuation techniques. If the carrying value of the assets and liabilities exceeds the fair value of the reporting unit, the Company would calculate the implied fair value of its reporting unit goodwill as compared with the carrying value of its reporting unit goodwill to determine the appropriate impairment charge. The Company estimates the fair value of its reporting unit using widely accepted valuation techniques. These techniques use a variety of assumptions including projected market conditions, discount rates and future cash flows. See Note 7 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Goodwill” for further discussion of the fair value of reporting unit goodwill.

Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

The Company accounts for impaired long-lived assets in accordance with Topic No. 360. This Topic requires that long-lived assets and certain identifiable intangibles be reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. Also, long-lived assets and certain intangibles to be disposed of should be reported at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell. The Company considers historical performance and future estimated results in its evaluation of potential impairment and then compares the carrying amount of the asset to the estimated future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset. If the carrying amount of the asset exceeds the estimated expected undiscounted future cash flows, the Company measures the amount of the impairment by comparing the carrying amount of the asset to its fair value. The estimation of fair value is either based on prices for similar assets or measured by discounting expected future cash flows by the Company’s risk adjusted rate of interest. The Company recorded impairment charges related to long-lived assets of $1.2 million, $2.0 million, $12.0 million and $10.0 million during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively. These charges are recorded in the line item “Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. See Note 8 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion of the Company’s measurement of impairment of long-lived assets.

Other Assets

Other assets consist primarily of deferred financing fees, landlord owned store assets that the Company has paid for as part of its lease, purchased lease rights and notes receivable. Deferred financing fees are amortized over the life of the related debt facility using the interest method of amortization. Amortization of deferred financing fees is recorded in the line item “Interest Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Landlord owned assets represent leasehold improvements at certain stores where the landlord has retained title to such assets. These assets are amortized over the straight line rent period and the amortization is included in the line item “Depreciation and Amortization” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Purchased lease rights are amortized over the straight line rent period and the amortization is recorded in the line item “Selling and Administrative Expenses” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Both landlord owned assets and purchased lease rights are assessed for impairment in accordance with Topic No. 360. During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, the Company recorded impairment charges of $0.4 million, $0.1 million, $0.1 million and $1.4 million, respectively, related to landlord owned assets and purchased lease rights. These charges were recorded in the line item “Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. See Note 8 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion of the Company’s measurement of impairment of long-lived assets.

 

62


Table of Contents

Other Current Liabilities

Other current liabilities primarily consist of sales tax payable, customer liabilities, accrued payroll costs, self-insurance reserves, accrued operating expenses, payroll taxes payable, current portion of straight line rent liability and other miscellaneous items. Customer liabilities totaled $29.7 million and $30.2 million, as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, respectively.

The Company has risk participation agreements with insurance carriers with respect to workers’ compensation, general liability insurance and health insurance. Pursuant to these arrangements, the Company is responsible for paying individual claims up to designated dollar limits. The amounts included in costs related to these claims are estimated and can vary based on changes in assumptions or claims experience included in the associated insurance programs. An increase in workers’ compensation claims by employees, health insurance claims by employees or general liability claims may result in a corresponding increase in costs related to these claims. Self insurance reserves were $49.6 million as of both January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011. At both January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the portion of the self insurance reserve expected to be paid in the next twelve months of $19.1 million, was recorded in the line item “Other Current Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. The remaining balances of $30.5 million for both periods were recorded in the line item “Other Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.

Other Liabilities

Other liabilities primarily consist of deferred lease incentives, the excess of straight-line rent expense over actual rental payments and tax liabilities associated with the uncertain tax positions recognized by the Company in accordance with ASC Topic No. 740 “Income Taxes” (Topic No. 740).

Deferred lease incentives are funds received or receivable from landlords used primarily to offset the costs incurred for remodeling. These deferred lease incentives are amortized over the expected lease term including rent holiday periods and option periods where the exercise of the option can be reasonably assured. Amortization of deferred lease incentives is included in the line item “Selling and Administrative Expenses” on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. At January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, deferred lease incentives were $129.4 million and $123.0 million, respectively.

Common Stock

The Company has 1,000 shares of common stock issued and outstanding, all of which are owned by Parent. Parent has 51,674,204 shares of Class A common stock, par value $0.001 per share and 5,769,356 shares of Class L common stock, par value $0.001 per share, authorized. As of January 28, 2012, 45,942,093 shares of Class A common stock and 5,104,677 shares of Class L common stock were outstanding. As of January 29, 2011, 45,458,316 shares of Class A common stock and 5,050,924 shares of Class L common stock were outstanding.

Revenue Recognition

The Company records revenue at the time of sale and delivery of merchandise, net of allowances for estimated future returns. The Company presents sales, net of sales taxes, in its Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. The Company accounts for layaway sales and leased department revenue in compliance with ASC Topic No. 605 “Revenue Recognition” (Topic No. 605). Layaway sales are recognized upon delivery of merchandise to the customer. The amount of cash received upon initiation of the layaway is recorded as a deposit liability in the line item “Other Current Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. Store value cards (gift cards and store credits issued for merchandise returns) are recorded as a liability at the time of issuance, and the related sale is recorded upon redemption.

The Company determines an estimated store value card breakage rate by continuously evaluating historical redemption data. Breakage income is recognized monthly in proportion to the historical redemption patterns for those store value cards for which the likelihood of redemption is remote. During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, the Company recorded $4.1 million, $2.7 million, $4.9 million and $3.1 million, respectively, of breakage income.

 

63


Table of Contents

Other Revenue

Other revenue consists of rental income received from leased departments; subleased rental income; layaway, alteration, dormancy and other service charges, inclusive of shipping and handling revenues (Service Fees); and other miscellaneous items as shown in the table below:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Years Ended      35 weeks
Ended
     Year
Ended
 
     January 28,
2012
     January 29,
2011
     January 30,
2010
     May 30,
2009
 

Service Fees

   $ 13,096       $ 12,453       $ 8,183         9,517   

Rental Income from Leased Departments

     9,566         7,843         5,997         8,699   

Subleased Rental Income and Other Miscellaneous Items

     10,735         11,191         7,550         11,170   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 33,397       $ 31,487       $ 21,730         29,386   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Rental income from leased departments results from arrangements at some of the Company’s stores where the Company has granted unaffiliated third parties the right to use designated store space solely for the purpose of selling such third parties’ goods, including such items as fragrances and jewelry. The Company does not own or have any rights to any tradenames, licenses or other intellectual property in connection with the brands sold by such unaffiliated third parties.

Vendor Rebates and Allowances

Rebates and allowances received from vendors are accounted for in accordance with Topic No. 605, which specifically addresses whether a reseller should account for cash consideration received from a vendor as an adjustment of cost of sales, revenue, or as a reduction to a cost incurred by the reseller. Rebates and allowances received from vendors that are dependent on purchases of inventories are recognized as a reduction of cost of goods sold when the related inventory is sold or marked down.

Rebates and allowances that are reimbursements of specific expenses that meet the criteria of Topic No. 605 are recognized as a reduction of selling and administrative expenses when earned, up to the amount of the incurred cost. Any vendor reimbursement in excess of the related incurred cost is characterized as a reduction of inventory and is recognized as a reduction to cost of sales as inventories are sold. Reimbursements of expenses, exclusive of advertising rebates, amounted to $2.7 million, $1.9 million, $1.3 million and $2.6 million during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively.

Advertising Costs

The Company’s net advertising costs consist primarily of television and newspaper costs. The production costs of net advertising are expensed as incurred. Net advertising expenses are included in the line item “Selling and Administrative Expenses” on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, advertising expense was $77.6 million, $70.4 million, $49.4 million and $75.2 million, respectively.

The Company nets certain cooperative advertising reimbursements received from vendors that meet the criteria of Topic No. 605 against specific, incremental, identifiable costs incurred in connection with selling the vendors’ products. Any excess reimbursement is characterized as a reduction of inventory and is recognized as a reduction to cost of sales as inventories are sold. Vendor rebates netted against advertising expenses were $0.6 million, $0.4 million, $0.2 million and $1.7 million during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively.

Barter Transactions

The Company accounts for barter transactions under ASC Topic No. 845 “Nonmonetary Transactions.” Barter transactions with commercial substance are recorded at the estimated fair value of the products exchanged, unless the products received have a more readily determinable estimated fair value. Revenue associated with barter transactions is recorded at the time of the exchange of the related assets. During Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2009, the Company exchanged $13.9 million and $10.7 million, respectively, of inventory for certain advertising credits. During Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period, the Company did not enter into any new barter agreements. To account for the exchange, the Company recorded “Sales” and “Cost of Sales” of $13.9 million and $10.7 million in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income during Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2009, respectively. The $16.9 million of unused advertising credits received as of January 28, 2012 are expected to be used over the eight consecutive fiscal years following Fiscal 2011.

 

64


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes the prepaid advertising expense in the line items “Prepaid and Other Current Assets” and “Other Assets” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011:

 

     (in thousands)  
     January 28,
2012
     January 29,
2011
 

Prepaid and Other Current Assets

   $ 3,474       $ 2,681   

Other Assets

     13,406         4,864   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Prepaid Advertising Expense

   $ 16,880       $ 7,545   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table details barter credit usage for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Fiscal Years Ended      35 Weeks
Ended
     Fiscal Year
Ended
 
     January 28,
2012
     January 29,
2011
     January 30,
2010
     May 30,
2009
 

Barter Credit Usage

   $ 4,712       $ 2,644       $ 1,816       $ 2,334   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income Taxes

The Company accounts for income taxes in accordance with Topic No. 740. Deferred income taxes reflect the impact of temporary differences between amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and such amounts as measured by tax laws. A valuation allowance against the Company’s deferred tax assets is recorded when it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. In determining the need for a valuation allowance, management is required to make assumptions and to apply judgment, including forecasting future earnings, taxable income, and the mix of earnings in the jurisdictions in which the Company operates. Management periodically assesses the need for a valuation allowance based on the Company’s current and anticipated results of operations. The need for and the amount of a valuation allowance can change in the near term if operating results and projections change significantly.

Topic No. 740 also clarifies the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in an entity’s financial statements, and prescribes a recognition threshold and measurement attributes for financial statement disclosure of tax positions taken or expected to be taken on a tax return. Topic No. 740 requires the recognition in the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements of the impact of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return, if that position is “more likely than not” of being sustained upon examination by the relevant taxing authority, based on the technical merits of the position. The tax benefits recognized in the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements from such a position are measured based on the largest benefit that has a greater than fifty percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate resolution. Additionally, Topic No. 740 provides guidance on de-recognition, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods, disclosure and transition. The Company records interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits as part of income taxes.

Other Income, Net

Other income, net, consists of investment income gains and losses, breakage income, net losses from disposition of fixed assets, and other miscellaneous income items. During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, the Company recognized $4.1 million, $2.7 million, $4.9 million and $3.1 million, respectively, of breakage income.

Comprehensive (Loss) Income

The Company presents Comprehensive (Loss) Income on its Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income in accordance with ASC Topic No. 220 “Comprehensive Income.” During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 there were no differences between Comprehensive (Loss) Income and net (loss) income.

Lease Accounting

The Company leases store locations, distribution centers and office space used in its operations. The Company accounts for these types of leases in accordance with ASC Topic No. 840, “Leases” (Topic No. 840) and subsequent amendments, which require that leases be evaluated and classified as operating or capital leases for financial reporting purposes. Assets held under

 

65


Table of Contents

capital leases are included in the line item “Property and Equipment – Net of Accumulated Depreciation” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. For leases classified as operating, the Company calculates rent expense on a straight-line basis over the lesser of the lease term including renewal options, if reasonably assured, or the economic life of the leased premises, taking into consideration rent escalation clauses, rent holidays and other lease concessions. The Company commences recording rent expense during the store fixturing and merchandising phase of the leased property.

Share-Based Compensation

The Company accounts for share-based compensation in accordance with ASC Topic No. 718, “Stock Compensation” (Topic No. 718), which requires companies to record stock compensation expense for all non-vested and new awards beginning as of the grant date. There are 730,478 units reserved under the 2006 Management Incentive Plan (as amended). Each unit consists of nine shares of Parent’s Class A common stock and one share of Parent’s Class L common stock. As of January 28, 2012, 472,673 options to purchase units and 91,571 units of restricted stock were outstanding. During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, the Company recognized non cash stock compensation expense of $5.8 million, $2.2 million, $1.0 million and $6.1 million, respectively (refer to Note 11 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Stock Option and Award Plans and Stock Based Compensation” for further details).

Credit Risk

Financial instruments that potentially subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash, cash equivalents and investments. The Company manages the credit risk associated with cash equivalents and investments by investing with high-quality institutions and, by policy, limiting investments only to those which meet prescribed investment guidelines. The Company maintains cash accounts that, at times, may exceed federally insured limits. The Company has not experienced any losses from maintaining cash accounts in excess of such limits. Management believes that it is not exposed to any significant risks on its cash and cash equivalent accounts.

Segment Information

The Company reports segment information in accordance with ASC Topic No. 280 “Segment Reporting” (Topic No. 280). The Company has one reportable segment.

 

2. Fiscal Year End Change

On February 25, 2010, the Company’s Board of Directors resolved that the fiscal year that began on May 31, 2009, would end on the Saturday nearest January 31, 2010, and from and after that date, fiscal years would be the 52 or 53 week periods ending on the Saturday closest to January 31 of each successive year.

 

66


Table of Contents

For comparative purposes, Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income for the 35 week periods ended January 30, 2010 and January 31, 2009 are presented as follows:

 

     (in thousands)  
     35 Weeks Ended  
     January 30,
2010
    January 31,
2009
(Unaudited)
 

REVENUES:

    

Net Sales

   $ 2,457,567      $ 2,476,635   

Other Revenue

     21,730        20,277   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

     2,479,297        2,496,912   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

COSTS AND EXPENSES:

    

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization as Shown Below)

     1,492,349        1,510,409   

Selling and Administrative Expenses

     759,774        761,062   

Restructuring and Separation Costs (Note 14)

     2,429        1,929   

Depreciation and Amortization

     103,605        106,823   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     46,776        28,134   

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

     —          279,300   

Other Income, Net

     (15,335 )     (4,698

Interest Expense (Inclusive of Gain/Loss on Interest Rate Cap Agreements)

     59,476        74,263   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Costs and Expenses

     2,449,074        2,757,222   

Income (Loss) Before Income Tax Expense (Benefit)

     30,223        (260,310

Income Tax Expense (Benefit)

     11,570        (104,667
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Income (Loss)

     18,653        (155,643
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Comprehensive Income (Loss)

   $ 18,653      $ (155,643
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

3. Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In September 2011, the FASB issued guidance on testing goodwill for impairment. The new guidance provides an entity the option to first perform a qualitative assessment to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount. If an entity determines that this is the case, it is required to perform the currently prescribed two-step goodwill impairment test to identify potential goodwill impairment and measure the amount of goodwill impairment loss to be recognized for that reporting unit (if any). If an entity determines that it is more likely than not the fair value of the reporting unit is not less than its carrying amount, the two-step goodwill impairment test is not required. The new guidance will be effective for the Company on the first day of the fiscal year ending February 2, 2013 (Fiscal 2012). The Company does not expect the pronouncement to have a material financial impact on its financial position or results of operations.

 

4. Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

At January 28, 2012, restricted cash and cash equivalents consisted of $34.8 million of collateral in lieu of a letter of credit for certain insurance contracts. The Company has the ability to convert the restricted cash to a letter of credit, which would ultimately reduce available borrowings on the Company’s ABL Line of Credit by $34.8 million. At January 29, 2011 restricted cash and cash equivalents consisted of $27.8 million of collateral in lieu of a letter of credit for certain insurance contracts and $2.5 million restricted contractually for the acquisition and maintenance of a building related to a store operated by the Company. During Fiscal 2011, the $2.5 million in restricted cash was distributed as required pursuant to the terms of the acquisition.

 

67


Table of Contents
5. Property and Equipment

Property and equipment consist of:

 

          (in thousands)  
     

Useful Lives

   January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
 

Land

   N/A    $ 162,985      $ 160,998   

Buildings

   20 to 40 Years      358,631        353,187   

Store Fixtures and Equipment

   3 to 10 Years      435,783        383,927   

Software

   3 to 5 Years      141,630        118,630   

Leasehold Improvements

   Shorter of lease term or useful life      374,378        358,976   

Construction in Progress

   N/A      8,755        6,104   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
        1,482,162        1,381,822   

Less: Accumulated Depreciation

        (616,947     (524,233
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Property and Equipment, Net of Accumulated Depreciation

      $ 865,215      $ 857,589   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, assets, net of accumulated amortization of $9.3 million, and $7.8 million, respectively, held under capital leases amounted to approximately $26.8 million and $28.5 million, respectively, and are included in the line item “Buildings” in the foregoing table. Amortization expense related to capital leases is included in the line item “Depreciation and Amortization” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. The total amount of depreciation expense during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 was $117.3 million, $112.2 million, $80.4 million and $125.7 million, respectively.

During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, the Company recorded impairment charges related to Property and Equipment of $1.2 million, $2.0 million, $12.0 million and $10.0 million, respectively (refer to Note 8 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion).

Internally developed software is being amortized on a straight line basis over three to five years and is being recorded in the line item “Depreciation and Amortization” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Depreciation and amortization of internally developed software amounted to $17.8 million, $13.9 million, $8.2 million and $20.7 million, respectively, during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009.

 

6. Intangible Assets

The Company accounts for indefinite-lived intangible assets and finite-lived intangible assets in accordance with Topic No. 350 and Topic No. 360, respectively. In accordance with Topic No. 350, indefinite-lived intangible assets not subject to amortization shall be tested for impairment on an annual basis, and between annual tests in certain circumstances. The Company typically performs this assessment in the beginning of May of the fiscal year. During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period, there were no circumstances that required the Company to perform additional Topic No. 350 testing. During Fiscal 2009, the Company concluded it was appropriate to test its indefinite-lived intangible assets for recoverability in the third fiscal quarter (refer to Note 7 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Goodwill” for further discussion regarding the Company’s decision to accelerate impairment testing under Topic No. 350 in Fiscal 2009).

In accordance with Topic No. 360, the Company tests long-lived assets and certain identifiable intangibles, including favorable leases, to be used by an entity for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. The Company considers historical performance and future estimated results in its evaluation of potential impairment and then compares the carrying amount of the asset to the estimated future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset. If the carrying amount of the asset exceeds the estimated expected undiscounted future cash flows, the Company measures the amount of the impairment by comparing the carrying amount of the asset to its fair value. The estimation of fair value is either based on prices for similar assets or measured by discounting expected future cash flows using the Company’s risk adjusted interest rate (refer to Note 8 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion regarding the Company’s impairment testing under Topic No. 360).

 

68


Table of Contents

Intangible assets at January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011 consist primarily of tradenames and favorable lease positions as follows:

 

     (in thousands)  
     January 28, 2012      January 29, 2011  
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net
Amount
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net
Amount
 

Tradenames

   $ 238,000       $ —        $ 238,000       $ 238,000       $ —        $ 238,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Favorable Leases

   $ 518,904       $ (159,001   $ 359,903       $ 521,561       $ (131,575   $ 389,986   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tradenames

The Company’s tradenames amounted to $238.0 million as of both January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011. As part of the Company’s annual assessment in accordance with Topic No. 350, the fair value of the Company’s tradenames as of January 28, 2012 exceeded its carrying value indicating that the asset was not impaired.

The recoverability assessment with respect to the tradenames used in the Company’s operations requires the Company to estimate the fair value of the tradenames as of the assessment date. Such determination is made using “relief from royalty” valuation method. Inputs to the valuation model include:

 

   

Future revenue and profitability projections associated with the tradenames;

 

   

Estimated market royalty rates that could be derived from the licensing of the Company’s tradenames to third parties in order to establish the cash flows accruing to the benefit of the Company as a result of its ownership of the tradenames; and

 

   

A rate used to discount the estimated royalty cash flow projections to their present value (or estimated fair value) based on the risk and nature of the Company’s cash flows.

Favorable Leases

The decrease in the gross carrying amount of the Company’s favorable leases from January 29, 2011 to January 28, 2012 reflects a reduction of $2.6 million of cost adjustments recorded during Fiscal 2010 which represented certain favorable leases becoming fully amortized during the period as well as a $0.1 million reduction as the result of the impairment of two stores (refer to Note 8 entitled “Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” for further discussion).

Accumulated amortization of favorable leases as of January 28, 2012 reflects increased amortization expense of $29.9 million, partially offset by a decrease of $2.5 million related to a cost adjustment, as discussed above, which decreased both the carrying cost and accumulated amortization of the favorable leases.

The weighted average amortization period remaining for the Company’s favorable leases is 15.9 years. Amortization expense of favorable leases for each of the next five fiscal years is estimated to be as follows:

 

Fiscal years:

   (in thousands)  

2012

   $ 28,574   

2013

     27,953   

2014

     26,786   

2015

     25,676   

2016

     24,464   
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 133,453   
  

 

 

 

 

69


Table of Contents
7. Goodwill

Goodwill totaled $47.1 million as of both January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011. The Company accounts for goodwill in accordance with Topic No. 350. In accordance with Topic No. 350, goodwill shall be tested for impairment on an annual basis, and between annual tests in certain circumstances. The Company typically performs this testing during the beginning of May of each fiscal year. During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010 and the Transition Period, there were no triggering events that required the Company to accelerate its Topic No. 350 impairment testing. During Fiscal 2009, the Company concluded that it was appropriate to test its goodwill for recoverability in connection with the preparation of the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for the third quarter of Fiscal 2009 (the three month period ended February 28, 2009) in light of the following factors:

 

   

Significant declines in the U.S. and international financial markets and the resulting impact of such events on current and anticipated future macroeconomic conditions and customer behavior;

 

   

The determination that these macroeconomic conditions were impacting the Company’s sales trends as evidenced by decreases in comparative store sales;

 

   

Decreased comparative store sales during the peak holiday and winter selling seasons which were significant to the Company’s annual financial results;

 

   

Declines in market valuation multiples of peer group companies used in the estimate of the Company’s business enterprise value; and

 

   

The Company’s expectation that unfavorable comparative store sales trends would continue for an extended period.

The Company revised its business strategies to include a more moderate store opening plan which reduced future projections of revenue and operating results offset by initiatives that were implemented to reduce the Company’s cost structure as discussed in Note 14 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Restructuring and Separation Costs.” As a result of the review, the Company assessed that there was no goodwill impairment during Fiscal 2009.

The Company assesses the recoverability of goodwill using a combination of valuation approaches to determine the Company’s business enterprise value including: (i) discounted cash flow techniques and (ii) a market approach using a guideline public company methodology. Inputs to the valuation model include:

 

   

Estimated future cash flows;

 

   

Growth assumptions for future revenues, which include net store openings as well as future gross margin rates, expense rates and other estimates;

 

   

Rate used to discount the Company’s estimated future cash flow projections to their present value (or estimated fair value); and

 

   

Market values and financial information of similar publicly traded companies to determine market valuation multiples.

Based upon the Company’s impairment analysis of recorded goodwill during Fiscal 2011, the Company determined that there was no goodwill impairment. The Company believes its estimates were appropriate based upon the current market conditions. However, future impairment charges could be required if the Company does not achieve its current cash flow, revenue and profitability projections or the weighted average cost of capital increases or market valuation multiples associated with peer group companies continue to decline. There have been no goodwill impairments since the Merger Transaction.

 

8. Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

The Company accounts for impaired long-lived assets in accordance with Topic No. 360. This statement requires that long-lived assets and certain identifiable intangibles to be held and used by an entity be reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. This statement also requires that long-lived assets and certain intangibles to be disposed of should be reported at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell. The Company considers historical performance and future estimated results in its evaluation of potential impairment and then compares the carrying amount of the asset to the estimated future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset.

 

70


Table of Contents

If the carrying amount of the asset exceeds the estimated expected undiscounted future cash flows, the Company measures the amount of the impairment by comparing the carrying amount of the asset to its fair value. The estimation of fair value is either based on prices for similar assets or measured by discounting expected future cash flows using the Company’s risk adjusted interest rate.

The recoverability assessment related to store-level assets requires judgments and estimates of future revenues, gross margin rates and store expenses. The Company bases these estimates upon its past and expected future performance. The Company believes its estimates are appropriate in light of current market conditions. However, future impairment charges could be required if the Company does not achieve its current revenue or cash flow projections. The impairment charges noted below are primarily related to a decline in revenues of the respective stores as a result of unfavorable weather conditions and the declining macroeconomic conditions that are negatively impacting the Company’s current comparative store sales.

Impairment charges recorded during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 amounted to $1.7 million, $2.1 million, $46.8 million and $37.5 million, respectively. Impairment charges during these periods related to the following:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Fiscal Years
Ended
     35 Weeks
Ended
     Fiscal Year
Ended
 

Asset Categories

   January 28,
2012
     January 29,
2011
     January 30,
2010
     May 30,
2009
 

Leasehold Improvements

   $ 652       $ 779       $ 9,443       $ 6,282   

Furniture and Fixtures

     457         1,148         2,284         2,086   

Other Assets

     410         60         116         1,426   

Favorable Leases

     165         —           34,642         26,080   

Other Property and Equipment

     51         93         291         1,624   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,735       $ 2,080       $ 46,776       $ 37,498   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The impairment of store level assets related to seven of the Company’s stores for Fiscal 2011, nine of the Company’s stores for Fiscal 2010, 33 of the Company’s stores during the Transition Period and 37 of the Company’s stores during Fiscal 2009.

As noted above, long-lived assets are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis for purposes of calculating impairment using the fair value hierarchy of Topic No. 820. The seven stores that were impaired during Fiscal 2011 and the nine stores that were impaired during Fiscal 2010 were 100% impaired and therefore had zero fair value as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011 and would be categorized as Level 3 – Significant Un-Observable Inputs as defined below in Note 16 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Fair Value of Financial Instruments.”

 

9. Derivatives and Hedging Activities

The Company accounts for derivatives and hedging activities in accordance with ASC Topic No. 815 “Derivatives and Hedging” (Topic No. 815). The Company is exposed to certain risks relating to its ongoing business operations, including market risks relating to fluctuations in interest rates. The Company’s senior secured credit facilities contain floating rate obligations and are subject to interest rate fluctuations. The Company uses interest rate cap agreements, which are designated as economic hedges, to manage interest rate risk associated with the Company’s variable-rate borrowings and to minimize the negative impact of interest rate fluctuations on its earnings and cash flows, thus reducing the Company’s exposure to variability in expected future cash flows attributable to the changes in LIBOR rates.

Topic No. 815 requires recognition of all derivative instruments as either assets or liabilities at fair value in the statement of financial position. The Company does not monitor its interest rate cap agreements for hedge effectiveness and therefore does not designate its interest rate cap agreements as cash flow hedges of certain future interest payments on variable-rate debt. Instead, the interest rate cap agreements are adjusted to market on a quarterly basis. As a result, gains or losses associated with the interest rate cap agreements are recorded in the line item “Interest Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income and in the line item “Interest Rate Cap Contract – Adjustment to Market” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows.

 

71


Table of Contents

As of January 28, 2012, the Company was party to two outstanding interest rate cap agreements to manage the interest rate risk associated with future interest payments on variable-rate debt.

 

    

(in thousands)

 
    

Fair Values of Derivative Instruments

 
    

Asset Derivatives

 
    

January 28, 2012

    

January 29, 2011

 

Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments Under Topic No. 815

  

Balance Sheet
Location

   Fair
  Value  
    

Balance Sheet
Location

   Fair
  Value  
 

Interest Rate Cap Agreements

   Other Assets    $ 114       Other Assets    $ 3,279   

 

    

(in thousands)

 
    

Liability Derivatives

 
    

January 28, 2012

    

January 29, 2011

 

Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments Under Topic No. 815

  

Balance Sheet
Location

   Fair
  Value  
    

Balance Sheet
Location

   Fair
  Value  
 

Interest Rate Cap Agreements

   Other Liabilities    $ —         Other Liabilities    $ —     

 

    

(in thousands)

 
    

(Gain)/Loss on Derivatives Instruments

 
          Amount of Loss or (Gain) Recognized in Income on
Derivatives
 
          Years Ended      35 Weeks
Ended
    Year
Ended
 

Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
Under Topic No. 815

  

Location of (Gain) or Loss Recognized in
Income on Derivatives

   January 28,
2012
     January 29,
2011
     January 30,
2010
    May 30,
2009
 

Interest Rate Cap Agreements

   Interest Expense    $ 3,165       $ 5,500       $ (455   $ (4,173 )

On May 31, 2011, the Company’s $600 million and $300 million interest rate cap agreements, each with a cap rate of 7% were terminated and two new interest rate cap agreements became effective. Each new agreement has a notional principal amount of $450 million with a cap rate of 7.0% and terminates on May 31, 2015. The Company has not elected hedge accounting treatment for its interest rate cap agreements. The Company will adjust these interest rate cap agreements to fair value on a quarterly basis and as a result, gains or losses associated with these agreements will be included in the line item “Interest Expense” on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss (Income) and in the line item “Interest Rate Cap Contract – Adjustment to Market” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Cash Flow.

 

72


Table of Contents
10. Long-Term Debt

Long-Term Debt consists of:

 

     (in thousands)  
     January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
 

$1,000,000 Senior Secured Term Loan Facility, LIBOR (with a floor of 1.50%) plus 4.8% due in quarterly payments of $2,500 from January 30, 2016 to January 28, 2017, matures with balance due on February 23, 2017.

   $ 949,123      $ —     

$450,000 Senior Notes, 10%, due at maturity on February 15, 2019, semi-annual interest payments on August 15 and February 15, from February 15, 2012 to February 15, 2019.

     450,000        —     

$900,000 Senior Secured Term Loan Facility, Libor plus 2.3%.

     —          777,550   

$600,000 ABL Senior Secured Revolving Facility, Libor plus spread based on average outstanding balance, expires September 2, 2016.

     190,000        168,600   

Senior Notes, 11.1%.

     —          301,997   

Senior Discount Notes, 14.5%.

     —          99,309   

Promissory Note, non-interest bearing, due in monthly payments of $17 through January 1, 2012

     —          200   

Promissory Note, 4.4% due in monthly payments of $8 through December 23, 2011

     —          82   

Capital Lease Obligations

     24,000        24,547   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total debt

     1,613,123        1,372,285   

Less: current maturities

     (7,659     (14,264
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt, net of current maturities

   $ 1,605,464      $ 1,358,021   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Term Loan

$1 Billion Senior Secured Term Loan Facility

In connection with the offering of the Notes, on February 24, 2011, BCFWC, exclusive of subsidiaries, (referred to herein as “BCFW”) refinanced its Previous Term Loan Facility with the proceeds of the New Term Loan Facility.

Like the Previous Term Loan Facility, the New Term Loan Facility is secured by (a) a perfected first priority lien on BCFW’s real estate, favorable leases, and machinery and equipment and (b) a perfected second priority lien on BCFW’s inventory and receivables, in each case subject to various limitations and exceptions. The New Term Loan Facility is to be repaid in quarterly payments of $2.5 million from January 30, 2016 to January 28, 2017, with the balance of the New Term Loan Facility due upon maturity on February 23, 2017. Beginning with the fiscal year ending on January 28, 2012, at the end of each fiscal year, BCFW is required to make a payment based on its available free cash flow (as defined in the credit agreement governing the New Term Loan Facility). This payment offsets future mandatory quarterly payments. During Fiscal 2011 the Company made $42.5 million of prepayments on the New Term Loan which will offset the mandatory quarterly payments through the second quarter of the Fiscal 2015. Based on the Company’s free cash flow calculation as of January 28, 2012, the Company is required to make an additional payment of $7.0 million. This payment further offsets our future mandatory quarterly payments through October 31, 2015, as well as a portion of the mandatory quarterly payment due on January 30, 2016.

The New Term Loan Facility contains financial, affirmative and negative covenants and requires that BCFW, among other things, maintain on the last day of each fiscal quarter a consolidated leverage ratio not to exceed a maximum amount and maintain a consolidated interest coverage ratio of at least a certain amount. The consolidated leverage ratio compares our total debt to Adjusted EBITDA, as each term is defined in the credit agreement governing the New Term Loan Facility (the New Term Loan Credit Agreement), for the trailing twelve months most recently ended, and such ratios that may not exceed 6.75 to 1 through October 27, 2012; 6.25 to 1 through November 2, 2013; 5.50 to 1 through November 1, 2014; 5.00 to 1 through October 31, 2015; and 4.75 to 1 at January 30, 2016 and thereafter.

The consolidated interest coverage ratio compares our consolidated interest expense to Adjusted EBITDA, as each term is defined in the New Term Loan Credit Agreement, for the trailing twelve months most recently ended, and such ratios that must exceed 1.75 to 1 through October 27, 2012; 1.85 to 1 through November 2, 2013; 2.00 to 1 through October 31, 2015; and 2.10 to 1 at January 30, 2016 and thereafter. Adjusted EBITDA is a non-GAAP financial measure of our liquidity. Adjusted EBITDA, as defined in the credit agreement governing our New Term Loan, starts with consolidated net loss for the period and adds back (i) depreciation, amortization, impairments and other non-cash charges that were deducted in arriving at consolidated net (loss), (ii) the (benefit) provision for taxes, (iii) interest expense, (iv) advisory fees, and (v) unusual, non-recurring or extraordinary expenses, losses or charges as reasonably approved by the administrative agent for such period.

 

73


Table of Contents

The interest rates for the New Term Loan Facility are based on: (i) for LIBO rate loans for any interest period, at a rate per annum equal to (a) the greater of (x) the LIBO rate as determined by the Term Loan Administrative Agent, for such interest period multiplied by the Statutory Reserve Rate (as defined in the New Term Loan Credit Agreement) and (y) 1.50% (the New Term Loan Adjusted LIBO Rate), plus an applicable margin; and (ii) for prime rate loans, a rate per annum equal to the highest of (a) the variable annual rate of interest then announced by JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. at its head office as its “prime rate,” (b) the federal funds rate in effect on such date plus 0.50% per annum, and (c) the New Term Loan Adjusted LIBO Rate for the applicable class of term loans for one-month plus 1.00%, plus, in each case, an applicable margin. The interest rate on the New Term Loan Facility was 6.3% as of January 28, 2012.

In addition, the New Term Loan Facility provides for an uncommitted incremental term loan facility of up to $150.0 million that is available subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions. The New Term Loan Facility has a six year maturity, except that term loans made in connection with the incremental term loan facility or extended in connection with the extension mechanics of the New Term Loan Facility have the maturity dates set forth in the amendments applicable to such term loans.

BCFW used the net proceeds from the offering of the Notes, together with borrowings under the New Term Loan Facility and the ABL Line of Credit, to (i) repurchase any and all of the outstanding Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes, pursuant to cash tender offers commenced by BCFW and the Company on February 9, 2011, and to redeem any Previous Notes that remained outstanding after the completion of the cash tender offers, and pay related fees and expenses, including tender or redemption premiums and accrued interest on the Previous Notes, (ii) to repay the indebtedness under the Previous Term Loan Facility and (iii) to pay a special cash dividend of approximately $300.0 million in the aggregate to the equity holders of the Parent on a pro rata basis, and to pay related fees and expenses.

In accordance with ASC Topic No. 470-50, “Debt – Modifications and Extinguishments” (Topic No. 470), the transactions noted above were determined to be an extinguishment of the existing debt and an issuance of new debt. As a result, the Company recorded a loss on the extinguishment of debt in the amount of $37.8 million in the line item “Loss on Extinguishment of Debt” in its Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss (Income). Of the $37.8 million loss on the extinguishment of debt, $21.4 million represented early call premiums that the Company paid to the holders of its Previous Senior Notes and Previous Senior Discount Notes as a result of repurchasing both notes prior to their maturity. The remaining $16.4 million represented the write off of deferred financing fees related to the extinguished debt facilities.

In conjunction with the issuance of the new debt facilities, the Company paid $25.3 million of legal, consulting, audit related and placement fees. These costs were all deferred and recorded in the line item “Other Assets” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets and will be amortized through the line item “Interest Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss (Income) over the respective lives of the new debt facilities using the effective interest method.

ABL Line of Credit

On September 2, 2011, the Company completed an amendment and restatement of the credit agreement governing the Company’s $600 million ABL Line of Credit, which, among other things, extended the maturity date to September 2, 2016. The aggregate amount of commitments under the amended and restated credit agreement is $600 million and, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, the Company may increase the aggregate amount of commitments up to $900 million. Interest rates under the amended and restated credit agreement are based on LIBO rates as determined by the administrative agent plus an applicable margin of 1.75% to 2.25% based on daily availability, or various prime rate loan options plus an applicable margin of 0.75% to 1.25% based on daily availability. The fee on the average daily balance of unused loan commitments is 0.375%. Prior to the modification, commitment fees of 0.25% were charged on the unused portion of the facility and were included in the line item “Interest Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. The ABL Line of Credit is collateralized by a first lien on the Company’s inventory and receivables and a second lien on the Company’s real estate and property and equipment.

The Company believes that the amended and restated credit agreement provides the liquidity and flexibility to meet its operating and capital requirements over the next five years. Further, the calculation of the borrowing base under the amended and restated credit agreement has been amended to allow for increased availability, particularly during the September 1st through December 15th period of each year. As a result of the amended and restated credit agreement, the Company capitalized $4.2 million in deferred debt charges that will be expensed over the life of the amended and restated credit agreement and wrote off $4.7 million in deferred charges from the prior credit agreement.

At January 28, 2012, the Company had $242.6 million available under the ABL Line of Credit. The maximum borrowings under the ABL Line of Credit during Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010 were $195.0 million and $171.8 million, respectively. Average borrowings under the ABL Line of Credit amounted to $79.2 million at an average interest rate of 3.3% during Fiscal 2011 and

 

74


Table of Contents

$10.5 million at an average interest rate of 2.7% during Fiscal 2010. At January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, $190.0 million and $168.6 million, respectively, were outstanding under the ABL Line of Credit and were included in the line item “Long-Term Debt” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. Borrowings as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011 were due to the working capital management strategy in place at the end of the year which required increased borrowings in order to accelerate certain accounts payable payments in both years.

At January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the Company’s borrowing rate related to the ABL Line of Credit was 2.2% and 5.1%, respectively. At January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the Company’s borrowing rates related to the Term Loan were 6.3% and 2.6%, respectively.

Both the New Term Loan and the ABL Line of Credit are fully, jointly, severally, unconditionally, and irrevocably guaranteed by all of the Company’s subsidiaries (with the exception of one immaterial non-guarantor subsidiary). As of January 28, 2012, the Company was in compliance with all of its debt covenants. The agreements regarding the ABL Line of Credit and the New Term Loan Facility, as well as the indenture governing the Notes, contain covenants that, among other things, limit the Company’s ability, and the ability of the Company’s restricted subsidiaries, to pay dividends on, redeem or repurchase capital stock; make investments; incur additional indebtedness or issue preferred stock; create liens; permit dividends or other restricted payments by the Company’s subsidiaries; sell all or substantially all of the Company’s assets or consolidate or merge with or into other companies; and engage in transactions with affiliates.

Senior Notes Offering and Extinguishment of Previous Notes

On February 24, 2011, BCFW issued $450.0 million aggregate principal amount of 10% Senior Notes due 2019 at an issue price of 100% (the Notes). The Notes were issued pursuant to an indenture, dated February 24, 2011 (the Indenture), among BCFWC, the guarantors signatory thereto, and Wilmington Trust FSB.

The Notes are senior unsecured obligations of BCFW and are guaranteed on a senior basis by BCFW, the Company and each of BCFW’s U.S. subsidiaries to the extent such guarantor is a guarantor of BCFW’s obligations under the New Term Loan Facility (as defined below). Interest is payable on the Notes on each February 15 and August 15, commencing August 15, 2011.

In connection with the issuance of the Notes, on February 24, 2011, BCFW entered into a registration rights agreement relating to the Notes, pursuant to which BCFW agreed to use its reasonable best efforts to file, and did initially file on July 15, 2011, a registration statement with the SEC (as amended, the “Exchange Offer Registration Statement”), enabling holders to exchange the Notes for registered notes with terms substantially identical in all material respects to the Notes, except the exchange notes would be freely tradable. On October 19, 2011, the Exchange Offer Registration Statement was declared effective by the SEC, and we completed the exchange offer on December 2, 2011.

All of BCFW’s Previous Senior Notes and all of the Previous Senior Discount Notes were purchased or redeemed in connection with the issuance of the Notes.

Scheduled maturities of the Company’s long-term debt and capital lease obligations, as they exist as of January 28, 2012, in each of the next four fiscal years and thereafter are as follows:

 

     (in thousands)  

Fiscal years ending in

   Long-Term
Debt
    Capital
Lease
Obligations
    Total  

2012

   $ 6,953      $ 706      $ 7,659   

2013

     —          778        778   

2014

     —          868        868   

2015

     547        1,059        1,606   

2016 and Thereafter

     1,590,000        20,589        1,610,589   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     1,597,500        24,000        1,621,500   

Less: Unamortized Discount

     (8,377     —          (8,377
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     1,589,123        24,000        1,613,123   

Less: Current Portion

     (6,953     (706     (7,659
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long Term Debt

   $ 1,582,170      $ 23,294      $ 1,605,464   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

75


Table of Contents

The capital lease obligations noted above are exclusive of interest charges of $2.0 million, $2.0 million, $1.9 million, $1.8 million and $10.6 million for the fiscal years ended February 2, 2013, February 1, 2014, January 31, 2015, January 30, 2016 and thereafter, respectively.

The Company has $31.5 million and $29.2 million in deferred financing fees related to its long term debt instruments recorded in the line item “Other Assets” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, respectively. Amortization of deferred financing fees amounted to $8.3 million, $12.3 million, $8.2 million and $10.3 million during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively, and is included in the line item “Interest Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. During Fiscal 2011 the Company recorded $33.6 million of new deferred financing fees related to the New Term Loan Facility, the Notes and the ABL Line of Credit and wrote off $23.0 million of previously capitalized deferred costs related to the Previous Term Loan, Previous Senior Notes, Previous Senior Discount Notes and the ABL Line of Credit which were all settled in connection with the refinancing transactions described above. Amortization expense related to the deferred financing fees as of January 28, 2012 for each of the next four fiscal years and thereafter is estimated to be as follows:

 

Fiscal years

   (in thousands)  

2012

   $ 5,996   

2013

     5,937   

2014

     5,913   

2015

     5,887   

2016 and Thereafter

     7,799   
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 31,532   
  

 

 

 

Deferred financing fees have a weighted average amortization period of approximately 5.5 years.

 

11. Stock Option and Award Plans and Stock-Based Compensation

On April 13, 2006, the Parent’s Board of Directors (the Board) adopted the 2006 Management Incentive Plan (the Plan). The Plan provides for the granting of service-based and performance-based stock options, restricted stock and other forms of awards to directors, executive officers and other key employees of the Company and its subsidiaries. Awards made pursuant to the Plan are comprised of units of Parent’s common stock. Each “unit” consists of nine shares of Class A common stock and one share of Class L common stock of the Parent. The shares comprising a unit are in the same proportion as the shares of Class A and Class L common stock held by all stockholders of the Parent. Options granted pursuant to the Plan are exercisable only for whole units and cannot be separately exercised for the individual classes of the Parent common stock. As of January 28, 2012, there were 730,478 units reserved under the Plan consisting of 6,574,302 shares of Class A common stock of Parent and 730,478 shares of Class L common stock of Parent.

Non-cash stock compensation expense during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 amounted to $5.8 million, $2.2 million, $1.0 million and $6.1 million, respectively. The table below summarizes the types of stock compensation:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Years Ended      35 Weeks
Ended
    Years
Ended
 

Type of Non-Cash Stock Compensation

   January 28,
2012
     January 29,
2011
     January 30,
2010
    May 30,
2009
 

Stock Compensation – Separation Costs

   $ —         $ —         $ 56  (b)    $ 2,425  (a) 

Stock Option Compensation (b)

     4,610         1,378         180        3,448   

Restricted Stock Compensation (b)

     1,187         852         758        251   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 5,797       $ 2,230       $ 994      $ 6,124   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

76


Table of Contents
(a) Included in the line item “Restructuring and Separation Costs” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income.
(b) Included in the line item “Selling and Administrative Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income.

The $0.1 million and $2.4 million, respectively, of stock compensation – separation costs during the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 relate to the separation of certain executives from the Company during the Transition Period and the separation of the Company’s former President and Chief Executive Officer (Former CEO) from the Company during Fiscal 2009. These costs are related to the purchase of a portion of the former executives’ and the Former CEO’s restricted stock and the acceleration of certain options previously granted to the Former CEO (refer to Note 14 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Restructuring and Separation Costs” for further information regarding the separation of the Former CEO from the Company).

Stock Options

Options granted during Fiscal 2011 were all service-based awards granted at exercise prices of $50 per unit and $120 per unit. Options granted during Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 were all service-based awards and had exercise prices of $90 per unit and $180 per unit.

On April 24, 2009, Parent’s Board approved new forms of: (i) Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreements applicable to certain members of executive management and other members of management, both of which are substantially similar to the pre-existing form of the Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement with the exception that the new forms grant options to purchase units of Parent’s common stock at two (instead of three) exercise prices, of which two-thirds of the options granted were at an exercise price of $90 per unit and one-third was at an exercise price of $180 per unit, whereas previously the options under an award were divided equally between exercise prices of $100 or $90 per unit, $180 per unit and $270 per unit; and (ii) Restricted Stock Grant Agreements applicable to certain members of executive management and other members of management, both of which are substantially similar to the pre-existing form of Restricted Stock Agreement except that:

 

   

awards granted under the new agreements vest 50% on the second anniversary of the grant date and 50% on the third anniversary of the grant date (instead of vesting 100% on the first anniversary of the grant date); and

 

   

the new agreements contain a mechanism by which recipients of awards granted thereunder may comply with certain of their income tax obligations relating to such awards.

In order to conform outstanding options to the new forms of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreements described above, on April 24, 2009, the Board also approved amendments to (i) then outstanding option agreements entered into prior to 2007 in order to lower the exercise price of options issued at an exercise price of $270 per unit to $90 per unit; provided, however, that the modified options commenced a new five year vesting period from and after the date of each amendment; and (ii) then outstanding option agreements entered into after 2006 in order to (a) re-price options issued at an exercise price of $100 per unit to $90 per unit; and (b) lower the exercise price of options issued at $270 per unit to $90 per unit, as stated above. The incremental compensation cost resulting from the modifications over the remaining vesting period of the options at the time of modification was $1.2 million, which was expected to be recognized by the Company over the next 5.0 years from the date of modification. As a result of expense incurred and changes to the Company’s forfeiture estimates, the Company expects to recognize the remaining $0.3 million of expense over the next 2.3 years. Incremental compensation expense recognized during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 related to the modification was $0.1 million, $0.1 million, $0.1 million and less than $0.1 million, respectively.

In April 2011, the Parent’s Board of Directors, in order to reflect the dividends paid in connection with the Company’s February 2011 debt refinancing (as discussed in further detail in Note 10 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Long Term Debt”), approved a reduction of the exercise prices of each then outstanding option from $90 per unit and $180 per unit, respectively, to $30.60 and $120.60 per unit, respectively, without affecting the existing vesting schedules thereof. Upon application of modification accounting, which contemplates fair value of awards both before and after the debt refinancing and related dividends, the stock compensation cost did not change as a result of this modification.

 

77


Table of Contents

With the exception of 3,999 options that were granted during the Transition Period and vested during Fiscal 2010, all options vest 40% on the second anniversary of the award with the remaining amount vesting ratably over the subsequent three years. The final exercise date for any option granted is the tenth anniversary of the grant date.

All options awarded pursuant to the Plan become exercisable upon a change of control. Unless determined otherwise by the plan administrator and except as otherwise set forth in the option holders’ agreement, upon cessation of employment, (1) options that have not vested will terminate immediately; (2) units previously issued upon the exercise of vested options will be callable at the Company’s option; and (3) unexercised vested options will be exercisable for a period of 60 days.

As of January 28, 2012, the Company had 472,673 options outstanding to purchase units, all of which are service-based awards. The Company accounts for awards issued under the Plan in accordance with Topic No. 718 using the modified prospective method, which requires companies to record stock compensation expense for all non-vested and new awards.

During Fiscal 2011, the Company recognized non-cash stock option compensation expense of $4.6 million ($2.8 million after tax), inclusive of a $2.3 million forfeiture adjustment as a result of actual forfeitures being less than initially estimated. During Fiscal 2010, the Company recognized non-cash stock option compensation expense of $1.4 million ($0.8 million after tax), net of a $1.4 million forfeiture adjustment that was recorded as a result of actual forfeitures being higher than initially estimated. During the Transition Period, the Company recognized non-cash stock compensation expense of $0.2 million ($0.1 million after tax), net of a $1.7 million forfeiture adjustment that was recorded as a result of actual forfeitures being higher than initially estimated. During Fiscal 2009, the Company recognized non-cash stock option compensation expense of $3.4 million ($1.9 million after tax) , net of $1.2 million of forfeiture adjustments that were recorded as a result of actual forfeitures being higher than initially estimated.

Non-cash stock option compensation expense is included in the line item “Selling and Administrative Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. As of January 28, 2012, there was approximately $4.8 million of unearned non-cash stock-based compensation that the Company expected to recognize as expense over the next 5.0 years. The service-based awards are expensed on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period of 5 years. As of January 28, 2012, 38.5% of outstanding options to purchase units had vested.

Stock option transactions are summarized as follows:

 

     Number
of Units
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price Per
Unit
 

Options Outstanding May 30, 2009

     488,500      $ 123.62   

Options Issued

     52,000       120.00  

Options Forfeited

     (62,000     120.00  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Options Outstanding January 30, 2010

     478,500      $ 123.70   

Options Issued

     82,000        120.00   

Options Forfeited

     (71,001     120.00   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Options Outstanding January 29, 2011

     489,499      $ 123.62   

Options Issued

     94,500        72.12   

Options Exercised

     (60,549     33.97   

Options Forfeited

     (50,777     81.56   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Options Outstanding January 28, 2012

     472,673      $ 69.86   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

78


Table of Contents

Non-vested stock option unit transactions during Fiscal 2011 are summarized below:

 

     Number
of

Units
    Weighted
Average
Grant
Date Fair
Value
Per Unit
 

Non-Vested Options Outstanding, January 29, 2011

     324,100      $ 38.28   

Non-Vested Options Granted

     94,500        24.44   

Non-Vested Options Vested

     (95,132     38.79   

Non-Vested Options Forfeited

     (33,004     35.88   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-Vested Options Outstanding, January 28, 2012

     290,464      $ 34.12   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table summarizes information about the options to purchase units that were outstanding under the Plan as well as options that were exercisable under the Plan as of January 28, 2012:

 

     Options Outstanding      Options Exercisable  

Exercise Prices

   Number
Outstanding
At

January  28,
2012
     Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life (Years)
     Number
Exercisable
at

January  28,
2012
     Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life (Years)
 

$30.60

     244,797         6.8         99,774         5.4   

$50.00

     57,004         9.5         —           —     

$120.00

     28,496         9.5         —           —     

$120.60

     128,376         6.0         68,435         4.5   

$270.00

     14,000         1.1         14,000         1.1   
  

 

 

       

 

 

    
     472,673            182,209      
  

 

 

       

 

 

    

The following table summarizes information about the stock options vested and expected to vest during the contractual term:

 

Exercise Prices

   Options      Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life (Years)
     Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
 

Vested and Expected to Vest as of January 28, 2012

        

$30.60

     204,391         6.7       $ 30.60   

$50.00

     45,600         9.5       $ 50.00   

$120.00

     22,800         9.5       $ 120.00   

$120.60

     111,247         5.8       $ 120.60   

$270.00

     14,000         1.1       $ 270.00   
  

 

 

       
     398,038         
  

 

 

       

 

79


Table of Contents

The fair value of each stock option granted is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted average assumptions used for grants under the Plan during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009:

 

     Fiscal
2011
  Fiscal
2010
  35 Weeks
Ended
January 30,
2010
  Fiscal
2009

Risk-Free Interest Rate

   1.3 – 3.4%   1.8 – 3.4%   2.9 – 3.5%   2.5 – 2.8%

Expected Volatility

   31.10%   38.2%   46.6 %   49.1%

Expected Life (years)

   6.4 – 9.3   6.6 – 9.5   6.0 – 9.9   7.3 – 8.7

Contractual Life (years)

   10.0   10.0   10.0   10.0

Expected Dividend Yield

   0.0%   0.0%   0.0 %   0.0%

Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value of Options Issued at an exercise price of:

        

$30.60

   $34.18   $N/A   $N/A   $N/A

$50.00

   $27.06   $N/A   $N/A   $N/A

$90.00

   $N/A   $49.80   $26.31   $21.77

$120.00

   $18.34   $N/A   $N/A   $N/A

$120.60

   $20.39   $N/A   $N/A   $N/A

$180.00

   $N/A   $34.45   $24.24   $26.24

$270.00

   $N/A   $N/A   $N/A   $25.38

The weighted average grant date fair value of options granted has varied from period to period due to changes in the Company’s business enterprise value resulting from changes in the Company’s business forecast, market conditions and changes in the fair value and book value of the Company’s debt. For additional information, refer to Note 7 to the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements entitled “Goodwill.”

Restricted Stock Awards

Under the Plan, the Company also has the ability to grant restricted stock awards (Awards). During Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010, the Company did not grant any Awards. During the Transition Period, the Company made one grant of 840 Awards of restricted stock at a weighted average fair value per Grant of $56.36. This grant vests 50% on the second anniversary of the grant and 50% on the third anniversary of the grant. During Fiscal 2009, The Company granted 114,245 Awards at a weighted average fair value per Award of $48.32. The fair value of each unit of restricted stock granted under the Plan is estimated on the date of grant using inputs that include the Company’s business enterprise value, the book value of outstanding debt and the number of shares of common stock outstanding. All Awards of restricted stock granted to date under the Plan are service-based awards. Following a change of control, as defined by the Plan, all unvested Awards shall accelerate and vest as of the date of such change of control.

During Fiscal 2011, the Company recorded $1.2 million, inclusive of a $0.2 million forfeiture adjustment related to actual forfeitures being lower than initially estimated. During Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, the Company recorded $0.9 million, net of a $0.2 million forfeiture adjustment related to actual forfeitures being higher than initially estimated, $0.8 million, net of a $0.1 million forfeiture adjustment related to actual forfeitures being higher than initially estimated, and $0.3 million, respectively, of non-cash restricted stock compensation expense. There was no forfeiture adjustment during Fiscal 2009. These expenses were included in the line item “Selling and Administrative Expense” on the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. As of January 28, 2012, there was approximately $0.2 million of unearned non-cash stock-based compensation that the Company expects to recognize as an expense over the next 5 months. Awards of restricted stock are expensed on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period of three years. At January 28, 2012, 63,449 of the outstanding Awards of restricted stock had vested.

 

80


Table of Contents

Award Grant and Forfeiture Activity for the Transition Period, Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010 are summarized below:

 

     Number
of
Awards
 

Awards Outstanding May 30, 2009

     142,032   

Awards Granted

     840   

Awards Forfeited

     (22,813
  

 

 

 

Awards Outstanding January 30, 2010

     120,059   

Awards Granted

     —     

Awards Forfeited

     (21,692
  

 

 

 

Awards Outstanding January 29, 2011

     98,367   

Awards Granted

     —     

Awards Forfeited

     (6,796
  

 

 

 

Awards Outstanding January 28, 2012

     91,571   
  

 

 

 

Award Grant, Vesting and Forfeiture transactions during Fiscal 2011 are summarized below:

 

     Number
of

Awards
    Weighted
Average
Grant
Date Fair
Value
Per
Awards
 

Non-Vested Awards Outstanding, January 29, 2011

     71,140      $ 47.27   

Awards Granted

     —          —     

Awards Vested

     (36,222     48.57   

Awards Forfeited

     (6,796     45.80   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-Vested Awards Outstanding, January 28, 2012

     28,122      $ 45.96   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

12. Lease Commitments

The Company leases stores, distribution facilities and office space under operating and capital leases that will expire principally during the next thirty years. The leases typically include renewal options and escalation clauses and provide for contingent rentals based on a percentage of gross sales.

 

81


Table of Contents

The following is a schedule of future minimum lease payments having an initial or remaining term in excess of one year:

 

     (in thousands)  

Fiscal years

   Operating
Leases (a)
     Capital
Leases
 

2012

   $ 207,169       $ 2,724   

2013

     208,512         2,733   

2014

     182,742         2,755   

2015

     158,130         2,865   

2016 and Thereafter

     595,859         31,189   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Minimum Lease Payments

     1,352,412         42,266   

Amount Representing Interest

     —           (18,266
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Future Minimum Lease Payments

   $ 1,352,412       $ 24,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

a) Total future minimum lease payments include $32.3 million related to options to extend lease terms that are reasonably assured of being exercised and also includes $118.5 million of minimum lease payments for 11 stores that the Company has committed to open during Fiscal 2012.

The above schedule of future minimum lease payments has not been reduced by future minimum sublease rental income of $41.8 million relating to operating leases under non-cancelable subleases and other contingent rental agreements.

The following is a schedule of net rent expense for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Year Ended     35 Weeks
Ended
    Year
Ended
 
     January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
    January 30,
2010
    May 30,
2009
 

Rent Expense:

        

Minimum Rental Payments

   $ 197,327      $ 182,473      $ 117,737      $ 170,134   

Contingent Rental Payments

     2,689        1,882        912        1,515   

Straight-Line Rent Expense

     9,211        10,639        4,196        7,358   

Lease Incentives Amortization

     (15,869     (13,043     (7,543     (9,090

Amortization of Purchased Lease Rights

     901        857        560        956   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Rent Expense

     194,259        182,808        115,862        170,873   

Less All Rental Income

     (19,113     (17,711     (12,741     (18,546 )
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Net Rent Expense

   $ 175,146      $ 165,097      $ 103,121      $ 152,327   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

13. Employee Retirement Plans

The Company has a discretionary noncontributory profit-sharing plan covering employees who meet age and service requirements. The Company also provides additional retirement security to participants through a cash or deferred (salary deferral) feature qualifying under Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code (401(k) Plan). Participation in the salary deferral feature is voluntary. Employees may, up to certain prescribed limits, contribute to the 401(k) Plan and a portion of these contributions are matched by the Company (401(k) Plan Match).

During Fiscal 2011, the Company recorded $3.6 million of 401(k) Plan Match expense. Under the Company’s 401(k) Plan, the Company is able to utilize monies recovered through forfeitures to fund some or all of the annual 401(k) Plan Match expense. A forfeiture is the portion of the Company’s profit sharing contribution that is lost by a 401(k) Plan participant who terminates employment prior to becoming fully vested in such contribution. The Company used $0.2 million of 401(k) Plan forfeitures during Fiscal 2011 to fund a portion of the 401(k) Plan Match for the 2011 401(k) Plan year, which ended on December 31, 2011.

During Fiscal 2010, the Company recorded $2.4 million of 401(k) Plan Match expense. The Company used $0.7 million of 401(k) Plan forfeitures during Fiscal 2010 to fund a portion of the 401(k) Plan Match for the 2010 401(k) Plan year, which ended on December 31, 2010.

During the Transition Period, the Company recorded $0.3 million of 401(k) Plan Match expense. The Company used $3.5 million of 401(k) Plan forfeitures during the Transition Period to fund the entire 401(k) Plan Match for the 2009 401(k) Plan

 

82


Table of Contents

year. The $0.3 million of 401(k) expenses recorded during the Transition Period represented 401(k) Plan Match expense for the Company’s 2010 401(k) Plan year which began on January 1, 2010. The Company used $3.9 million of 401(k) Plan forfeitures during Fiscal 2009 to fund the entire 401(k) Plan match for the 2008 401(k) Plan year.

 

14. Restructuring and Separation Costs

The Company accounts for restructuring and separation costs in accordance with ASC Topic No. 420, “Exit or Disposal Cost Obligations” (Topic No. 420). In accordance with Topic No. 420, the Company recorded a liability for one-time benefit costs related to (i) the Company’s reorganization of certain positions within its stores and corporate locations during Fiscal 2011, (ii) the workforce reduction described below during Fiscal 2009, and (iii) the separation of the Company’s former President and Chief Executive Officer (Former CEO) from the Company during the fiscal year ended May 30, 2009.

During Fiscal 2011, in an effort to improve workflow efficiencies and realign certain responsibilities, the Company effected a reorganization of certain positions within its stores and corporate locations. These changes to the Company’s workforce during Fiscal 2011 resulted in severance and restructuring charges of $7.4 million, which were recorded in the line item “Restructuring and Separation Costs” in the Company’s Consolidated Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Loss (Income).

In an effort to better align the Company’s resources with its business objectives, during Fiscal 2009, the Company reviewed all areas of the business to identify efficiency opportunities to enhance the organization’s performance. In light of the then current challenging economic and retail sales environments, the Company executed the implementation of several initiatives, including some that resulted in the elimination of certain positions and the restructuring of certain other jobs and functions. These reductions, which continued through the Transition Period and, to a lesser extent, Fiscal 2010, resulted in severance and related payroll tax charges during Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 of $2.2 million, $2.4 million and $2.8 million, respectively.

Additionally, on February 16, 2009, the Former CEO entered into a separation agreement with the Company. As part of his separation agreement, the Company paid the Former CEO’s salary through May 30, 2009 at which time continuation payments and other benefits payable as provided in his separation agreement commenced. The continuation payments were paid out in biweekly installments through May 30, 2011. Total continuation payments and other benefits payable to the Former CEO pursuant to the terms of his separation agreement amounted to $4.2 million, $2.4 million of which were non-cash stock compensation.

The table below summarizes the charges incurred related to the Company’s restructuring and separation costs, which are included in the line items “Other Current Liabilities” and “Other Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet:

 

(in thousands)

 
     January 29,
2011
     Charges      Cash
Payments
    January 28,
2012
 

Severance-Restructuring (a)

   $ 6       $ 5,011       $ (5,017   $ —     

Severance-Separation Cost (b)

     1,231         2,427         (2,679     979   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,237       $ 7,438       $ (7,696   $ 979   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(in thousands)

 
     January 30,
2010
     Charges      Cash
Payments
    Other     January 29,
2011
 

Severance-Restructuring (a)

   $ 1,560       $ —         $ (1,444   $ (110   $ 6   

Severance-Separation Cost (b)

     912         2,310         (1,991     —          1,231   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 2,472       $ 2,310       $ (3,435   $ (110   $ 1,237   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

83


Table of Contents

(in thousands)

 
     May 30,
2009
     Charges      Cash
Payments
    January 30,
2010
 

Severance-Restructuring (a)

   $ 1,124       $ 2,429       $ (1,993   $ 1,560   

Severance-Separation Cost (b)

     1,608         —           (696     912   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 2,732       $ 2,429       $ (2,689   $ 2,472   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) The balance as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011 are recorded in the line item “Other Current Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.
(b) As of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the balance is recorded in the line item “Other Current Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. Approximately $0.7 million and $0.2 million of the balance as of January 30, 2010 are recorded in the line items “Other Current Liabilities” and “Other Liabilities,” respectively, in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.

 

15. Income Taxes

(Loss) earnings before income taxes are as follows for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Years Ended      35 Weeks
Ended
     Year
Ended
 
     January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
     January 30,
2010
     May 30,
2009
 

Domestic

   $ (7,618   $ 52,796       $ 28,857       $ (339,955

Foreign

     (2,802     332         1,366         983   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total (Loss) Earnings before income taxes

   $ (10,420   $ 53,128       $ 30,223       $ (338,972
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income tax (benefit) expense is as follows for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Years Ended     35 Weeks
Ended
    Year
Ended
 
     January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
    January 30,
2010
    May 30,
2009
 

Current:

        

Federal

   $ (11,847   $ 11,229      $ 27,191      $ (2,889

State and Other

     5,901        9,159        3,533        (640

Foreign

     2,499        856        661        246   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal

     (3,447     21,244        31,385        (3,283
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred:

        

Federal

     903        3,241        (14,278     (107,924

State

     (1,235     (1,622     (5,433     (35,947

Foreign

     (369     (733     (104     (235
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal

     (701     886        (19,815     (144,106
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income tax (benefit) expense

   $ (4,148   $ 22,130      $ 11,570      $ (147,389
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

84


Table of Contents

The tax rate reconciliations are as follows for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009:

 

     Years Ended     35 Weeks
Ended
    Year
Ended
 
     January 28,
2012
    January 29,
2011
    January 30,
2010
    May 30,
2009
 

Tax at statutory rate (%)

     (35.0 )%      35.0     35.0     (35.0 )% 

State income taxes, net of federal

     (9.5 )     8.9        1.2        (7.8

Change in valuation allowance

     14.8        (2.3     (5.3     0.7   

Permanent & Other (benefits) charges

     13.3        0.5        6.7        (0.2 )

Tax credits

     (30.5     (2.6     (4.1     (0.5

Tax reserves

     (11.6 )     2.2        4.8        (0.7

Impact of Change in State Tax Laws and Rates

     9.0        —          —          —     

Foreign Taxes

     9.7        —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective tax rate (%)

     (39.8 )%      41.7     38.3     (43.5 )% 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The tax effects of temporary differences are included in deferred tax accounts as follows:

 

     (in thousands)  
     January 28, 2012      January 29, 2011  

Period Ended

   Tax
Assets
    Tax
Liabilities
     Tax
Assets
    Tax
Liabilities
 

Current deferred tax assets and liabilities:

         

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 33      $ —         $ 69      $ —     

Compensated absences

     659        —           658        —     

Inventory costs and reserves capitalized for tax purposes

     9,845        —           11,990        —     

Insurance reserves

     6,863        —           9,576        —     

Prepaid items and other items deductible for tax purposes

     —          10,152         —          9,433   

Sales return reserves

     3,031        —           3,037        —     

Reserves

     2,383        —           2,781        —     

Accrued interest

     1,044        —           323        —     

Prepaid items taxable for tax purposes

     1,539        —           501        —     

Deferred revenue

     811        —           1,779        —     

Employee benefit accrual

     6,115        —           4,939        —     

Other

     2,135        —           319        —     

Valuation allowance (net of federal benefit)

     (1,063     —           (1,704     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current deferred tax assets and liabilities

   $ 33,395      $ 10,152       $ 34,268      $ 9,433   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-Current deferred tax assets and liabilities:

         

Property and equipment basis adjustments

   $ —        $ 136,663       $        $ 117,441   

Deferred rent

     25,761        —           22,716        —     

Intangibles – Long-Lived

     —          138,557         —          150,438   

Intangibles – Indefinite-Lived

     —          93,614         —          93,916   

Insurance reserves

     11,994        —           9,283        —     

Employee benefit compensation

     4,816        —           4,968        —     

State net operating losses (net of federal benefit)

     9,845        —           9,286        —     

Prepaid items taxable for tax purposes

     6,698        —           764        —     

Landlord allowances

     28,640        —           28,692        —     

Accrued interest

     2,456        —           3,728        —     

Other

     5,267        —           7,183        —     

Federal and Puerto Rico Tax Credits

     2,658        —           —          —     

Valuation allowance (net of federal – benefit)

     (6,286     —           (4,104     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-current deferred tax assets and liabilities

   $ 91,849      $ 368,834       $ 82,516      $ 361,795   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Deferred Tax Liability

     $ 253,742         $ 254,444   

 

85


Table of Contents

The Company assesses the available positive and negative evidence to estimate if sufficient future taxable income will be generated to utilize the existing deferred tax assets. Based on this evaluation, the Company believes no valuation allowances for federal income taxes are necessary.

The Company also determined that it is more likely than not that the benefit from certain state net operating loss carry forwards will not be realized. Therefore, as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, valuation allowances of $6.1 million and $5.8 million were recorded. In addition, management also determined that a full valuation allowance of $1.2 million was required against the tax benefit associated with Puerto Rico alternative minimum tax credits. If or when recognized, the tax benefits relating to any reversal of the valuation allowance on deferred tax assets will be recorded to the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income.

The Company applies the provisions of FASB Interpretation (“FIN”) No. 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes – An Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109,” as codified in Topic No. 740.

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of gross unrecognized tax benefits (exclusive of interest and penalties) is as follows:

 

(in thousands)

 
     Gross
Unrecognized
Tax Benefits,
Exclusive of
Interest and
Penalties
 

Ending balance at May 30, 2009

   $ 25,128   

Additions for tax positions of the current year

     —     

Additions for tax positions of prior years

     —     

Reduction for tax positions of prior years

     (1,923

Settlements

     —     

Lapse of statute of limitations

     —     
  

 

 

 

Ending balance at January 30, 2010

   $ 23,205   

Additions for tax positions of the current year

     —     

Additions for tax positions of prior years

     1,590   

Reduction for tax positions of prior years

     (1,524 )

Settlements

     —     

Lapse of statute of limitations

     —     
  

 

 

 

Ending balance at January 29, 2011

   $ 23,271   

Additions for tax positions of the current year

     —     

Additions for tax positions of prior years

     6,383   

Reduction for tax positions of prior years

     (7,505

Settlements

     —     

Lapse of statute of limitations

     —     
  

 

 

 

Ending balance at January 28, 2012

   $ 22,149   
  

 

 

 

 

86


Table of Contents

As of January 28, 2012, the Company reported total unrecognized benefits of $22.1 million, of which $8.5 million would affect the Company’s effective tax rate if recognized. As a result of previous positions taken, the Company recorded a reduction of $0.1 million of interest and penalties during Fiscal 2011 in the line item “Income Tax (Benefit) Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Cumulative interest and penalties of $12.5 million have been recorded in the line item “Other Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet as of January 28, 2012. The Company recognizes interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits as part of income taxes. Within the next twelve months, the Company does not expect any significant changes in its unrecognized tax benefits.

As of January 29, 2011, the Company reported total unrecognized benefits of $23.3 million, of which $9.1 million would affect the Company’s effective tax rate if recognized. As a result of previous positions taken, the Company recorded $1.8 million of interest and penalties during Fiscal 2010 in the line item “Income Tax (Benefit) Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Cumulative interest and penalties of $12.6 million have been recorded in the line item “Other Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet as of January 29, 2011. 

As of January 30, 2010, the Company reported total unrecognized benefits of $23.2 million, of which $9.1 million would affect the Company’s effective tax rate if recognized. As a result of previous positions taken, the Company recorded $1.4 million of interest and penalties during the Transition Period in the line item “Income Tax (Benefit) Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Cumulative interest and penalties of $10.8 million have been recorded in the line item “Other Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet as of January 30, 2010.

As of May 30, 2009, the Company reported total unrecognized benefits of $25.1 million, of which $9.1 million would affect the Company’s effective tax rate if recognized. As a result of previous positions taken, the Company recorded a reduction of $7.2 million of interest and penalties during Fiscal 2009 in the line item “Income Tax (Benefit) Expense” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. Cumulative interest and penalties of $9.3 million have been recorded in the line item “Other Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet as of May 30, 2009. For the year ended May 30, 2009, the principal item affecting unrecognized tax benefits was $12.7 million of settlements.

The Company files tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction, Puerto Rico and various state jurisdictions. The Company recently concluded an audit by the Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) for Fiscal 2006 through Fiscal 2010 resulting in a payment of $0.5 million including tax and interest. However, the Company is still open to further examination by the IRS under the applicable statutes of limitations for fiscal years 2008 through 2011. The Company or its subsidiaries’ state income tax returns are open to audit for the fiscal years 2007 through 2011, which includes the Transition Period, under the applicable statutes of limitations. There are ongoing state audits in several jurisdictions and the Company has accrued for possible exposures as required under Topic No. 740. The IRS and the Company agreed to a settlement related to audits of the Company’s Fiscal 2004 and Fiscal 2005 years in the amount of $10.4 million plus interest of $3.1 million that was paid in January 2010.

The Small Business Jobs Act of 2010 and the Tax Relief, Unemployment Insurance Reauthorization and Job Creation Act of 2010 (2010 Tax Relief Act) extended 50% bonus depreciation for qualifying property through December 31, 2012 and created a new 100% bonus depreciation for qualifying property placed in service between September 9, 2010 and December 31, 2011. The impact on cash flow for Fiscal 2011 and Fiscal 2010 was approximately $25.6 million, predominantly attributable to 100% bonus depreciation, and $7.7 million, respectively, which represented an acceleration of tax benefits that would have otherwise been deductible over the life of the qualifying assets.

 

87


Table of Contents
16. Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The Company accounts for fair value measurements in accordance with ASC Topic No. 820, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures,” (Topic No. 820) which defines fair value, establishes a framework for measurement and expands disclosure about fair value measurements. Topic No. 820 defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (exit price), and classifies the inputs used to measure fair value into the following hierarchy:

 

Level 1:    Quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in active markets.
Level 2:    Quoted market prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets; quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active; and model-derived valuations whose inputs are observable or whose significant value drivers are observable.
Level 3:    Pricing inputs that are unobservable for the assets and liabilities and include situations where there is little, if any, market activity for the assets and liabilities.

The inputs into the determination of fair value require significant management judgment or estimation.

Financial Assets

The Company’s financial assets as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011 include cash equivalents, interest rate cap agreements and a note receivable. The Company’s financial liabilities are discussed below. The carrying value of cash equivalents approximates fair value due to its short-term nature. The fair value of the interest rate cap agreements are determined using quotes that are based on models whose inputs are observable LIBOR forward interest rate curves. To comply with the provisions of Topic No. 820, the Company incorporates credit valuation adjustments to appropriately reflect both the Company’s non-performance risk and the respective counterparty’s non-performance risk in the fair value measurements. In adjusting the fair value of the Company’s interest rate cap agreements for the effect of non-performance risk, the Company has considered the impact of netting and any applicable credit enhancements, such as collateral postings, thresholds, mutual puts, and guarantees. As a result, the Company has determined that the inputs used to value this investment fall within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.

The fair value of the note receivable is based on a discounted cash flow analysis whose inputs are unobservable, and therefore it falls within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

Although the Company has determined that the majority of the inputs used to value its interest rate cap agreements fall within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy, the credit valuation adjustments associated with the Company’s interest rate cap agreements utilize Level 3 inputs, such as estimates of current credit spreads to evaluate the likelihood of default. As of January 28, 2012, the Company did not record credit valuation adjustments to the overall valuation of the Company’s interest rate cap agreements. The credit valuation adjustment is not considered significant to the valuation of each of the individual interest rate cap agreements and as a result, the Company has determined that its interest rate cap agreement valuations in their entirety are classified as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy.

The fair values of the Company’s financial assets and the hierarchy of the level of inputs are summarized below:

 

     (in thousands)  
     Fair Value
Measurements
at

January 28,
2012
     Fair Value
Measurements
at

January 29,
2011
 

Assets:

     

Level 1

     

Cash equivalents (including restricted cash)

   $ 34,915       $ 30,331   

Level 2

     

Interest rate cap agreements (a)

   $ 114       $ 3,279   

Level 3

     

Note Receivable (b)

   $ 763       $ 1,090   

 

(a) Included in “Other Assets” within the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets (refer to Note 9 of the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements, entitled “Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities” for further discussion regarding the Company’s interest rate cap agreements).
(b) Included in “Prepaid and Other Current Assets” and “Other Assets” on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. The change in the fair value of our Level 3 note receivable is related to the Company receiving a partial payment in the amount of $0.5 million, which was partially offset by unrealized gains in the amount of $0.2 million.

 

88


Table of Contents

Financial Liabilities

The fair values of the Company’s financial liabilities are summarized below:

 

     (in thousands)  
     January 28, 2012      January 29, 2011  
     Carrying
Amount (3)
     Fair
Value (3)
     Carrying
Amount (3)
     Fair
Value (3)
 

$1,000,000 Senior Secured Term Loan Facility, LIBOR (with a floor of 1.50%) plus 4.8% due in quarterly payments of $2,500 from January 30, 2016 to January 28, 2017, matures with balance due on February 23, 2017.

     949,123         945,247         —           —     

$450,000 Senior Notes, 10%, due to maturity on February 15, 2019, semi-annual interest payments on August 15 and February 15, from February 15, 2012 to February 15, 2019.

     450,000         432,000         —           —     

$900,000 Senior Secured Term Loan Facility, Libor plus 2.3% due in quarterly payments of $2,250 from August 26, 2011 to May 28, 2013.

   $ —         $ —         $ 777,550       $ 773,986   

$600,000 ABL Senior Secured Revolving Facility, Libor plus spread based on average outstanding balance, expires September 2, 2016 (1)

     190,000         190,000         168,600         168,600   

Senior Notes, 11.1%.

     —           —           301,997         313,322   

Senior Discount Notes, 14.5%.

     —           —           99,309         104,274   

Other Debt (2)

     —           —           282         282   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total debt

   $ 1,589,123       $ 1,567,247       $ 1,347,738       $ 1,360,464   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) The carrying value of the ABL Line of Credit approximates its fair value due to its short term nature (borrowings are typically done in 30 day increments) and its variable interest rate.
(2) Other debt includes industrial revenue bonds and two promissory notes.
(3) Capital lease obligations are excluded from the table above.

As of January 28, 2012, the fair value of the Company’s debt, exclusive of capital leases, was $1,567.2 million compared with the carrying value of $1,589.1 million. The fair values presented herein are based on pertinent information available to management as of the respective year end dates. Although management is not aware of any factors that could significantly affect the estimated fair value amounts, such amounts have not been comprehensively revalued for purposes of these financial statements since that date, and current estimates of fair value may differ from amounts presented herein.

Due to the short term nature of the Company’s accounts receivable and accounts payable, the recorded value approximates fair value.

 

17. Commitments and Contingencies

Legal

The Company establishes reserves for the settlement amounts, as well as reserves relating to legal claims, in connection with litigation to which the Company is party from time to time in the ordinary course of business. The aggregate amount of such reserves was $6.1 million and $6.9 million as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, respectively. The Company believes that potential liabilities in excess of those recorded will not have a material adverse effect on the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements. However, there can be no assurances to this effect.

 

89


Table of Contents

We are party to various litigation matters, in most cases involving ordinary and routine claims incidental to our business. We cannot estimate with certainty our ultimate legal and financial liability with respect to such pending litigation matters. However, we believe, based on our examination of such matters, that our ultimate liability will not have a material effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

Lease Guarantees

During Fiscal 2007, we sold lease rights for three store locations that were previously operated by us. In the event of default by the assignee, we could be liable for obligations associated with these real estate leases which have future lease related payments (not discounted to present value) of approximately $2.4 million through the end of our fiscal year ending February 1, 2014. The scheduled future aggregate minimum rentals for these leases over the two consecutive fiscal years following Fiscal 2011 are $1.6 million, and $0.8 million, respectively. We believe the likelihood of a material liability being triggered under these leases is remote, and no liability has been accrued for these contingent lease obligations as of January 28, 2012.

Letters of Credit

The Company had irrevocable letters of credit in the amounts of $35.3 million and $39.6 million as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, respectively.

Letters of credit outstanding as of January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011 amounted to $27.7 million and $30.4 million, respectively, guaranteeing performance under various lease agreements, insurance contracts, and utility agreements. The Company also had outstanding letters of credit arrangements in the aggregate amount of $7.6 million and $9.2 million at January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, respectively, related to certain merchandising agreements. Based on the terms of the credit agreement relating to the ABL Line of Credit, the Company had available letters of credit of $242.6 million as of January 28, 2012.

Severance and Separation

During Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, the Company entered into certain severance and separation agreements which require it to make payments to certain former employees. These obligations resulted in a charge during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 of approximately $7.4 million, $2.2 million, $2.4 million and $7.0 million, respectively. The expense in Fiscal 2011 related to a reorganization of certain positions within the Company’s stores and corporate locations. All other charges, with the exception of a $4.2 million charge during Fiscal 2009 which related to the separation of the Former CEO from the Company ($2.4 million of which represented non-cash stock compensation incurred by the Company), related to the reduction of the Company’s workforce at its corporate office and stores that began in Fiscal 2009.

Purchase Commitments

The Company had $471.6 million of purchase commitments related to goods or services that were not received as of January 28, 2012.

Death Benefits

In November of 2005, the Company entered into agreements with three of the Company’s former executives whereby upon each of their deaths, the Company will pay $1.0 million to the respective designated beneficiary.

 

18. Related Party Transactions

In connection with the purchase of the Company by Bain Capital in April of 2006, the Company entered into an advisory agreement with Bain Capital (the Advisory Agreement) pursuant to which Bain Capital provides management, consulting, financial and other advisory services. Pursuant to the agreement, Bain Capital is paid a periodic fee of $1.0 million per fiscal quarter plus reimbursement for reasonable out-of-pocket fees, and a fee equal to 1% of the transaction value of certain financing, acquisition, disposition or change of control or similar transaction by or involving the Company. Fees paid to Bain Capital amounted to $4.3 million, $4.3 million, $2.9 million and $4.7 million during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively, and are included in the line item “Selling and Administrative Expenses” in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income. The Advisory Agreement has a 10-year initial term, and is thereafter subject to automatic one-year extensions unless the Company or Bain Capital provides written notice of termination,

 

90


Table of Contents

except that the agreement terminates automatically upon an initial public offering or a change of control of the Company. If the Advisory Agreement is terminated early, Bain Capital will be entitled to receive all unpaid fees and unreimbursed out-of-pocket fees and expenses, as well as the present value of the periodic fee that would otherwise have been payable through the end of the 10-year term.

As of both January 28, 2012 and January 29, 2011, the Company had $0.7 million of prepaid advisory fees related to the Advisory Agreement recorded within the line item “Prepaid and Other Current Assets” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.

 

19. Dividends

Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries may declare or pay cash dividends or make other distributions of property to any affiliate unless such dividends are used for certain specified purposes including, among others, to pay general corporate and overhead expenses incurred by Holdings or Parent in the ordinary course of business, or the amount of any indemnification claims made by any director or officer of Holdings or Parent, to pay taxes that are due and payable by Holdings or any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries, pay interest on Holdings Senior Discount Notes or other eligible distributions, provided that no event of default under BCFWC’s debt agreements has occurred or will occur as the result of such interest payment.

Dividends equal to $297.9 million, $0.3 million, $0.2 million and $3.0 million were paid during Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009, respectively. In connection with the offering of the Notes and the refinancing of the Term Loan facility during Fiscal 2011, the Company declared a cash dividend of approximately $300.0 million in the aggregate, on a pro rata basis to the equity holders of Parent. Of the $300.0 million declared dividend, $297.9 million was paid and the remaining $2.1 million is recorded in the line item “Other Current Liabilities” in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet. Dividends paid in Fiscal 2010, the Transition Period and Fiscal 2009 were paid to Parent in order to repurchase capital stock of the Parent from executives who left the Company, which are permissible under our debt agreements.

 

20. Consolidated Guarantor Data

On February 24, 2011, BCFW issued $450 million aggregate principal amount of 10% Senior Notes due in 2019. Holdings and subsidiaries of BCFWC have fully, jointly, severally and unconditionally guaranteed these notes. In addition, Holdings and certain subsidiaries of BCFWC fully, jointly, severally and unconditionally guarantee BCFWC’s obligations under the $600 million ABL Line of Credit and New Term Loan Facility. The following consolidating financial statements present the financial position, results of operations and cash flows of Holdings, BCFW and the guarantor subsidiaries. The Company has one non-guarantor subsidiary that is not wholly-owned and is considered to be “minor” as defined in Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X promulgated by the Securities and Exchange Commission.

Neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries may declare or pay cash dividends or make other distributions of property to any affiliate unless such dividends are used for certain specified purposes including, among others, to pay general corporate and overhead expenses incurred by Holdings or Parent in the ordinary course of business, or the amount of any indemnification claims made by any director or officer of Holdings or Parent, to pay taxes that are due and payable by Holdings or any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries, or to pay interest on the Notes, provided that no event of default under BCFWC’s debt agreements has occurred or will occur as the result of such interest payment.

Amounts reported for intercompany receivables/payables and capital in excess of par value as of January 29, 2011 have been adjusted in the Consolidating Balance Sheets presented below from that originally reported, to separately present certain intercompany activities between BCFW and the Guarantors that had previously been netted in shareholder’s equity. Such adjustments totaled $400.0 million as of January 29, 2011. The Company also made adjustments to reflect a change of $215.8 million in the Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows for fiscal year ended January 29, 2011 within BCFW’s and the Guarantors’ net cash provided by (used in) operating activities and net cash provided by (used in) financing activities. The adjustments had no impact to the Company’s consolidated balance sheets, statements of operations and comprehensive loss and cash flows for any period presented.

The adjustment to the Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet within the Guarantor Data as of January 30, 2010 had the effect of increasing capital in excess of par value of the Guarantors by $226.4 million. The impact to the consolidating statements of cash flows within the Condensed Guarantor Data increased (decreased) net cash provided by financing activities of the Guarantors by $256.1 million with a corresponding change to net cash used in operating activities and a reciprocal change to BCFW for the 35 week transition period ended January 30, 2010 and by $255.6 million and $578.9 million for the fiscal years ended May 30, 2009 and May 31, 2008, respectively.

 

91


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     As of January 28, 2012  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors      Eliminations     Consolidated  

ASSETS

           

Current Assets:

           

Cash and Cash Equivalents

   $ —        $ 11,522      $ 24,142       $ —        $ 35,664   

Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          34,800        —           —          34,800   

Accounts Receivable

     —          21,037        19,082         —          40,119   

Merchandise Inventories

     —          —          682,260         —          682,260   

Deferred Tax Assets

     —          10,008        13,235         —          23,243   

Prepaid and Other Current Assets

     —          13,628        26,434         —          40,062   

Prepaid Income Taxes

     —          18,964        2,355         —          21,319   

Intercompany Receivable

     —          —          471,255         (471,255     —     

Assets Held for Disposal

     —          —          521         —          521   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current Assets

     —          109,959        1,239,284         (471,255 )     877,988   

Property and Equipment – Net of Accumulated Depreciation

     —          80,220        784,995         —          865,215   

Tradenames

       238,000        —           —          238,000   

Favorable Leases – Net of Accumulated Amortization

     —          —          359,903         —          359,903   

Goodwill

     —          47,064        —           —          47,064   

Investment in Subsidiaries

     —          1,995,796        —           (1,995,796     —     

Other Assets

     —          31,696        81,277         —          112,973   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

   $ —        $ 2,502,735      $ 2,465,459       $ (2,467,051   $ 2,501,143   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDER’S EQUITY

           

Current Liabilities:

           

Accounts Payable

   $ —        $ 276,285      $ —         $ —        $ 276,285   

Other Current Liabilities

     —          134,874        86,469         —          221,343   

Intercompany Payable

     —          471,255        —           (471,255     —     

Current Maturities of Long Term Debt

     —          6,953        706         —          7,659   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current Liabilities

     —          889,367        87,175         (471,255 )     505,287   

Long Term Debt

     —          1,582,169        23,295         —          1,605,464   

Other Liabilities

     —          56,909        167,443         —          224,352   

Deferred Tax Liability

     —          85,235        191,750         —          276,985   

Investment in Subsidiaries

     110,945        —          —           (110,945     —     

Commitments and Contingencies

     —          —          —           —          —     

Stockholder’s Equity:

           

Common Stock

     —          —          —           —          —     

Capital in Excess of Par Value

     474,569        474,569        1,063,180         (1,537,749 )     474,569   

Accumulated Deficit

     (585,514     (585,514     932,616         (347,102     (585,514
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Stockholder’s Equity

     (110,945 )     (110,945     1,995,796         (1,884,851     (110,945 )
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Stockholder’s Equity

   $ —        $ 2,502,735      $ 2,465,459       $ (2,467,051   $ 2,501,143   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

92


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     As of January 29, 2011  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors      Eliminations     Consolidated  

ASSETS

           

Current Assets:

           

Cash and Cash Equivalents

   $ —        $ 7,168      $ 23,046       $ —        $ 30,214   

Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          27,800        2,464         —          30,264   

Accounts Receivable

     —          19,691        30,184         —          49,875   

Merchandise Inventories

     —          —          644,228         —          644,228   

Deferred Tax Assets

     —          10,144        14,691         —          24,835   

Prepaid and Other Current Assets

     —          12,617        23,492         —          36,109   

Prepaid Income Taxes

     —          13,934        2,513         —          16,447   

Intercompany Receivable

     —          —          379,785         (379,785     —     

Assets Held for Disposal

     —          —          2,156         —          2,156   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current Assets

     —          91,354        1,122,559         (379,785 )     834,128   

Property and Equipment – Net of Accumulated Depreciation

     —          68,181        789,408         —          857,589   

Tradenames

     —          238,000        —           —          238,000   

Favorable Leases – Net of Accumulated Amortization

     —          —          389,986         —          389,986   

Goodwill

     —          47,064        —           —          47,064   

Investment in Subsidiaries

     187,512        1,782,737        —           (1,970,249     —     

Other Assets

     —          35,627        55,614         —          91,241   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

   $ 187,512      $ 2,262,963      $ 2,357,567       $ (2,350,034    $ 2,458,008   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDER’S EQUITY

           

Current Liabilities:

           

Accounts Payable

   $ —        $ 190,460      $ —         $ —        $ 190,460   

Other Current Liabilities

     —          114,137        98,807         —          212,944   

Intercompany Payable

     —          379,785        —           (379,785     —     

Current Maturities of Long Term Debt

     —          —          14,264         —          14,264   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current Liabilities

     —          684,382        113,071         (379,785 )     417,668   

Long Term Debt

     —          1,248,147        109,874         —          1,358,021   

Other Liabilities

     —          53,844        161,684         —          215,528   

Deferred Tax Liability

     —          89,078        190,201         —          279,279   

Commitments and Contingencies

     —          —          —           —          —     

Stockholder’s Equity:

           

Common Stock

     —          —          —           —          —     

Capital in Excess of Par Value

     466,754        466,754        1,063,182         (1,529,936 )     466,754   

Accumulated Deficit

     (279,242     (279,242     719,555         (440,313     (279,242
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Stockholder’s Equity

     187,512        187,512        1,782,737         (1,970,249     187,512   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Stockholder’s Equity

   $ 187,512      $ 2,262,963      $ 2,357,567       $ (2,350,034   $ 2,458,008   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

93


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     For the Year Ended January 28, 2012  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors     Eliminations     Consolidated  

REVENUES:

          

Net Sales

   $ —        $ —        $ 3,854,134      $ —        $ 3,854,134   

Other Revenue

     —          349        33,048        —          33,397   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

       349        3,887,182        —          3,887,531   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

COSTS AND EXPENSES:

     —             

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization)

     —          —          2,363,464        —          2,363,464   

Selling and Administrative Expenses

     —          180,991        1,034,310        —          1,215,301   

Restructuring and Separation Costs

     —          4,568        2,870        —          7,438   

Depreciation and Amortization

     —          23,240        129,830        —          153,070   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     —          —          1,735        —          1,735   

Other Income, Net

     —          (5,979     (3,963     —          (9,942

Loss on Extinguishment of Debt

     —          36,042        1,722        —          37,764   

Interest Expense

     —          125,853        3,268        —          129,121   

Loss (Earnings) from Equity Investment

     6,272        (213,060     —          206,788        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Costs and Expenses

     6,272        151,655        3,533,236        206,788        3,897,951   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Loss) Income Before (Benefit) Provision for Income Tax

     (6,272 )     (151,306     353,946        (206,788     (10,420

(Benefit) Provision for Income Tax

     —          (145,034     140,886        —          (4,148
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (Loss) Income

   $ (6,272 )   $ (6,272   $ 213,060      $ (206,788   $ (6,272
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

94


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     For the Year Ended January 29, 2011  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors     Eliminations     Consolidated  

REVENUES:

          

Net Sales

   $ —        $ 862      $ 3,668,740      $ —        $ 3,669,602   

Other Revenue

     —          477        31,010        —          31,487   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

       1,339        3,699,750        —          3,701,089   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

COSTS AND EXPENSES:

     —             

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization)

     —          825        2,251,521        —          2,252,346   

Selling and Administrative Expenses

     —          165,450        991,163        —          1,156,613   

Restructuring and Separation Costs

     —          1,256        944        —          2,200   

Depreciation and Amortization

     —          18,159        128,600        —          146,759   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     —          61        2,019        —          2,080   

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

     —          —          —          —          —     

Other Income, Net

     —          (6,541     (4,805     —          (11,346

Interest Expense

     —          82,302        17,007        —          99,309   

Loss (Earnings) from Equity Investment

     (30,998     (182,798     —          213,796        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Costs and Expenses

     (30,998     78,714        3,386,449        213,796        3,647,961   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (Loss) Before Provision (Benefit) for Income Tax

     30,998        (77,375     313,301        (213,796     53,128   

(Benefit) Provision for Income Tax

     —          (108,373     130,503        —          22,130   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Income (Loss)

   $ 30,998      $ 30,998      $ 182,798      $ (213,796   $ 30,998   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

95


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     For the 35 Weeks Ended January 30, 2010  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors     Eliminations     Consolidated  

REVENUES:

          

Net Sales

   $ —        $ 1,135      $ 2,456,432      $ —        $ 2,457,567   

Other Revenue

     —          452        21,278        —          21,730   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

       1,587        2,477,710        —          2,479,297   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

COSTS AND EXPENSES:

     —             

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization)

     —          965        1,491,384        —          1,492,349   

Selling and Administrative Expenses

     —          108,364        651,410        —          759,774   

Restructuring and Separation Costs

     —          2,032        397        —          2,429   

Depreciation and Amortization

     —          10,885        92,720        —          103,605   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     —          197        46,579        —          46,776   

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

     —          —          —          —          —     

Other Income, Net

     —          (7,772     (7,563     —          (15,335

Interest Expense

     —          47,975        11,501        —          59,476   

Loss (Earnings) from Equity Investment

     (18,653     (118,055     —          136,708        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Costs and Expenses

     (18,653     44,591        2,286,428        136,708        2,449,074   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (Loss) Before Provision (Benefit) for Income Tax

     18,653        (43,004     191,282        (136,708     30,223   

(Benefit) Provision for Income Tax

     —          (61,657     73,227        —          11,570   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Income (Loss)

   $ 18,653      $ 18,653      $ 118,055      $ (136,708   $ 18,653   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

96


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     For the Year Ended May 30, 2009  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors     Eliminations     Consolidated  

REVENUES:

          

Net Sales

   $ —        $ 3,012      $ 3,538,969      $ —        $ 3,541,981   

Other Revenue

     —          (319     29,705        —          29,386   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Revenue

     —          2,693        3,568,674        —          3,571,367   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

COSTS AND EXPENSES:

          

Cost of Sales (Exclusive of Depreciation and Amortization)

     —          3,036        2,196,730        —          2,199,766   

Selling and Administrative Expenses

     —          153,436        961,812        —          1,115,248   

Restructuring and Separation Costs

     —          3,259        3,693        —          6,952   

Depreciation and Amortization

     —          26,859        132,748        —          159,607   

Impairment Charges – Long-Lived Assets

     —          —          37,498        —          37,498   

Impairment Charges – Tradenames

     —          294,550        —          —          294,550   

Other Income, Net

     —          (5,452     (546     —          (5,998

Interest Expense

     —          85,518        17,198        —          102,716   

Loss (Earnings) from Equity Investment

     191,583        (124,082     —          (67,501     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Costs and Expenses

     191,583        437,124        3,349,133        (67,501     3,910,339   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Loss) Income Before (Benefit) Provision for Income Tax

     (191,583     (434,431     219,541        67,501        (338,972

(Benefit) Provision for Income Tax

     —          (242,848     95,459        —          (147,389
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (Loss) Income

   $ (191,583   $ (191,583   $ 124,082      $ 67,501      $ (191,583
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

97


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     For the Year Ended January 28, 2012  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors     Eliminations     Consolidated  

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

        

Net Cash Provided by Operations

   $ —        $ (49,557   $ 299,540      $ —        $ 249,983   

INVESTING ACTIVITIES

        

Cash Paid for Property and Equipment

     —          (43,895     (109,478     —          (153,373

Change in Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          (6,978     2,442        —          (4,536 )

Proceeds from Sale of Property and Equipment and Assets Held for Disposal

     —          —          757        —          757   

Lease Acquisition Costs

     —          —          (557     —          (557

Other

     —          (1,064     —          —          (1,064 )
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

     —          (51,937     (106,836     —          (158,773

FINANCING ACTIVITIES

        

Proceeds from Long-Term Debt – ABL Line of Credit

     —          1,073,700        —          —          1,073,700   

Proceeds from Long-Term Debt – Notes Payable

     —          450,000        —          —          450,000   

Proceeds from Long-Term Debt – Term Loan

     —          991,623        —          —          991,623   

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt – ABL Line of Credit

     —          (1,052,300     —          —          (1,052,300

Principal Repayments on Long-Term Debt – Senior Discount Notes

     —          —          (99,309     —          (99,309

Principal Repayments on Long-Term Debt – Senior Notes

     —          (302,056     —          —          (302,056

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt

     —          —          (829     —          (829

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt – Term Loan

     —          (42,500     —          —          (42,500

Principal Repayments on Previous Term Loan

     —          (777,550     —          —          (777,550

Debt Issuance Cost

     —          (30,640     —          —          (30,640

Stock Option Exercise and Related Tax Benefits

     —          2,018        —          —          2,018   

Intercompany Borrowings (Payments)

     —          91,470        (91,470     —          —     

Payment of Dividends

     (297,917     (297,917     —          297,917        (297,917

Receipt of Dividends

     297,917        —          —          (297,917     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Financing Activities

     —          105,848        (191,608     —          (85,760
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          4,354        1,096        —          5,450   

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Period

     —          7,168        23,046        —          30,214   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period

   $ —        $ 11,522      $ 24,142      $ —        $ 35,664   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

98


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     For the Year Ended January 29, 2011  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors     Eliminations     Consolidated  

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

          

Net Cash Provided by Operations

   $ —        $ (63,440 )   $ 272,144      $ —        $ 208,704   

INVESTING ACTIVITIES

          

Cash Paid for Property and Equipment

     —          (37,533     (94,598     —          (132,131

Change in Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          (27,659     —          —          (27,659   

Proceeds from Sale of Property and Equipment and Assets Held for Disposal

     —          —          (38     —          (38

Lease Acquisition Costs

     —          —          (422     —          (422

Redemption of Investment in Money Market Fund

     —          —          240        —          240   

Other

       48        —          —          48   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

     —          (65,144     (94,818     —          (159,962

FINANCING ACTIVITIES

          

Proceeds from Long-Term Debt – ABL Line of Credit

     —          204,200        —          —          204,200   

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt

     —          —          (1,998     —          (1,998

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt – Term Loan

     —          (87,202     —          —          (87,202

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt – ABL Line of Credit

     —          (156,800     —          —          (156,800

Debt Issuance Cost

     —          (1,227     —          —          (1,227

Intercompany Borrowings (Payments)

     —          172,856        (172,856     —          —     

Payment of Dividends

     (251     (251     —          251        (251

Receipt of Dividends

     251        —          —          (251     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Financing Activities

     —          131,576        (174,854     —          (43,278
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          2,992        2,472        —          5,464   

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Period

     —          4,176        20,574        —          24,750   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period

   $ —        $ 7,168      $ 23,046      $ —        $ 30,214   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

99


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     For the 35 Weeks Ended January 30, 2010  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors     Eliminations     Consolidated  

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

          

Net Cash Provided by Operations

   $ —        $ (186,900   $ 290,427      $ —        $ 103,527   

INVESTING ACTIVITIES

          

Cash Paid for Property and Equipment

     —          (18,074     (41,961     —          (60,035

Change in Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          —          17        —          17   

Proceeds from Sale of Property and Equipment and Assets Held for Disposal

     —          —          1,062        —          1,062   

Redemption of Investment in Money Market Fund

     —          —          4,844        —          4,844   

Other

       38        —          —          38   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

     —          (18,036     (36,038     —          (54,074

FINANCING ACTIVITIES

          

Proceeds from Long-Term Debt – ABL Line of Credit

     —          444,315        —          —          444,315   

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt

     —          —          (1,537     —          (1,537

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt – Term Loan

     —          (5,998     —          —          (5,998

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt – ABL Line of Credit

     —          (473,422     —          —          (473,422

Debt Issuance Cost

     —          (13,659     —          —          (13,659

Intercompany Borrowings

     —          256,088        (256,088     —          —     

Payment of Dividends

     (212     —          (212     212        (212

Receipt of Dividends

     212        —          —          (212     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Financing Activities

     —          207,324        (257,837     —          (50,513
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          2,388        (3,448     —          (1,060

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Period

     —          1,788        24,022        —          25,810   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period

   $ —        $ 4,176      $ 20,574      $ —        $ 24,750   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

100


Table of Contents

Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(All amounts in thousands)

 

     For the Year Ended May 30, 2009  
     Holdings     BCFW     Guarantors     Eliminations     Consolidated  

OPERATING ACTIVITIES

          

Net Cash Provided by Operations

   $ —        $ 246,247      $ (73,951   $ —        $ 172,296   

INVESTING ACTIVITIES

          

Cash Paid for Property and Equipment

     —          (31,025     (98,932     —          (129,957

Change in Restricted Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          —          70        —          70   

Proceeds from Sale of Property and Equipment and Assets Held for Disposal

     —          —          369        —          369   

Lease Acquisition Costs

     —          —          (3,978     —          (3,978

Redesignation of Cash Equivalents to Investment in Money Market Fund

     —          —          (56,294     —          (56,294

Redemption of Investment in Money Market Fund

     —          —          50,637        —          50,637   

Purchase of Tradenames Rights

     —          (6,250     —          —          (6,250

Other

     —          123        —          —          123   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Investing Activities

     —          (37,152     (108,128     —          (145,280

FINANCING ACTIVITIES

          

Proceeds from Long-Term Debt – ABL Line of Credit

     —          857,051        —          —          857,051   

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt

     —          —          (1,597     —          (1,597

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt – Term Loan

     —          (2,057     —          —          (2,057

Principal Payments on Long-Term Debt – ABL Line of Credit

     —          (888,344     —          —          (888,344

Purchase of Interest Rate Cap Contract

     —          (3,360     —          —          (3,360

Intercompany Borrowings

     —          (171,711     171,711        —          —     

Payment of Dividends

     (3,000     (3,000     —          3,000        (3,000

Receipt of Dividends

     3,000        —          —          (3,000     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Cash Used in Financing Activities

     —          (211,421     170,114        —          (41,307
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Decrease in Cash and Cash Equivalents

     —          (2,326     (11,965     —          (14,291

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Period

     —          4,114        35,987        —          40,101   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period

   $ —        $ 1,788      $ 24,022      $ —        $ 25,810   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

101


Table of Contents

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Schedule II – Valuation and Qualifying Accounts and Reserves

(All amounts in thousands)

 

Description    Balance at
Beginning
of Period
     Charged
to Costs &
Expenses
    Charged
to Other
Accounts  (1)
     Accounts
Written Off
or
Deductions (2)
     Balance at
End of
Period
 

Year ended January 28, 2012

             

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 175       $ 1,211      $ —         $ 1,301       $ 85   

Sales reserves

   $ 2,423       $ 173      $ 268,046       $ 268,339       $ 2,303   

Year ended January 29, 2011

             

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 513       $ 2,098      $ —         $ 2,436       $ 175   

Sales reserves

   $ 2,275       $ (224   $ 264,585       $ 264,213       $ 2,423   

35 weeks ended January 30, 2010

             

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 629      $ 1,995      $ —         $ 2,111      $ 513  

Sales reserves

   $ 6,161       $ (3,498   $ 177,393       $ 177,781       $ 2,275   

Year ended May 31, 2009

             

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 634       $ 2,832      $ —         $ 2,837       $ 629   

Sales reserves

   $ 6,400       $ —        $ 239,511       $ 239,750       $ 6,161   

Notes:

 

(1) Charged to merchandise sales.
(2) Actual returns and allowances.

 

102


Table of Contents
Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

None.

 

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Our management team, under the supervision and with the participation of our principal executive officer and our principal financial officer, evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures as such term is defined under Rule 13a-15(e) promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (Exchange Act), as of the last day of the fiscal period covered by this report, January 28, 2012. The term disclosure controls and procedures means our controls and other procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms. Disclosure controls and procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to management, including our principal executive and principal financial officer, or persons performing similar functions, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. Based on this evaluation, our principal executive officer and our principal financial officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of January 28, 2012.

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Internal control over financial reporting is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) and Rule 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act as a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the issuer’s principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the issuer’s board of directors, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP and includes those policies and procedures that:

 

   

pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the issuer;

 

   

provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP, and that receipts and expenditures of the issuer are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the issuer; and

 

   

provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the issuer’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In accordance with the internal control reporting requirement of the SEC, management completed an assessment of the adequacy of our internal control over financial reporting as of January 28, 2012. In making this assessment, management used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control – Integrated Framework.

Based on this assessment and the criteria in the COSO framework, management has concluded that, as of January 28, 2012, our internal control over financial reporting was effective.

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

During the fourth quarter of Fiscal 2011, there were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

 

Item 9B. Other Information.

None.

 

103


Table of Contents

Part III

 

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance.

Identification of Our Directors

Set forth below is the biographical information for each of our current directors, including age (as of March 31, 2012), business experience, memberships on committees of our Board of Directors (Board of Directors), the date when each director first became a member of our Board of Directors, and the experience, qualifications, attributes or skills that caused the Board of Directors to conclude that the person should serve as a director.

Joshua Bekenstein – Director. Mr. Bekenstein, 53, has served as a member of our Board of Directors since the closing of the Merger Transaction on April 13, 2006 and currently serves as a member of our Compensation Committee. Mr. Bekenstein is currently a Managing Director of Bain Capital, having joined the firm at its inception in 1984. Mr. Bekenstein serves as a board member of Bombardier Recreational Products, Bright Horizons Family Solutions, Dollarama, Gymboree Corp, Michaels Stores, Toys “R” Us and Waters Corporation. Prior to joining Bain Capital, Mr. Bekenstein spent two years as a consultant at Bain & Company. Mr. Bekenstein received an M.B.A. from Harvard Business School and a B.A. from Yale University. Mr. Bekenstein possesses valuable financial expertise, including extensive experience with capital markets transactions and investments in both public and private companies. Mr. Bekenstein’s service as a member of the boards of directors of several other companies provides him with substantial knowledge of a full range of corporate and board functions.

Jordan Hitch – Director. Mr. Hitch, 45, has served as a member of our Board of Directors since the closing of the Merger Transaction on April 13, 2006 and currently serves as a member of our Compensation Committee. Mr. Hitch is currently a Managing Director of Bain Capital, having joined the firm in 1997. Mr. Hitch serves as a board member of Bombardier Recreational Products, Guitar Center, Gymboree Corp and Bright Horizons Family Solutions. Prior to joining Bain Capital, Mr. Hitch was a consultant at Bain & Company where he worked in the financial services, healthcare and utility industries. Mr. Hitch received an M.B.A., with distinction, from the University of Chicago Graduate School of Business and a B.S. in Mechanical Engineering from Lehigh University. Mr. Hitch possesses valuable financial expertise, including extensive experience with capital markets transactions and investments in both public and private companies.

David Humphrey – Director. Mr. Humphrey, 34, has served as a member of our Board of Directors since September 2009 and currently serves as a member of our Audit Committee. Mr. Humphrey is currently a Principal in the Private Equity group of Bain Capital, having joined the firm in 2001. Mr. Humphrey serves on the board of directors of Bright Horizons Family Solutions and Skillsoft plc. Prior to joining Bain Capital, Mr. Humphrey was an investment banker in the mergers and acquisitions group at Lehman Brothers from 1999 to 2001. Mr. Humphrey received an M.B.A. from Harvard Business School and a B.A. from Harvard University. Mr. Humphrey has substantial knowledge of the capital markets from his experience as an investment banker and is valuable to the Board of Directors’ discussions of our capital and liquidity needs.

Thomas A. Kingsbury – President, Chief Executive Officer and Director. Mr. Kingsbury, 59, has served as our President and Chief Executive Officer, and on our Board of Directors, since December 2008. Prior to joining us, Mr. Kingsbury served as Senior Executive Vice President – Information Services, E-Commerce, Marketing and Business Development of Kohl’s Corporation from August 2006 to December 2008. Prior to joining Kohl’s, Mr. Kingsbury served in various management positions with The May Department Stores Company commencing in 1976 and as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Filene’s division since February 2000. Mr. Kingsbury received a B.B.A. degree from the University of Wisconsin-Madison. Mr. Kingsbury’s day-to-day leadership and experience as our President and Chief Executive Officer gives him unique insights into our challenges, opportunities and operations.

Jay Margolis – Director. Mr. Margolis, 63, has served as a member of our Board of Directors since December 2009. Mr. Margolis most recently served as CEO of Limited Corporation where he oversaw operations of Limited Brands’ Apparel Division (Express and Limited Stores) and was responsible for revamping the product line as well as operations. Mr. Margolis has served as President or Chief Executive Officer of seven retail apparel corporations. Prior to Limited Corporation, Mr. Margolis served as President, Chief Operating Officer & Director of Reebok International Ltd. and as Chief Executive Officer & Chairman of the Board of Esprit de Corporation, USA. He also held senior executive positions at Tommy Hilfiger Inc., Liz Claiborne Inc., Cluett Peabody, Inc., Ron Chereskin Menswear and Bidermann Industries. Mr. Margolis currently serves on the Board of Directors of Boston Beer Company and Godiva Chocolatier, Inc. He earned his B.A. degree from Queens College, part of The City University of New York. Mr. Margolis has extensive executive experience within the retail industry and brings a unique and valuable perspective to the Board of Directors.

Mark Verdi – Director. Mr. Verdi, 45, has served as a member of our Board of Directors since October 2007 and currently serves as a member of our Audit Committee. Mr. Verdi is currently a Managing Director in the Portfolio Group of Bain Capital, having joined the firm in 2004. Mr. Verdi serves on the board of managers of OSI Restaurant Partners and Styron Luxco S.à r.l. Prior to joining Bain Capital, Mr. Verdi worked at IBM Global Services from 2001 to 2004. From 1996 to 2001, Mr. Verdi

 

104


Table of Contents

served as Senior Vice President of Finance and Operations and a member of the board of directors of Mainspring, Inc., a publicly held strategy consulting firm. From 1988 to 1996, Mr. Verdi held various positions at PricewaterhouseCoopers. Mr. Verdi received an M.B.A. from Harvard Business School and a B.S. from the University of Vermont. Mr. Verdi possesses valuable financial expertise, including extensive experience in corporate finance and accounting and extensive experience providing strategic advisory services to numerous organizations.

The directors named above also currently serve as directors of Parent and BCFWC. Other than the provisions of the Stockholders Agreement described below under the caption entitled “Governance of the Company,” we do not know of any arrangements or understandings between any of our directors and any other person pursuant to which a director was or is to be selected as a director, other than any arrangements or understandings with our directors acting solely in their capacities as such.

Governance of the Company

Our business, property and affairs are managed by, or under the direction of, our Board of Directors. In connection with the Merger Transaction, Parent entered into a Stockholders Agreement, dated as of April 13, 2006, with its stockholders, including funds associated with Bain Capital and certain management personnel (Stockholders Agreement). Pursuant to the Stockholders Agreement, each holder of Management Shares and Investor Shares (as each term is defined in the Stockholders Agreement) agrees to cast all votes to which such holder is entitled in respect of such shares:

 

   

To fix the number of members of Parent’s board of directors at such number as may be specified from time to time by the holders of a majority of the Investor Shares; and

 

   

To elect members of Parent’s board of directors as follows:

 

   

one individual nominated by Bain Capital Fund IX, LLC; and

 

   

for the remaining members of Parent’s board of directors, such individuals nominated by the holders of a majority of the Investor Shares.

The Stockholders Agreement additionally provides that Parent will cause our Board of Directors and the board of directors of BCFWC to consist at all times of the same members as Parent’s board of directors.

Our Board of Directors currently consists of six members. Each director shall hold office until a successor is duly elected and qualified or until his earlier death, resignation or removal as provided in our By-Laws. Directors may be removed at any time, with or without cause, by the holders of a majority of the shares then entitled to vote at an election of directors. Our Board of Directors currently has two standing committees: an Audit Committee and a Compensation Committee.

Nominees to Board of Directors

Since the date of the Stockholders Agreement there have been no material changes to the procedures by which security holders may recommend nominees to our Board of Directors.

Audit Committee

Our Board of Directors has a separately designated audit committee consisting of Messrs. Verdi and Humphrey. Our Board of Directors has determined that each of its members is financially literate. However, as we are now privately held and controlled by affiliates of Bain Capital, our Board of Directors has determined that it is not necessary to designate one or more of our Audit Committee members as an “audit committee financial expert” at this time.

Identification of Our Executive Officers

Our executive officers have been elected to their respective offices by our Board of Directors. Set forth below is the biographical information for each of our current executive officers (other than Mr. Kingsbury, our President and Chief Executive Officer, and a member of our Board of Directors, whose biographical information is set forth above under the caption entitled “Identification of Our Directors”), including age (as of March 31, 2012) and business experience:

Fred Hand – Executive Vice President of Stores. Mr. Hand, 48, has served as our Executive Vice President of Stores since February 2008. Prior to joining us, Mr. Hand served as Senior Vice President, Group Director of Stores of Macy’s, Inc. from March 2006 to February 2008. From 2001 to 2006, Mr. Hand served as Senior Vice President, Stores and Visual Merchandising of Filene’s Department Stores. Mr. Hand held various other positions at the May Department Stores Company from 1991 to 2001, including Area Manager, General Manager, and Regional Vice President.

 

105


Table of Contents

Joyce Manning Magrini – Executive Vice President – Human Resources. Ms. Magrini, 57, has served as our Executive Vice President – Human Resources since November 2009. Prior to joining us, Ms. Magrini served as Executive Vice President – Administration of Finlay Jewelry since June 2005. From March 1999 to June 2005, Ms. Magrini served as Senior Vice President of Human Resources of Finlay Jewelry and from January 1995 to February 1999, Ms. Magrini was Vice President of Human Resources of Finlay Jewelry. Ms. Magrini held various human resources and customer service positions at Macy’s from 1978 through December 1994. Ms. Magrini holds a B.A. degree from Montclair State University and a J.D. degree from Seton Hall University.

Hobart Sichel – Executive Vice President and Chief Marketing Officer. Mr. Sichel, 47, has served as our Executive Vice President and Chief Marketing Officer since May 2011. Prior to joining us and since 1998, Mr. Sichel was at McKinsey & Company, where he was most recently a Principal and co-led McKinsey’s Retail Marketing practice in North America. Prior to 1998, Mr. Sichel worked in various capacities across consumer facing industries including retail, e-Commerce, packaged goods, financial services, and media. Mr. Sichel holds an MBA from Columbia University and a B.A. from Vassar College.

Todd Weyhrich – Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer. Mr. Weyhrich, 48, has served as our Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer since November 2007. From the commencement of his employment with us in August 2007 through November 2007, Mr. Weyhrich served as our Chief Accounting Officer and interim Chief Financial Officer. Prior to joining us, Mr. Weyhrich served as Chief Financial Officer of Arby’s Restaurant Group, Inc. from May 2004 to June 2006. From February 2003 to August 2003, he served as Senior Vice President – Merger Integration of The Sports Authority and served as Senior Vice President – Chief Accounting Officer and Logistics of The Sports Authority from February 2001 to February 2003. Prior to that, Mr. Weyhrich was Senior Vice President – Finance and Logistics from 2000 to 2001 and Vice President – Controller from 1995 to 2000 of Pamida Holdings Corporation, which became a wholly-owned subsidiary of ShopKo Stores, Inc. in July 1999. Prior to that, Mr. Weyhrich served in various capacities, most recently as Audit Senior Manager, with Deloitte & Touche LLP from 1985 to 1995. Mr. Weyhrich received a B.A. degree in Business Administration from Wayne State College in Wayne, Nebraska.

We do not know of any arrangements or understandings between any of our executive officers and any other person pursuant to which he or she was or is to be selected as an officer, other than any arrangements or understandings with our officers acting solely in their capacities as such.

Code of Ethics

We have adopted a written Code of Business Conduct and Ethics (Code of Business Conduct) which applies to all of our directors, officers and other employees, including our principal executive officer, principal financial officer and controller. In addition, we have adopted a written Code of Ethics for the Chief Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers (Code of Ethics) which applies to our principal executive officer, principal financial officer, controller and other designated members of our management. We will provide any person, without charge, upon request, a copy of our Code of Business Conduct or Code of Ethics. Such requests should be made in writing to the attention of our Corporate Counsel at the following address: Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, 1830 Route 130 North, Burlington, New Jersey 08016.

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance

As we do not have a class of equity securities registered pursuant to Section 12 of the Exchange Act, none of our directors, officers or stockholders were subject to the reporting requirements of Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act during the fiscal year ended January 28, 2012 (Fiscal 2011).

 

Item 11. Executive Compensation

Compensation Discussion and Analysis

The following Compensation Discussion and Analysis describes the material elements of compensation for our most highly compensated executive officers as of January 28, 2012 (collectively our named executive officers). The specific amounts paid or payable to our named executive officers are disclosed in the tables and narrative following this Compensation Discussion and Analysis. The following discussion cross-references those specific tabular and narrative disclosures where appropriate.

Setting Named Executive Officer Compensation

Currently comprised of Messrs. Hitch and Bekenstein, the Compensation Committee (Committee) of our Board of Directors is tasked with discharging our Board of Directors’ responsibilities related to oversight of the compensation of our named executive officers and ensuring that our executive compensation program meets our corporate objectives.

The Committee (and, in some cases, our entire Board of Directors) makes decisions regarding salaries, annual incentive awards and long-term equity incentives for our named executive officers. The Committee is also responsible for reviewing and

 

106


Table of Contents

approving corporate goals and objectives relevant to the compensation of our named executive officers, as well as evaluating their performance in light of those goals and objectives. Based on this review and evaluation, as well as on input from our chief executive officer regarding the performance of our other named executive officers and his recommendations as to their compensation, the Committee, as authorized by our Board of Directors, determines and approves our named executive officers’ compensation. Our named executive officers do not play a role in their own compensation determinations.

Objectives of Our Compensation Program

Our overall objective is to have a compensation program that will allow us to attract and retain executive officers of a caliber and level of experience necessary to effectively manage our business and motivate such executive officers to increase our value. We believe that, in order to achieve that objective, our program must:

 

   

provide each named executive officer with compensation opportunities that are competitive with the compensation opportunities available to executives in comparable positions at companies with whom we compete for talent;

 

   

tie a significant portion of each named executive officer’s compensation to our financial performance; and

 

   

promote and reward the achievement of objectives that our Board of Directors believes will lead to long-term growth in shareholder value.

New Members of Our Management Team

Mr. Sichel joined us during Fiscal 2011 in line with our overall goal of attracting superior talent. Consequently, the process for determining the compensation of Mr. Sichel was significantly influenced by our need to attract new and additional talent.

Prior to hiring a new executive officer to fill a vacant or a newly created position, we typically described the responsibilities of the position and the skills and level of experience required for the position to one or more national executive search firms. The search firm(s) informed us about the compensation ranges of executives in positions with similar responsibilities at comparable companies, and provided us with guidance as to how different skills and levels of experience impact those compensation ranges. By using the information obtained from the search firms, as well as information obtained from compensation surveys, the Committee determined target compensation ranges for the positions we were seeking to fill, taking into account the individual candidates’ particular skills and levels of experience. In specific circumstances, when making an offer to a new executive officer, the Committee also considered other factors such as the amount of unvested compensation that the executive officer had with his former employer.

By using information provided by one or more search firms, the Committee sought to ensure that the compensation information considered was both comprehensive and reliable. The Committee would most likely use a similar benchmarking process in seeking to fill new executive officer positions, as it has enabled us to attract superior individuals for key positions by providing for reasonable and competitive compensation.

Elements of Compensation

Our executive compensation program utilizes three primary integrated elements to accomplish the objectives described above:

 

   

base salary;

 

   

annual incentive awards; and

 

   

long-term equity incentives.

We believe that we can meet the objectives of our executive compensation program by achieving a balance among these three elements that is competitive with our industry peers and creates appropriate incentives for our named executive officers. Actual compensation levels are a function of both corporate and individual performance as described under each compensation element below. In making compensation determinations, the Committee considers, among other things, the competitiveness of compensation both in terms of individual pay elements and the aggregate compensation package.

Mix of Total Compensation

In regard to the allocation of the various pay elements within the total compensation program, no formula or specific weightings or relationships are used. Cash compensation includes base salary and annual incentive awards which, for our named executive officers, are targeted to a percentage of base salary to emphasize performance-based compensation, rather than salaries or other forms, which are fixed compensation. Perquisites and other types of non-cash benefits are used on a limited basis and, other than certain relocation and temporary living expenses reimbursed by us, represent only a small portion of total compensation for our named executive officers. Equity compensation includes long-term incentives, which provide a long-term capital appreciation element to our executive compensation program and are not performance-based.

 

107


Table of Contents

Base Salary

We provide our named executive officers with base salary in the form of fixed cash compensation to compensate them for services rendered during the fiscal year. The base salary of each of our named executive officers is reviewed for adjustment annually by the Committee. Generally, in making a determination of whether to make base salary adjustments, the Committee considers the following factors:

 

   

our success in meeting our strategic operational and financial goals;

 

   

each named executive officer’s individual performance;

 

   

length of service to us of such named executive officer;

 

   

changes in scope of responsibilities of such named executive officer; and

 

   

competitive market compensation paid by other companies for similar positions.

In addition, the Committee considers internal equity within our organization and, when reviewing the base salaries of our named executive officers, their current aggregate compensation.

Mr. Sichel was hired by us during Fiscal 2011 and Ms. Magrini was hired by us during the Transition Period. Mr. Kingsbury was hired by us during Fiscal 2009 and Messrs. Hand and Weyhrich were hired by us during Fiscal 2008. Accordingly, their initial base salaries were determined through the “executive search firm” process described above under the caption entitled “New Members of Our Management Team.” Effective as of November 2007, Mr. Weyhrich received an increase in salary of $100,000 from $350,000 to $450,000 to reflect his promotion to Chief Financial Officer. Mr. Weyhrich was appointed as our Chief Financial Officer in November 2007 after having served as our interim Chief Financial Officer since the commencement of his employment with us in August 2007. The base salaries of each of our named executive officers in fiscal years after the fiscal year in which they were hired are subject to annual review by the Committee.

The Committee reviewed the annual base salary rates for Ms. Manning and Messrs. Kingsbury, Hand and Weyhrich and, pursuant to its review, increased each named executive officer’s salary by 2.5% effective May 1, 2011. In addition, after considering internal equity within our organization, their current aggregate compensation and scope of current responsibilities, the Committee further increased the base salary of Mr. Weyhrich and Ms. Manning by $27,219 and $36,875, respectively, effective May 1, 2011.

Annual Incentive Awards

Annual incentive awards are an important part of the overall compensation we pay our named executive officers. Unlike base salary, which is fixed, annual incentive awards are paid only if specified performance levels are achieved. We believe that annual incentive awards encourage our named executive officers to focus on specific short-term business and financial goals. Our named executive officers are eligible to receive annual cash incentive awards under our annual Management Incentive Bonus Plan (Bonus Plan).

Under our Bonus Plan, each named executive officer has an annual incentive target expressed as a percentage of his or her base salary as follows: 100% for Mr. Kingsbury and 50% for each named executive officer other than Mr. Kingsbury. As described below, each named executive officer’s annual incentive award is based on a combination of our Adjusted EBITDA results and comparative store sales results (collectively, the Financial Component) and his or her personal performance (Performance Component). We believe that this methodology more closely aligns the named executive officer’s interests with our stockholders’ interests while also rewarding each of the named executive officers for his or her individual performance.

The Financial Component is based 50% on our Adjusted EBITDA results and 50% on our comparative store sales results. Although our Adjusted EBITDA results and comparative store sales results are measured separately, Adjusted EBITDA must meet or exceed a predetermined threshold Adjusted EBITDA in order for any bonus payment to be made with respect to the comparative store sales results portion of the Financial Component.

In determining each portion of the Financial Component, (i) achievement at a predetermined target approved by the Compensation Committee would result in a potential payout at the target level; (ii) if actual results are less than the established target but greater than the predetermined threshold approved by the Compensation Committee, each named executive officer would be eligible for an incentive bonus equivalent to a fractional share of his or her target bonus determined by the proportion of the actual results achieved in relation to the target; and (iii) if actual results are greater than the target, each named executive officer would be eligible for his or her target bonus plus an additional bonus payment equivalent to a percentage of every dollar above the target (not subject to any maximum amount). If Adjusted EBITDA is less than the threshold Adjusted EBITDA, no bonus would be payable.

 

108


Table of Contents

Once the Committee assesses the Financial Component, specific payments to each named executive officer depend on the Committee’s rating of his or her personal performance. A rating of “Meets Expectations” means that the named executive officer has generally met his or her individual performance objectives for the year and would be eligible to receive up to 100% of his or her target bonus. A rating of “Exceeds Expectations” means that a named executive officer has exceeded his or her individual performance objectives and would be eligible to receive up to 110% of his or her target bonus. Finally, a rating of “Outstanding” means that a named executive officer has substantially exceeded his or her individual performance objectives and would be eligible to receive up to 125% of his or her target bonus. Where a named executive officer is rated below “Meets Expectations,” no bonus would be payable. Notwithstanding the foregoing formulas, the Committee has the discretion to pay more or less than the formula amount to any named executive officer.

Following the conclusion of Fiscal 2011, the Committee assessed the Financial Component and the Performance Component. Our actual Adjusted EBITDA for Fiscal 2011 amounted to $350 million, greater than the predetermined threshold ($332.5 million of Adjusted EBITDA) approved by the Committee and equal to our Adjusted EBITDA target of $350 million for Fiscal 2011. As a result, the Adjusted EBITDA portion of the Financial Component was achieved at 100% of the target. Our comparative store sales increased 0.7% during Fiscal 2011, less than our comparative store sales target of a 3.1% increase but greater than the predetermined threshold (zero percent comparative store sales increase) approved by the Committee. As a result, the comparative store sales portion of the Financial Component was achieved at 36.5% of the target. With respect the Performance Component, the Committee assigned each named executive officer a rating of “Meets Expectations.”

After giving effect to the Committee’s assessment, awards under the Bonus Plan were made to our named executive officers in April 2012. The Bonus Plan awards earned by each named executive officer are reported in the “Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation” column of the Summary Compensation Table.

Long-Term Incentives

We believe that long-term incentives are a component of compensation that helps us to attract and retain our named executive officers. These incentives also align the financial rewards paid to our named executive officers with our long-term performance, thereby encouraging our named executive officers to focus on long-term goals. We offer long-term incentives under our 2006 Management Incentive Plan (Incentive Plan) which Parent adopted concurrently with the Merger Transaction. Under the Incentive Plan, named executive officers (as well as other key employees) are eligible to receive restricted common stock of Parent or stock options to purchase Parent’s common stock. Awards of restricted stock and stock options under the Incentive Plan generally are expressed in terms of “units.” Each unit consists of nine shares of Class A Common Stock of Parent (Class A Stock) and one share of Class L Common Stock of Parent (Class L Stock). Awards granted under the Incentive Plan are exercisable only for whole units and cannot be separately exercised for the individual classes of Parent common stock. More detail about the stock options and restricted stock granted to our named executive officers (including the vesting provisions related to these grants) are set out in the tables that follow this discussion.

Options

Upon commencement of their employment with us, Ms. Magrini and Messrs. Kingsbury, Weyhrich, Hand, and Sichel received options to purchase 10,000, 100,000, 12,500, 10,000, and 10,000 units under the Incentive Plan, respectively. As provided for under his employment agreement with us, Mr. Weyhrich received options to purchase an additional 7,500 units concurrently with his elevation to Chief Financial Officer in November 2007. On April 13, 2009, Mr. Hand received options to purchase an additional 10,000 units. On May 13, 2011, Ms. Magrini received options to purchase an additional 10,000 units.

The amounts of each named executive officer’s option awards were based on their position with us and the total target compensation packages deemed appropriate for their positions. The Committee concluded that these awards were reasonable and consistent with the nature of the individuals’ responsibilities.

Options granted to our named executive officers prior to April 2009 under the Incentive Plan are exercisable in three tranches; options granted to our named executive officers from and after April 2009 under the Incentive Plan are exercisable in two tranches. Grants are made at or above fair market value, and the tranche structure of the option awards, with increasing exercise prices in each tranche, is designed to encourage long-term performance by tying the value of the options to long-term increases in the value of Parent’s common stock. Option awards granted to each named executive officer vest 40% on the second anniversary of the award with the remaining options vesting ratably over the subsequent three years. All options become exercisable upon a change of control and, unless determined otherwise by the plan administrator, upon cessation of employment, options that have not vested will terminate immediately (except with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, whose option agreement provides a formula for calculating a number of options which will vest in the event that Mr. Kingsbury’s employment is terminated without cause or Mr. Kingsbury resigns with good reason), units issued upon the exercise of vested options will be callable under our Stockholders Agreement, and unexercised vested options will be exercisable for a period of 60 days. The final exercise date for any option granted is the tenth anniversary of the grant date.

On April 24, 2009, our Board of Directors approved amendments to all outstanding option agreements between us and our employees, including certain of our named executive officers, to exchange eligible options on a one-for-one basis for

 

109


Table of Contents

replacement options and re-price certain options to a lower exercise price. All then-current employees who previously received options were permitted to exchange options with an exercise price of $270 per unit for an equal number of options with an exercise price of $90 per unit and a new five year vesting schedule commencing on April 24, 2009. In addition, all then-current employees with options having an exercise price of $100 per unit were eligible to have the exercise price of such options re-priced to $90 per unit with no loss of vesting. These amendments were designed to create better incentives for employees to remain with us and contribute to achieving our business objectives.

In April 2011, our Board of Directors, in connection with the dividend paid pursuant to our February 2011 debt refinancing, approved an adjustment of the exercise prices of each then outstanding option from $180 per unit and $90 per unit to $120.60 per unit and $30.60 per unit, respectively, without affecting the existing vesting schedules thereof.

Restricted Stock

Upon commencement of his employment with us, Mr. Kingsbury received an award of 7,500 units of restricted stock. In the judgment of the Committee, this grant was appropriate for Mr. Kingsbury’s position and was instrumental to our successful recruiting of Mr. Kingsbury as our President and Chief Executive Officer.

On April 24, 2009, our Board of Directors granted one-time awards of units of restricted stock to certain of our management employees, including certain of our named executive officers as follows: Mr. Kingsbury – 3,611; Mr. Weyhrich – 4,444; and Mr. Hand – 5,111. The amount of each named executive officer’s restricted stock award was based on his position with us and the total target compensation package deemed appropriate for his position. The Committee concluded that these awards were reasonable and consistent with the nature of the named executive officer’s responsibilities.

Units of restricted stock granted (i) on April 24, 2009 to each of our named executive officers vested 50% on April 24, 2011 and will vest 50% on April 24, 2012, and (ii) to Mr. Kingsbury on December 2, 2008 vested one-third on December 2, 2011. Two-thirds of the units of restricted stock granted to Mr. Kingsbury on December 2, 2008 were vested as of December 2, 2010. Except as otherwise noted:

 

   

units of restricted stock vest only in the event that the recipient remains continuously employed by us on each vesting date;

 

   

all unvested units of restricted stock will remain unvested following any change of control, provided, however, that 100% of such units will vest if, following a change of control, the recipient’s employment is terminated by us without cause or the recipient resigns with good reason (except with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, whose restricted stock agreements provide that all unvested units of restricted stock will accelerate and vest as of the date of a change of control);

 

   

all unvested units of restricted stock will vest if the recipient’s employment is terminated prior to vesting as a result of the recipient’s death or disability;

 

   

all unvested units of restricted stock will automatically be forfeited (and will not vest) if the recipient’s employment with us terminates for any reason (other than if, following a change of control, recipient’s employment is terminated by us without cause or the recipient resigns with good reason) prior to the vesting date (except with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, whose restricted stock agreements include a formula for calculating a number of units of restricted stock which will vest in the event that Mr. Kingsbury’s employment is terminated without cause or Mr. Kingsbury resigns with good reason);

 

   

all vested units of restricted stock are callable under the Stockholders Agreement; and

 

   

holders of unvested restricted units have the right to vote such units but cannot dispose of them until such units have vested.

Each holder of a restricted stock grant that was outstanding when the dividend pursuant to our February 2011 debt refinancing was declared is entitled to receive a pro rata dividend equivalent payment upon the vesting of such holder’s restricted stock.

Benefits and Perquisites

Benefits

We maintain broad-based benefits that are provided to all full-time employees, including health, dental, life and disability insurance. Certain of these benefits require employees to pay a portion of the premium. Except with respect to life insurance (our named executive officers all receive life insurance in an amount equal to three time their annual base salary) and participation in an executive medical reimbursement plan (pursuant to which our named executive officers receive a certain amount per year, to offset the cost of covered medical expenses), these benefits are offered to our named executive officers on the same basis as all other employees. We also maintain a savings plan in which our named executive officers who have at least one year of employment with us are eligible to participate, along with a substantial majority of our employees. The savings plan is a traditional 401(k) plan, under which we match 100% of the first 3% of the named executive officer’s compensation that is deferred and 50% of the next 2% of the named executive officer’s compensation that is deferred, up to the Internal Revenue Code limit for each respective year in which the named executive officer participates in the plan.

 

110


Table of Contents

Perquisites or Other Personal Benefits

Although our named executive officers are entitled to few perquisites or other personal benefits that are not otherwise available to all of our employees, we do provide our named executive officers with perquisites that the Committee believes are reasonable and consistent with the perquisites that would be available to them at companies with whom we compete for experienced senior management. We provide each of our named executive officers with a car allowance or use of a company car. Additionally, certain of our newly hired named executive officers have received reimbursement of certain relocation and temporary living expenses (subject to clawback in the event of termination on the conditions specified in each such named executive officer’s employment agreement).

These perquisites or other personal benefits represent a relatively modest portion of each named executive officer’s total compensation. The cost of these perquisites or other personal benefits to us is set forth below in the Summary Compensation Table below under the column “All Other Compensation,” and detail about each element is set forth in the footnote table following the Summary Compensation Table.

Tax and Accounting Considerations

We structure our compensation program in a manner that is consistent with our compensation philosophy and objectives. However, in the course of making decisions about executive compensation, the Committee takes into account certain tax and accounting considerations. For example, they take into account Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code regarding non-qualified deferred compensation. In making decisions about executive compensation, they also consider how various elements of compensation will affect our financial reporting. For example, they consider the impact of FASB ASC Topic 718 – Stock Compensation, which requires us to recognize the cost of employee services received in exchange for awards of equity instruments based upon the grant date fair value of those awards.

While it is the general intention of the Committee to design the components of our executive compensation program in a manner that is tax efficient for both us and our named executive officers, there can be no assurance that they will always approve compensation that is advantageous for us from a tax perspective.

Termination Based Compensation

Severance arrangements applicable to our named executive officers are set forth in each of their respective employment agreements. We believe these arrangements play an important role in protecting our highly competitive business by restricting our executive officers from working for a competitor during the specified severance period. Additionally, each named executive officer’s option grant agreement and restricted stock agreement (if applicable) contains terms regarding vesting in connection with the termination of employment and changes in control. A detailed discussion of compensation payable upon termination or a change in control is provided below under the caption entitled “Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change-in-Control.”

Compensation Committee Report

We, the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc., have reviewed and discussed the “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” set forth above with management and, based on such review and discussions, recommended to the Board of Directors that the “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” set forth above be included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors:

Jordan Hitch

Joshua Bekenstein

The preceding Compensation Committee Report shall not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing made by us under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, notwithstanding any general statement contained in any such filing incorporating this report by reference, except to the extent we incorporate such report by specific reference.

 

111


Table of Contents

Summary Compensation Table

The following table sets forth summary information concerning the compensation of our named executive officers:

 

Name and Principal Position

  Fiscal Year   Salary ($)     Bonus ($)     Stock
Awards
($) (3)
    Option
Awards

($) (4)
    Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
($)
    All Other
Compensation
($) (6)
    Total ($)  

Thomas A. Kingsbury,

  2011     887,167        —          —          —          609,494        55,378        1,552,039   

President and Chief Executive Officer

  2010     884,920        500,000  (5)      —          —          1,074,784        43,029        2,502,733   
  5/31/09-1/30/2010     556,260        —          —          —          915,441        4,250        1,475,951   
  2009     422,381        —          769,809        3,169,250        451,128        357,477        5,170,045   

Todd Weyhrich,

  2011     492,548        —          —          —          170,625        45,855        709,028   

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

  2010     457,486        —          —          —          284,502        14,784        756,772   
  5/31/09-1/30/2010     294,396        —          —          —          242,322        15,969        552,687   
  2009     508,942       —          203,535        52,430        241,245        12,402        1,018,554   

Joyce Manning Magrini

Executive Vice President – Human Resources

  2011     386,539        —          —          237,236        136,500        45,061        805,336   
  2010

5/31/09-1/30/2010

   

 

348,657

90,386

  

  

   

 

—  

150,000 

  

(1) 

   

 

—  

—  

  

  

   

 

—  

263,400

  

  

   

 

213,783

69,235

  

  

   

 

71,099

24,273

  

  

   

 

633,539

597,294

  

  

Hobart Sichel,

  2011     326,923        125,000  (1)      —          237,236        113,906        238,083        1,041,148   

Executive Vice President and Chief Marketing Officer (2)

               

Fred Hand,

  2011     521,863        —          —          —          179,263        49,526        750,652   

Executive Vice President – Stores

  2010     512,260        —          —          —          309,226        19,952        841,438   

 

(1) Represents a sign-on bonus pursuant to the terms of the named executive officer’s employment agreement.
(2) Mr. Sichel has served as our Executive Vice President and Chief Marketing Officer since May 2011.
(3) Represents the aggregate grant date fair value of awards of restricted units of Parent’s common stock. Each unit consists of nine shares of Class A Stock and one share of Class L Stock. The amounts shown were calculated in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718, excluding the effect of certain forfeiture assumptions, and are based on a number of key assumptions described in our financial statements. The vesting terms and conditions of restricted stock awards to our named executive officers are described below under the table entitled “Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End.”
(4)

Represents the aggregate grant date fair value of awards of options to purchase units of Parent’s common stock. With respect to each of Messrs. Kingsbury and Weyhrich, the amount shown in Fiscal 2009 includes the incremental value (calculated in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718) of the repriced and exchanged options described below under the caption entitled “Narrative Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table” and the table entitled “Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End.” Each unit consists of nine shares of Class A Stock and one share of Class L Stock. The amounts shown were calculated in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718, excluding the effect of certain forfeiture

 

112


Table of Contents
  assumptions, and are based on a number of key assumptions described in our Consolidated Financial Statements. The amount of compensation, if any, actually realized by a named executive officer from the exercise and sale of vested options will depend on numerous factors, including the continued employment of the named executive officer during the vesting period of the award and the amount by which the unit price on the day of exercise and sale exceeds the option exercise price. The vesting terms and conditions of option awards to our named executive officers are described below under the table entitled “Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End.”
(5) Represents a special one-time bonus award for Mr. Kingsbury for his performance during Fiscal 2010.
(6) The amounts reported in this column for Fiscal 2011 represent the following:

 

Name

   Relocation
Expenses

($) (a)
     Company
Matching
401(k)
Contributions

($)
     Automobile
Reimbursement

($) (b)
     Tax
Reimbursements

($) (c)
     Other
Perquisites or
Contractual
Arrangements
($) (d)
     Total
($)
 

Thomas A. Kingsbury

     —           9,800         12,578         8,006         24,994         55,378   

Todd Weyhrich

     —           9,800         24,758         —           11,297         45,855   

Joyce Manning Magrini

     —           9,800         19,534         —           15,727         45,061   

Hobart Sichel

     221,349         —           16,734         —           —           238,083   

Fred Hand

     —           9,800         14,924         —           24,802         49,526   

 

(a) Consists of (i) a one-time relocation allowance of $200,000 in lieu of any other payment or reimbursement for the costs of Mr. Sichel’s relocation to a non-temporary residence within reasonable commuting distance from our principal offices in Burlington, New Jersey; and (ii) reimbursement in the amount of $21,349 for certain temporary housing expenses.
(b) Consists of the following incremental costs to us associated with the provision of the use of a company car: (i) the value of the use of the company car purchased in Fiscal 2011 and the Transition Period for Mr. Hand $8,750 and Ms. Magrini $12,750, respectively; (ii) $1,000 of automobile insurance costs for each of Mr. Kingsbury, Mr. Weyhrich, Mr. Hand and Ms. Magrini; (iii) fuel expenses in the following amounts: Mr. Kingsbury: $5,745; Mr. Weyhrich – $2,925; Ms. Magrini – $5,784; and Mr. Hand – $5,174; and (iv) automobile allowances in the following amounts: Mr. Kingsbury: $5,833; Mr. Weyhrich – $20,833; Mr. Sichel – $16,734.
(c) Represents reimbursement of income taxes related to certain out of pocket expenses.
(d) Represents amounts reimbursed by us to each named executive officer as part of participation in our executive medical reimbursement plan.

 

113


Table of Contents

Grants of Plan-Based Awards

The following table sets forth information regarding our grants of plan-based awards to our named executive officers during Fiscal 2011:

 

          Estimated Future Payouts Under
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Awards
(1)
                             

Name

   Grant Date    Threshold
($)
     Target
($)
     Maximum
($) (2)
     All Other
Stock
Awards:
Number
of Units
(#)
     All Other
Option
Awards:
Number of
Securities
Underlying
Options

(#) (3)
     Exercise
or Base
Price of
Option
Awards
($/Unit)
(4)
     Grant
Date
Fair
Value of
Stock
and
Option
Awards
($) (5)
 

Thomas A. Kingsbury

   N/A      446,515         893,031         —           —           —           —           —     

Todd Weyhrich

   N/A      125,000         250,000         —           —           —           —           —     

Joyce Manning Magrini

   N/A      100,000         200,000         —           —           —           —           —     
   5/13/2011      —           —           —           —           6,667         50         178,342   
   5/13/2011      —           —           —           —           3,333         120         58,894   

Hobart Sichel

   N/A      83,375         166,750         —           —           —           —           —     
   6/9/2011      —           —           —           —           6,667         50         178,342   
   6/9/2011      —           —           —           —           3,333         120         58,894   

Fred Hand

   N/A      131,328         262,656         —           —           —           —           —     

 

(1) The amounts shown represent the threshold and target payments the named executive officer was eligible to receive under our Bonus Plan for Fiscal 2011 in the event that the named executive officer “Meets Expectations” pursuant to the Performance Component. For Mr. Sichel, the amounts reflect prorated values for the partial year he was employed. Amounts actually paid to each named executive officer are reported in the “Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation” column of the Summary Compensation Table.
(2) Under the Bonus Plan, each named executive officer is eligible for his or her target bonus plus an additional bonus payment equivalent to a percentage of every dollar above the Adjusted EBITDA or comparative store sales targets in the event that actual results exceed the targets (subject to adjustment based on the Performance Component determination discussed under the section above entitled “Annual Incentive Awards”). Accordingly, the Bonus Plan provides for unlimited potential awards and, as such, this column contains no maximum values. For additional information regarding the Bonus Plan, please refer to the section above entitled “Annual Incentive Awards.”
(3) The amounts shown represent the options to purchase units of Parent’s common stock granted to each named executive officer under the Incentive Plan during Fiscal 2011. Such options vest 40% on the second anniversary of the grant date with the remaining options vesting ratably over the subsequent three years. For additional information regarding these grants, please refer to the section above entitled “Long Term Incentives.”

 

114


Table of Contents
(4) All grants of options have an exercise price equal to or greater than the fair market value of the units of Parent’s common stock on the date of grant. Because we are a privately-held company and there is no market for units of Parent’s common stock, fair market value is determined by our Board of Directors based on available information that is material to the value of units of Parent’s common stock.
(5) The amounts shown in this column reflect the grant date fair value of the option awards calculated in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718.

Narrative Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table

We have written employment agreements with each of our named executive officers that provide for, among other things, the payment of base salary, reimbursement of certain costs and expenses, and for each named executive officer’s participation in our Bonus Plan and employee benefit plans. Additionally, we have written agreements with each named executive officer pursuant to which we have granted them units of restricted stock and/or options to purchase units under our Incentive Plan. For additional information regarding such grants, please refer to the section above entitled “Long Term Incentives.”

In addition, each employment agreement specifies payments and benefits that would be due to such named executive officer upon the termination of his or her employment with us. For additional information regarding amounts payable upon termination to each of our named executive officers, see the discussion below under the caption entitled “Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change in Control.”

On April 24, 2009, our Board of Directors approved amendments to all outstanding option agreements between us and our employees, including certain of our named executive officers, to exchange eligible options on a one-for-one basis for replacement options and re-price certain options to a lower exercise price. All then-current employees who previously received options were permitted to exchange options with an exercise price of $270 per unit for an equal number of options with an exercise price of $90 per unit and a new five year vesting schedule commencing on April 24, 2009. In addition, all then-current employees with options having an exercise price of $100 per unit were eligible to have the exercise price of such options re-priced to $90 per unit with no loss of vesting.

In April 2011, our Board of Directors, in connection with the dividend paid pursuant to our February 2011 debt refinancing, approved an adjustment of the exercise prices of each then outstanding option from $90 per unit and $180 per unit, respectively, to $30.60 and $120.60 per unit, respectively, without affecting the existing vesting schedules thereof.

 

115


Table of Contents

Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End

The following table sets forth information with respect to the outstanding stock options and units of unvested restricted stock held by each named executive officer as of January 28, 2012:

 

          Option Awards    Stock Awards  

Name

   Grant Date    Number of
Units
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)
Exercisable
     Number of
Units
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)
Unexercisable
(1)
    Option
Exercise
Price ($/
Unit)
     Option
Expiration
Date
   Number
of Units
That
Have
Not
Vested
(#) (6)
     Market
Value
Of
Units of
Stock
That
Have
Not
Vested
($) (7)
 

Thomas A. Kingsbury

   12/2/2008      —           —          —         —        —           —     
   12/2/2008      5,000         20,000  (2)      30.60       12/2/2018      —           —     
   12/2/2008      15,000         10,000  (4)      120.60       12/2/2018      —           —     
   12/2/2008      10,000         15,000  (3)      30.60       12/2/2018      —           —     
   4/24/2009      —           —          —         —        1,806         63,156   

Todd Weyhrich

   8/21/2007      —           834  (2)      30.60       8/21/2017      —           —     
   8/21/2007      3,333         834  (4)      120.60       8/21/2017      —           —     
   8/21/2007      —           2,501  (3)      30.60       8/21/2017      —           —     
   11/5/2007      —           500  (2)      30.60       11/5/2017      —           —     
   11/5/2007      2,000         500  (4)      120.60       11/5/2017      —           —     
   11/5/2007      —           1,500  (3)      30.60       11/5/2017      —           —     
   4/24/2009      —           —          —         —        2,222         77,703   

Joyce Manning Magrini

   11/2/2009      2,666         4,001  (5)      30.60       11/2/2019      —           —     
   11/2/2009      1,333         2,000  (4)      120.60       11/2/2019      —           —     
   5/13/2011      —           6,667        50       5/13/2021      —           —     
   5/13/2011      —           3,333        120       5/13/2021      —           —     

Hobart Sichel

   6/9/11      —           6,667        50       6/9/21      —           —     
   6/9/11      —           3,333        120       6/9/21      —           —     

Fred Hand

   2/11/2008      666         1,334  (2)      30.60       2/11/2018      —           —     
   2/11/2008      1,999         1,334  (4)      120.60       2/11/2018      —           —     
   2/11/2008      1,333         2,001  (3)      30.60       2/11/2018      —           —     
   4/13/2009      2,666         4,001  (5)      30.60       4/13/2019      —           —     
   4/13/2009      1,333         2,000  (4)      120.60       4/13/2019      —           —     
   4/24/2009      —           —          —         —        2,556         89,383   

 

(1) All options vest 40% on the second anniversary of the grant date, 20% on the third anniversary of the grant date, 20% on the fourth anniversary of the grant date and 20% on the fifth anniversary of the grant date.
(2) Pursuant to an amendment to the named executive officer’s option agreement on April 24, 2009, the exercise price of these options was modified to be $90 per unit. In April 2011, our Board of Directors, in connection with the dividend paid pursuant to our February 2011 debt refinancing, approved an adjustment of the exercise prices of each then outstanding option from $90 per unit to $30.60 per unit without affecting the existing vesting schedules thereof.
(3)

Pursuant to an amendment to the named executive officer’s option agreement on April 24, 2009, these options were replaced on a one-for-one basis for replacement options with (i) an exercise price of $90 per unit, and (ii) a new five-year vesting period commencing from and after such date, such that 40% of these options shall vest on April 24, 2011, and then one-third of the

 

116


Table of Contents
  remaining 60% shall vest on April 24, 2012, 2013 and 2014, respectively. In April 2011, our Board of Directors, in connection with the dividend paid pursuant to our February 2011 debt refinancing, approved an adjustment of the exercise prices of each then outstanding option from $90 per unit to $30.60 per unit without affecting the existing vesting schedules thereof.
(4) In April 2011, our Board of Directors, in connection with the dividend paid pursuant to our February 2011 debt refinancing, approved an adjustment of the exercise prices of each then outstanding option from $180 per unit to $120.60 per unit without affecting the existing vesting schedules thereof.
(5) In April 2011, our Board of Directors, in connection with the dividend paid pursuant to our February 2011 debt refinancing approved an adjustment of the exercise price of each then outstanding option from $90 per unit to $30.60 per unit without affecting the existing vesting schedules thereof.
(6) Provided, in each case, that the named executive officer remains continuously employed by us on such date, the units of restricted stock granted to such named executive officer on April 24, 2009 will vest 50% on April 24, 2012. 50% of the units of restricted stock granted to such named executive officer on April 24, 2009 vested on April 24, 2011.
(7) The amounts set forth in this column represent the fair market value of the unvested shares of restricted stock held by the named executive officer using a price of $34.97 per unit, which was the fair market value of each unit at the end of Fiscal 2011.

 

117


Table of Contents

Option Exercises and Stock Vested

The following table sets forth information regarding stock options exercised by our named executive officers, and the vesting of our named executive officers’ restricted stock, during Fiscal 2011.

 

     Option Awards      Stock Awards  

Name

   Number of
Units

Acquired
on Exercise (1)
     Value Realized
on Exercise ($) (2)
     Number of
Units

Acquired
on Vesting (#)
    Value Realized
on Vesting ($)
 

Thomas A. Kingsbury

     25,000         109,250         1,805  (4)      63,085  (5) 
           2,500  (3)      87,425  (6) 

Todd Weyhrich

     7,998         34,951         2,222  (4)      77,659  (5) 

Joyce Manning Magrini

     —           —           —          —     

Hobart Sichel

     —           —           —          —     

Fred Hand

     1,333         5,825         2,556  (4)      89,332  (5) 

 

(1) Messrs. Kingsbury, Weyhrich and Hand exercised the options reflected in this column on January 13, 2012, January 13, 2012 and January 12, 2012, respectively.
(2) The dollar value reflects the difference in the fair market value of our units at the time of exercise ($34.97) and the option’s exercise price ($30.60). These amounts were not realized by the named executive officers as they retained ownership of the units received upon exercise.
(3) Amount shown vested on December 2, 2011.
(4) Amount shown vested on April 24, 2011.
(5) The value realized is equal to the fair market value of $34.95 per unit on the day of vesting multiplied by the number of units that vested.
(6) The value realized is equal to the fair market value of $34.97 per unit on the day of vesting multiplied by the number of units that vested.

Pension Benefits

None of our named executive officers participate in or have account balances in qualified or non-qualified defined benefit plans sponsored by us.

Nonqualified Deferred Compensation

None of our named executive officers participate in or have account balances in any defined contribution or other plan that provides for the deferral of compensation on a basis that is not tax-qualified.

 

118


Table of Contents

Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change-in-Control

The following is a discussion of payments and benefits that would be due to each of our named executive officers upon the termination of his or her employment with us, including termination in connection with a change of control. The amounts in the table below assume that each termination was effective as of January 27, 2012, the last business day of Fiscal 2011, and are merely illustrative of the impact of a hypothetical termination of each executive’s employment. The amounts to be payable upon an actual termination of employment can only be determined at the time of such termination based on the facts and circumstances then prevailing.

Employment Agreements

We maintain employment agreements with each of our named executive officers that provide certain benefits upon termination of employment.

Termination Without Cause or for Good Reason

Each named executive officer’s employment agreement provides that he will be entitled to receive the following in the event that (i) his or her employment is terminated by us without “cause” or by him or her for “good reason” (as those terms are defined below), or (ii) the term of his or her employment expires on the expiration date specified in his or her employment agreement (as applicable):

 

   

all previously earned and accrued but unpaid base salary and vacation and unpaid business expenses up to the date of such termination;

 

   

as applicable, any unpaid guaranteed bonuses or unreimbursed permitted relocation expenses;

 

   

a pro-rated portion of the then current year’s annual target performance bonus under the Bonus Plan through the date of termination, based on actual results (Bonus Payment);

 

   

a severance payment (Severance Payment) equal to his or her then current base salary (in Mr. Kingsbury’s case, two times his then current base salary); and

 

   

full continuation of his hospital, health, disability, medical and life insurance benefits during the one-year period commencing on the date of termination (in Mr. Kingsbury’s case, a two year period commencing on the date of termination) (Healthcare Continuation).

Each named executive officer shall only be entitled to receive the Bonus Payment, Severance Payment and Healthcare Continuation in the event that he or she:

 

   

executes a release of claims in respect of his employment with us; and

 

   

has not breached, as of the date of termination or at any time during the period for which such payments or services are to be made, certain restrictive covenants (Restrictive Covenants) contained in his or her employment agreement regarding (i) confidentiality, (ii) intellectual property rights, and (iii) non-competition and non-solicitation (each of which extend for a period of one year (or two years, in the case of Mr. Kingsbury) following termination of employment).

Our obligation to make such payments or provide such services will terminate upon the occurrence of any such breach during such period. Payments in connection with a termination without cause or for good reason shall be (unless otherwise provided) paid by us in regular installments in accordance with our general payroll practices.

For purposes of each named executive officer’s employment agreement,

 

   

“cause” means the named executive officer (i) is convicted of a felony or other crime involving dishonesty towards us or material misuse of our property; (ii) engages in willful misconduct or fraud with respect to us or any of our customers or suppliers or an intentional act of dishonesty or disloyalty in the course of his or her employment; (iii) refuses to perform his or her material obligations under his or her employment agreement which failure is not cured within 15 days after written notice to him or her; (iv) misappropriates one or more of our material assets or business opportunities; or (v) breaches a Restrictive Covenant which breach, if capable of being cured, is not cured within 10 days of written notice to him or her; and

 

   

“good reason” means the occurrence of any of the following events without the written consent of the named executive officer: (i) a material diminution of his or her duties or the assignment to him or her of duties that are inconsistent in any

 

119


Table of Contents

 
  substantial respect with the position, authority or responsibilities associated with his or her position; (ii) our requiring him or her to be based at a location which is 50 or more miles from his or her principal office location on the date he or she commences employment with us; or (iii) a material breach by us of our obligations pursuant to his or her employment agreement (which breach goes uncured after notice and a reasonable opportunity to cure). No such condition is deemed to be “good reason” unless (i) we are notified within 30 days of the initial existence of such condition and are provided with a period of at least 30 days from the date of notice to remedy the condition, and (ii) (a) with respect to each named executive officer other than Mr. Kingsbury, within 10 days after the expiration of such period (but in no event later than 120 days after the initial existence of the condition), the named executive officer actually terminates his or her employment with us by providing written notice of resignation for our failure to remedy the condition; or (b) with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, at any time during the period commencing 10 days after the expiration of such period and ending 180 days after Mr. Kingsbury’s knowledge of the initial existence of the condition (but in all events within two years after the initial existence of said condition), Mr. Kingsbury actually terminates his employment with us by providing written notice of resignation for our failure to remedy the condition.

Termination for Any Other Reason

In the event that he or she is terminated for any other reason, including as a result of his death, disability, voluntary resignation for other than good reason or by resolution of our Board of Directors for cause, each named executive officer’s employment agreement provides that he shall only be entitled to receive all previously earned and accrued but unpaid base salary, vacation and unpaid business expenses up to the date of such termination.

Change-in-Control

None of our named executive officers are entitled to receive any payments upon a change-in-control pursuant to the terms of his or her employment agreement.

Option and Restricted Stock Agreements

Pursuant to the terms of the option agreements with each of our named executive officers, all options become exercisable upon a change of control and, unless determined otherwise by the plan administrator, upon cessation of employment and subject to the terms of the Incentive Plan,

 

   

options that have not vested will terminate immediately (except with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, whose option agreement provides a formula for calculating a number of options which will vest in the event that Mr. Kingsbury’s employment is terminated by us without cause or Mr. Kingsbury resigns with good reason);

 

   

units issued upon the exercise of vested options will be callable under our Stockholders Agreement; and

 

   

unexercised vested options will be exercisable for a period of 60 days;

 

   

Pursuant to the terms of the restricted stock agreements with each of our named executive officers and subject to the terms of the Incentive Plan,

 

   

all unvested units of restricted stock will remain unvested following any change of control, provided, however, that 100% of such units will vest if, following a change of control, the recipient’s employment is terminated by us without cause or the recipient resigns with good reason (except with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, whose restricted stock agreements provide that all unvested units of restricted stock will accelerate and vest as of the date of a change of control);

 

   

all unvested units of restricted stock will vest if the recipient’s employment is terminated prior to vesting as a result of the recipient’s death or disability;

 

   

all unvested units of restricted stock will automatically be forfeited (and will not vest) if the recipient’s employment with us terminates for any reason (other than if, following a change of control, recipient’s employment is terminated by us without cause or the recipient resigns with good reason) prior to the vesting date (except with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, whose restricted stock agreements include a formula for calculating a number of units of restricted stock which will vest in the event that Mr. Kingsbury’s employment is terminated without cause or Mr. Kingsbury resigns with good reason); and

 

   

all vested units of restricted stock are callable under the Stockholders Agreement.

 

120


Table of Contents

Termination Without Cause or for Good Reason

 

Name

   Base
Salary

($) (1)
     Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
($) (2)
     Health
Benefits
($) (3)
     Other
Payments
($)
     Option and
Restricted
Stock
Acceleration
($) (4)
     Termination
for Any
Other
Reason

($) (5)
     Option
Acceleration
Upon
Change of
Control

($) (6)
     Restricted
Stock
Acceleration
Upon
Change of
Control,
Death or
Disability

($) (7)
 

Thomas A. Kingsbury

     1,786,062         609,494         18,194         —           79,543         —           152,950         63,156   

Todd Weyhrich

     500,000         170,625         9,098         —           —           —           23,314         77,703   

Joyce Manning Magrini

     400,000         136,500         9,098         —           —           —           17,484         —     

Hobart Sichel

     500,000         113,906         9,098         —           —           —           —           —     

Fred Hand

     525,312         179,263         9,031         —           —           —           32,058         89,383   

 

(1) The amount set forth in this column (i) reflects the severance pay the named executive officers would be entitled to receive based upon salaries in effect as of January 27, 2012, (ii) with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, assumes that the severance pay will be provided for a period of two years in accordance with the terms of his employment agreement; and (iii) with respect to each named executive officer other than Mr. Kingsbury, assumes that the severance pay will be provided for a period of one year in accordance with the terms of his or her employment agreement.
(2) The amounts set forth in this column for each of the named executive officers reflect the actual award that they received pursuant to the Bonus Plan with respect to Fiscal 2011.
(3) The amounts set forth in this column have been calculated based upon the health coverage rates and elections in effect as of as January 28, 2011 for each of the named executive officers, and assumes that coverage will be provided (i) for a period of two years for Mr. Kingsbury; and (ii) for a period of one year with respect to each named executive officer other than Mr. Kingsbury.
(4) As described above, upon cessation of employment and subject to the terms of the Incentive Plan, options and restricted stock that have not vested will terminate immediately (except with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, whose option and restricted stock agreements contain a formula for calculating a number of options and restricted stock which will vest in the event that Mr. Kingsbury’s employment is terminated without cause or if Mr. Kingsbury resigns with good reason). Because units of our capital stock are not publicly traded, the value of our stock is only available when a valuation is performed. The units were valued at $34.97 per unit (Valuation Price) as of January 27, 2012. The dollar value in this column with respect to Mr. Kingsbury assumes withholding tax obligations due in connection with the restricted stock are satisfied by a cash payment to us and represents the sum of the (i) product obtained by multiplying the number of accelerated units of restricted stock (calculated pursuant to the formula contained in Mr. Kingsbury’s restricted stock agreements) by the Valuation Price, and (ii) product obtained by multiplying (a) the number of accelerated options with an exercise price less than the Valuation Price, by (b) the amount by which the Valuation Price exceeds such exercise price.
(5) Under our employment agreement with each named executive officer, in the event that such named executive officer is terminated for any reason other than by us without cause or by him or her for good reason, including as a result of death, disability, voluntary resignation for other than good reason or by resolution of our Board of Directors for cause, he or she shall only be entitled to receive all previously earned and accrued but unpaid base salary, vacation and unpaid business expenses up to the date of such termination.

 

121


Table of Contents
(6) As described above, all unvested outstanding options fully vest upon a change-in-control. Accordingly, the amount set forth in this column represents (assuming withholding tax obligations due in connection with vesting are satisfied by a cash payment to us) the product obtained by multiplying (i) the number of unvested options with an exercise price less than the Valuation Price, by (ii) the amount by which the Valuation Price exceeds such exercise price.
(7) As described above, all unvested units of restricted stock will remain unvested following any change of control, provided, however, that 100% of such units will vest if, following a change of control, the named executive officer’s employment is terminated by us without cause or the named executive officer resigns with good reason (except with respect to Mr. Kingsbury, whose restricted stock agreements provide that all unvested units of restricted stock will accelerate and vest as of the date of a change of control). In all cases, unvested units of restricted stock will vest if the named executive officer’s employment is terminated prior to vesting as a result of the named executive officer’s death or disability. Accordingly, the amount set forth in this column represents (assuming withholding tax obligations due in connection with the restricted stock are satisfied by a cash payment to us), (i) with respect to Mr. Kingsbury in the event of a change of control or his death or disability, the product obtained by multiplying the number of unvested units of restricted stock by the Valuation Price; and (ii) with respect to each named executive officer other than Mr. Kingsbury, the product obtained by multiplying the number of unvested units of restricted stock by the Valuation Price in the event (a) of such named executive officer’s death or disability, or (b) the employment of such named executive officer is terminated by us without cause or he or she resigns with good reason following a change of control.

Share Repurchase Rights

Under the Stockholders Agreement, upon termination of a named executive officer’s employment for any reason, Parent has the option to purchase all or any portion of the named executive officer’s (i) fully vested units of restricted stock at the fair market value of the units; and (ii) units issued upon the exercise of options held by such named executive officer at the fair market value of the units (provided that in the event such termination was by us for cause or following such termination of employment (for any reason) the executive has breached any non-competition obligation he has to us under any agreement, the per unit purchase price will be equal to the lesser of the exercise price paid by the executive to obtain the unit and the fair market value of the units). If Parent elects to purchase the named executive officer’s units, it must deliver notice to the named executive officer no later than 180 days after the later of (i) the date of termination or (ii) the exercise of any option originally granted to the executive. The fair market value of the units shall be determined as of the later of (i) the 181st day after the exercise of the applicable option or after such unit has vested pursuant to the terms of the restricted stock grant, as applicable, and (ii) the date on which Parent’s notice is delivered.

Compensation of Directors

Other than Mr. Margolis, the members of our Board of Directors are not separately compensated for their services as directors. Compensation provided to Mr. Kingsbury in his capacity as an executive officer is provided in the Summary Compensation Table above. All directors, however, are entitled to receive reimbursement for out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with rendering such services.

Mr. Margolis receives an annual fee of $30,000 as compensation for his services as a director, which is payable in equal quarterly installments (and pro-rated for partial quarters). In addition, Mr. Margolis received options to purchase 2,000 units under the Incentive Plan in connection with his election to our Board of Directors on December 15, 2009. 40% of these options vested on December 15, 2011 and the remainder will vest 20% on each of December 15, 2012, December 15, 2013 and December 15, 2014.

The table below summarizes the compensation paid to Mr. Margolis during Fiscal 2011:

 

Name

   Fees
Earned
Or Paid
in

Cash
($)
     Stock
Awards

($)
     Option
Awards
($)
     Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation

($)
     Change
in Pension
Value

and
Nonqualified

Deferred
Compensation
Earnings
($)
     All Other
Compensation

($)
     Total
($)
 

Jay Margolis

     30,000         —           —           —           —           —           30,000   

On December 22, 2011, Mr. Margolis exercised options to purchase 799 units. As of January 28, 2012, Mr. Margolis had 1,201 options outstanding.

 

122


Table of Contents

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

Messrs. Bekenstein and Hitch served at all times during Fiscal 2011, and continue to currently serve, on the Committee. Neither of these individuals (i) has ever been an officer or an employee of ours, nor (ii) except as otherwise set forth herein, has any relationship that is required to be disclosed pursuant to the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission. In addition, none of our executive officers serve (or served at any time during Fiscal 2011) as a member of the Board of Directors or Compensation Committee of any entity that has one or more executive officers serving as a member of our Board of Directors or the Committee.

 

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

Security Ownership of Our Directors, Executive Officers, and 5% Beneficial Owners

As a result of the Merger Transaction, all of BCFWC’s outstanding capital stock is beneficially owned by us, and all of our outstanding capital stock is beneficially owned by Parent. The following table shows information about the beneficial ownership of Parent’s Class A Stock and Class L Stock as of March 31, 2012 by:

 

   

Each person we know to be the beneficial owner of at least five percent of Parent’s common stock;

 

   

Each current director;

 

   

Each of our named executive officers; and

 

   

All current directors and executive officers as a group.

The table also sets forth ownership information for these persons regarding unvested stock options for which these persons are not deemed to beneficially own the underlying shares of common stock.

The percentages of shares outstanding provided in the table below are based upon 5,104,677 shares of Class L Stock and 45,942,093 shares of Class A Stock outstanding as of March 31, 2012.

 

123


Table of Contents

Name and Address of Beneficial Owner (1)

   Amount and
Nature of

Class L Stock
Beneficially
Owned
     Percentage of
Class
    Amount and
Nature of

Class A Stock
Beneficially
Owned
     Percentage of
Class
    Options to
Purchase Units
Not Exercisable
Within the Next
60 Days
 

Affiliates of Bain Capital, LLC (2)

     4,944,444         96.9     44,499,996         96.9     —     

Jay Margolis (3)

     799         *        7,191         *        1,201   

Todd Weyhrich (4)

     19,109         *        171,981         *        5,335   

Joyce Manning Magrini (5)

     3,999         *        35,991         *        16,001   

Thomas Kingsbury (6)

     71,111         1.4     639,999         1.4     40,000   

Fred Hand (7)

     18,442         *        165,978         *        6,669   

Hobart Sichel (8)

     —           —          —           —          10,000   

Joshua Bekenstein (9)

     —           —          —           —          —     

Jordan Hitch (9)

     —           —          —           —          —     

Mark Verdi (10)

     —           —          —           —          —     

David Humphrey (10)

     —           —          —           —          —     

Executive Officers and Directors as a Group (10 persons) (11)

     113,460         2.2     1,021,140         2.2     79,206   

 

* Less than 1%
(1) A “beneficial owner” of a security is determined in accordance with Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act and generally means any person who, directly or indirectly, through any contract, arrangement, understanding, relationship, or otherwise, has or shares:

 

   

voting power which includes the power to vote, or to direct the voting of, such security; and/or

 

   

investment power which includes the power to dispose, or to direct the disposition of, such security.

Unless otherwise indicated, each person named in the table above has sole voting and investment power, or shares voting and investment power with his spouse (as applicable), with respect to all shares of stock listed as owned by that person. Shares issuable upon the exercise of options exercisable on March 31, 2012 or within 60 days thereafter are considered outstanding and to be beneficially owned by the person holding such options for the purpose of computing such person’s percentage beneficial ownership, but are not deemed outstanding for the purposes of computing the percentage of beneficial ownership of any other person. The address of our named executive officers and Mr. Margolis is c/o Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, 1830 Route 130 North, Burlington, New Jersey 08016.

 

124


Table of Contents
(2) Includes shares beneficially owned, and with respect to which sole power to vote and sole power of disposition are held, by each of Bain Capital Integral Investors, LLC (Integral), Bain Capital Fund IX, LLC (Fund IX), BCIP TCV, LLC (BCIP TCV) and BCIP Associates – G (BCIP-G) as follows:

 

Name of Fund    Class L
Stock
     Class A
Stock
 

Integral

     2,523,111         23,077,824   

Fund IX

     2,361,567         21,254,078   

BCIP TCV

     58,596         157,560   

BCIP-G

     1,170         10,534   

Bain Capital Fund IX, L.P. (“Fund IX LP”) is the sole member of Fund IX. Bain Capital Partners IX, L.P. (“Partners IX”) is the general partner of Fund IX LP. Bain Capital Investors, LLC (“BCI”) is the administrative member of each of Integral and BCIP TCV, the managing partner of BCIP-G, and the general partner of Partners IX. BCI, by virtue of the relationships described above, may be deemed to beneficially own the shares held by Integral, BCIP TCV, and BCIP-G. BCI disclaims beneficial ownership of such shares except to the extent of its pecuniary interest therein. Fund IX LP, Partners IX, and BCI, by virtue of the relationships described above, may be deemed to beneficially own the shares held by Fund IX LLC. Fund IX LP, Partners IX, and BCI disclaim beneficial ownership of such shares except to the extent of their pecuniary interest therein. The address of each entity referenced in this footnote is John Hancock Tower, 200 Clarendon Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02116.

 

(3) Mr. Margolis’ Class L Stock is comprised of 799 shares purchased in connection with an option exercise on December 22, 2011. Mr. Margolis’ Class A Stock is comprised of 7,191 shares purchased in connection with an option exercise on December 22, 2011.
(4) Mr. Weyhrich’s Class L Stock is comprised of (i) 4,444 shares that were granted to Mr. Weyhrich on April 24, 2009, (ii) 7,998 shares purchased in connection with an option exercise on January 13, 2012; (iii) vested options to purchase 5,333 shares; and (iv) options to purchase 1,334 shares that will vest on April 24, 2012. Mr. Weyhrich’s Class A Stock is comprised of (i) 39,996 shares that were granted to Mr. Weyhrich on April 24, 2009, (ii) 71,982 shares purchased in connection with an option exercise on January 13, 2012; (iii) vested options to purchase 47,997 shares; and (iv) options to purchase 12,006 shares that will vest on April 24, 2012.
(5) Ms. Magrini’s Class L Stock is comprised of vested options to purchase 3,999 shares. Mr. Ms. Magrini’s Class A Stock is comprised of vested options to purchase 35,991 shares.
(6) Mr. Kingsbury’s Class L Stock is comprised of (i) 7,500 shares that were granted to Mr. Kingsbury on December 2, 2008; (ii) 3,611 shares that were granted to Mr. Kingsbury on April 24, 2009; (iii) 25,000 shares purchased in connection with an option exercise on January 13, 2012; (iv) vested options to purchase 30,000 shares; and (v) options to purchase 5,000 shares that will vest on April 24, 2012. Mr. Kingsbury’s Class A Stock is comprised of (i) 67,500 shares that were granted to Mr. Kingsbury on December 2, 2008; (ii) 32,499 shares that were granted to Mr. Kingsbury on April 24, 2009; (iii) 225,000 shares purchased in connection with an option exercise on January 13, 2012; (iv) vested options to purchase 270,000 shares; and (v) options to purchase 45,000 shares that will vest on April 24, 2012.
(7) Mr. Hand’s Class L Stock is comprised of (i) 5,111 shares that were granted to Mr. Hand on April 24, 2009; (ii) 1,333 shares purchased in connection with an option exercise on January 12, 2012; (iii) vested options to purchase 9,331 shares; (iv) options to purchase 2,000 shares that will vest on April 13, 2012; and (v) options to purchase 667 shares that will vest on April 24, 2012. Mr. Hand’s Class A Stock is comprised of (i) 45,999 shares that were granted to Mr. Hand on April 24, 2009; (ii) 11,997 shares purchased in connection with an option exercise on January 12, 2012; (iii) vested options to purchase 83,979 shares; (iv) options to purchase 18,000 shares that will vest on April 13, 2012; and (v) options to purchase 6,003 shares that will vest on April 24, 2012.
(8) Mr. Sichel received options to purchase 10,000 units under the Incentive Plan on June 9, 2011 in connection with the commencement of his employment. These options vest 40% on June 9, 2013, 20% on June 9, 2014, 20% on June 9, 2015 and 20% on June 9, 2016.
(9) Messrs. Bekenstein, Hitch and Verdi are managing directors of BCI and, accordingly, may be deemed to beneficially own the shares owned by BCI. Messrs. Bekenstein, Hitch and Verdi disclaim beneficial ownership of such shares except to the extent of their pecuniary interest therein. The address of Messrs. Bekenstein, Hitch and Verdi is c/o Bain Capital Partners, LLC, John Hancock Tower, 200 Clarendon Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02116.

 

125


Table of Contents
(10) David Humphrey is a general partner, and BCI is the managing partner, of each of BCIP Associates III (“BCIP III”), BCIP Associates III-B (“BCIP III-B”), BCIP Trust Associates III (“BCIP Trust III”) and BCIP Trust Associates III-B (“BCIP Trust III-B”), and accordingly Mr. Humphrey may be deemed to beneficially own the shares owned by BCIP Associates III, LLC (“BCIP III LLC”), BCIP Associates III-B, LLC (“BCIP III-B LLC”), BCIP T Associates III, LLC (“BCIP T III LLC”) and BCIP T Associates III-B, LLC (“BCIP T III-B LLC”).

BCIP III LLC may be deemed to hold 1,107,809 shares of Class A Stock and 79,985 shares of Class L Stock by virtue of its membership in Integral. BCIP III is the sole member of BCIP III LLC. BCIP III-B LLC may be deemed to hold 60,481 shares of Class A Stock and 8,736 shares of Class L Stock by virtue of its membership in Integral. BCIP III-B is the sole member of BCIP III-B LLC. BCIP T III LLC may be deemed to hold 129,086 shares of Class A Stock and 57,449 shares of Class L Stock by virtue of its membership in BCIP TCV. BCIP Trust III is the sole member of BCIP T III LLC. BCIP T III-B LLC may be deemed to hold 28,474 shares of Class A Stock and 1,147 shares of Class L Stock by virtue of its membership in BCIP TCV. BCIP Trust III-B is the sole member of BCIP T III-B LLC.

Mr. Humphrey disclaims beneficial ownership of such shares except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein. The address of Mr. Humphrey, as well as each of the entities referenced in this footnote, is c/o Bain Capital Partners, LLC, John Hancock Tower, 200 Clarendon Street, Boston, Massachusetts, 02116.

 

(11) Includes our current directors (Messrs. Kingsbury, Margolis, Bekenstein, Hitch, Humphrey and Verdi) and our current executive officers (Ms. Magrini and Messrs. Kingsbury, Weyhrich, Hand, and Sichel).

Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans

The following table sets forth, as of January 28, 2012, information concerning equity compensation plans under which Parent’s securities are authorized for issuance. The table does not reflect grants, awards, exercises, terminations or expirations since that date.

 

Plan Category

   (A)
Number of
Securities to
be

Issued Upon
Exercise of
Outstanding
Options,
Warrants

and Rights
    (B)
Weighted
Average

Exercise
Price of

Outstanding
Options,

Warrants
and Rights
     (C)
Number of
Securities

Remaining
Available

for Future
Issuance

under Equity
Compensation
Plans

(excluding
securities

reflected
in column (A))
 

Equity Compensation Plans Approved by Security Holders

     (1   $ 69.86         (2

Equity Compensation Plans Not Approved by Security Holders

     —          —           —     

Total

     (1   $ 69.86         (2

 

(1) As of January 28, 2012, 4,254,057 shares of Class A Stock and 472,673 shares of Class L Stock were issuable pursuant to outstanding options under our Incentive Plan.
(2) As of January 28, 2012, 554,670 shares of Class A Stock and 61,630 shares of Class L Stock may be issued pursuant to future issuances under our Incentive Plan.

 

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

2006 Management Incentive Plan

In connection with the Merger Transaction, Holdings adopted the Incentive Plan, which provides for grants of awards to designated employees subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Incentive Plan. 730,478 shares of Class L stock and 6,574,302 shares of Class A stock are currently reserved for issuance under the Incentive Plan.

 

126


Table of Contents

Stockholders Agreement

In connection with the Merger Transaction, Parent entered into the Stockholders Agreement with its stockholders, including funds associated with Bain Capital, which among other things establishes the composition of our Board of Directors (as discussed in further detail in Item 10, Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance, under the caption entitled “Governance of the Company”), provides certain restrictions and rights with respect to sale and issuance of Parent’s common stock and provides for limited approval rights in favor of Bain Capital. In particular, the Stockholders Agreement provides that no stockholder may transfer his or her common stock except to permitted transferees and except in compliance with certain restrictions on transfer. Parent’s stockholders have the right to sell a pro rata portion of their common stock if funds associated with Bain Capital elect to sell all or a portion of its common stock. The holders of a majority of Parent’s outstanding common stock (and in some cases funds associated with Bain Capital acting alone) also have the right to cause a sale of the Company to occur and to require the other holders of our common stock to participate in such a sale. If Parent or any affiliate of Parent proposes to issue new equity securities, each holder of Parent’s common stock will have the right to purchase its pro rata share of such new securities. In addition, under the Stockholders Agreement, funds associated with Bain Capital and other holders of common stock will have the ability to cause Parent to register their shares of common stock and to participate in registrations by us of Holdings’ or any other affiliate’s common stock. We will be responsible for paying expenses of holders of Parent’s common stock in connection with any such registration.

Advisory Agreement

In connection with the Merger Transaction, we entered into an advisory agreement with Bain Capital pursuant to which Bain Capital provides us with management and consulting services and financial and other advisory services. Pursuant to the agreement, we pay Bain Capital a periodic fee of $1 million per fiscal quarter plus reimbursement for reasonable out-of-pocket fees, and a fee equal to 1% of the transaction value of each financing, acquisition, disposition or change of control or similar transaction by or involving us. Bain Capital received a fee of approximately $21 million in consideration for financial advisory services related to the Merger Transaction. The advisory agreement has a 10-year initial term, and thereafter is subject to automatic one-year extensions unless we or Bain Capital provides written notice of termination, except that the agreement terminates automatically upon an initial public offering or a change of control. If the agreement is terminated early, then Bain Capital will be entitled to receive all unpaid fees and unreimbursed out-of-pocket fees and expenses, as well as the present value of the periodic fee that would otherwise have been payable through the end of the term. The agreement includes customary indemnities in favor of Bain Capital.

Merchandise Purchases

Jim Magrini, brother-in-law of Ms. Magrini, is an independent sales representative of one of our suppliers of merchandise inventory. This relationship predated the commencement of Ms. Magrini’s employment with us. We have determined that the dollar amount of purchases through such supplier represents an insignificant amount of our inventory purchases.

Indemnification

The Merger Agreement provides that, after the Merger, Parent and BCFWC will, jointly and severally, and Parent will cause BCFWC to, indemnify and hold harmless the individuals who are now, or have been at any time prior to the execution of the Merger Agreement or who become such prior to the effective time of the Merger, our directors or officers or any of our subsidiaries, or our employees or any of its subsidiaries providing services to or for such a director or officer in connection with the Merger Agreement or any of the transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement, against costs and liabilities incurred in connection with any pending, threatened or completed claim, action, suit, proceeding or investigation arising out of or pertaining to (i) the fact that such individual is or was an officer, director, employee, fiduciary or agent of BCFWC or any of its subsidiaries, or (ii) matters occurring or existing at or prior to the effective time of the Merger (including acts or omissions occurring in connection with the Merger Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereby), whether asserted or claimed prior to, at or after the effective time of the Merger.

The Merger Agreement provides that we will provide, for a period of six years after the Merger becomes effective, directors’ and officers’ liability insurance for the benefit of those persons covered under our officers’ and directors’ liability insurance policy on terms with respect to coverage and amounts no less favorable than those of the policy in effect as of the execution of the Merger Agreement, provided that, subject to certain exceptions, the surviving corporation will not be obligated to pay premiums in excess of 300% of the annualized policy premium based on a rate as of the execution of the Merger Agreement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, prior to the effective time of the Merger we are permitted to purchase prepaid “tail” policies in favor of such indemnified persons with respect to the matters referred to above (provided that the annual premium for such tail policy may not exceed 300% of the annualized policy premium based on a rate as of the execution of the Merger Agreement), in which case Parent has agreed to maintain such tail policies in effect and continue to honor the obligations under such policies.

 

127


Table of Contents

Parent and BCFWC have also agreed (i) to continue in effect for at least six years after the effective time of the Merger all rights to indemnification existing in favor of, and all exculpations and limitations of the personal liability of, the directors, officers, employees, fiduciaries and agents of BCFWC and its subsidiaries in our certificate of incorporation as of the effective time of the Merger with respect to matters occurring at or prior to the effective time of the Merger and (ii) to honor our indemnification agreements with our directors (including one former director, Harvey Morgan) and with certain officers. Each such indemnification agreement provides, among other things, that we will indemnify such indemnified person to the fullest extent permitted by the Delaware General Corporation Law (DGCL), including advancement of legal fees and other expenses incurred by the indemnified person in connection with any legal proceedings arising out the indemnified person’s service as director and/or officer, subject to certain exclusions and procedures set forth in the indemnification agreement.

In addition, our officers and directors under our Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws are indemnified and held harmless against any and all claims alleged against any of them in their official capacities to the fullest extent authorized by the DGCL as it exists today or as it may be amended but only to the extent that such amendment permits the Company to provide broader indemnification rights than previously permitted.

Review, Approval or Ratification of Transactions with Related Persons

Under our Code of Business Conduct, which was approved by our Board of Directors, employees are asked to avoid potential, or the appearance of, conflicts of interest, and if the avoidance of such conflict of interest is not possible, then the employee is required to make full written disclosure of the proposed transaction for review by the employee’s immediate supervisor who should in turn bring it to the attention of our Corporate Compliance Officer in appropriate circumstances. Our Code of Business Conduct specifically discusses standards applicable to certain prohibited conflicts of interest including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

Employment by, directorship with or financial interests in any competitor, customer, distributor, vendor, or supplier where such employment, directorship or financial interest would influence, or appear to influence, action on our behalf;

 

   

Loans to, and guarantees of obligations of, employees or directors incurred for personal reasons;

 

   

Supervision, review or influence on the job evaluation or salary of persons with whom employees have a family or close relationship;

 

   

Dealings with businesses which provide or seek to provide goods or services to us in which immediate family members or close relationships of employees have an ownership interest in or work in a managerial or executive capacity for;

 

   

Dealings with charitable or community organizations in individual capacities rather than our behalf;

 

   

Solicitation or distribution activities not relating to our business;

 

   

Lobbying activities (or even the appearance of lobbying any governmental body or public official) as our representative;

 

   

Appropriation of the benefit of certain business ventures, opportunities or potential opportunities; and

 

   

Acceptance of gifts and commercial bribery.

Director Independence

Although we do not currently have securities listed on a national securities exchange or on an inter-dealer quotation system, prior to the Merger Transaction our Board of Directors utilized director independence standards designed to satisfy the corporate governance requirements of the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) when determining whether or not members of our Board of Directors were independent. Under such standards, none of the current members of our Board of Directors other than Mr. Margolis would be considered independent. In making this determination, our Board of Directors did not consider any related party transactions that are not described in this Item 13.

Under NYSE rules, we are considered a “controlled company” because more than 50% of Parent’s voting power is held by affiliates of Bain Capital. Accordingly, even if we were a listed company, we would not be required by NYSE rules to maintain a majority of independent directors on our Board of Directors, nor would we be required to maintain a compensation committee or a nominating/corporate governance committee comprised entirely of independent directors. We do not maintain a nominating/corporate governance committee and our compensation committee does not include any independent directors.

 

128


Table of Contents
Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services

Fees Paid to the Principal Accountant

The following table sets forth the aggregate fees billed to us by Deloitte & Touche LLP (D&T), the member firms of Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu and their respective affiliates, our independent registered public accounting firm, for Fiscal 2011, Fiscal 2010 and the transition period ended January 30, 2010:

 

    

Fiscal Year
Ended

January 28,

2012

    

Fiscal Year
Ended

January 29,

2011

    

Transition
Period
Ended

January 30,
2010

 

Audit Fees (1)

   $  1,648,000         1,991,000         1,733,000   

Audit-Related Fees (2)

   $  1,015,000         317,000         95,000   

Tax Fees (3)

   $  630,000         652,000         650,000   

Total

   $  3,293,000         2,960,000         2,378,000   

 

(1) Audit Fees – represents aggregate fees for the audit of our annual financial statements and review of our interim financial statements.
(2) Audit-Related Fees – represents fees for services that are normally provided by our independent registered public accounting firm in connection with statutory and regulatory filings.
(3) Tax Fees – represents fees incurred in connection with a strategic tax review, the filing of tax returns, and other tax consulting services.

Audit Committee Pre-Approval of Audit and Permissible Non-Audit Services of Independent Auditors

In accordance with its charter, the Audit Committee of our Board of Directors must pre-approve all audit and permissible non-audit services to be provided by D&T. In its review of non-audit service fees, the Audit Committee considers, among other things, the possible effect of the performance of such services on the independence of D&T. All services provided by D&T during the fiscal year ended January 28, 2012, the fiscal year ended January 29, 2011, and the transition period ended January 30, 2010 were pre-approved by the Audit Committee.

PART IV

 

Item 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

 

(a) Documents Filed as Part of this Report

(1) Financial Statements. The consolidated financial statements filed as part of this Report are listed on the Index to Consolidated Financial Statements on page [52] of this Report.

(2) Financial Statement Schedules. Schedule II – Valuation and Qualifying Accounts filed as part of this Report is set forth on page [102] of this Report. All other financial statement schedules have been omitted here because they are not applicable, not required, or the information is shown in the consolidated financial statements or notes thereto.

 

129


Table of Contents

(3) Exhibits Required by Item 601 of Regulation S-KSee Item 15(b) below.

 

(b) Exhibits Required by Item 601 of Regulation S-K

The following is a list of exhibits required by Item 601 of Regulation S-K and filed as part of this Report. Exhibits that previously have been filed are incorporated herein by reference.

 

EXHIBIT

NUMBER

  DESCRIPTION
    1.1 (10)   Purchase Agreement, dated February 17, 2011, among Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, the guarantors signatory thereto, Goldman, Sachs & Co., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporation and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC.
    2.1 (1)   Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of January 18, 2006, by and among Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, BCFWC Acquisition, Inc. and BCFWC Mergersub, Inc.
    3.1 (11)   Certificate of Incorporation of Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc.
    3.2 (1)   By-laws of Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc.
    4.1 (10)   Indenture, dated February 24, 2011, among Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, the guarantors signatory thereto and Wilmington Trust FSB.
    4.2 (10)   Form of 10.000% Senior Notes due 2019 (included in Exhibit 4.1).
  10.1 (10)   Registration Rights Agreement, dated February 24, 2011, among Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, the guarantors signatory thereto, Goldman, Sachs & Co., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporation and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC.
  10.2 (10)   Credit Agreement, dated February 24, 2011, among Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc., the facility guarantors signatory thereto, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent and as collateral agent, the lenders party thereto, J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Goldman Sachs Lending Partners LLC, as joint bookrunners and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Goldman Sachs Lending Partners LLC, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, as joint arrangers.
  10.3 (10)   First Amendment, dated February 24, 2011, to the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of January 15, 2010, among Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, as Lead Borrower, the Borrowers and the Facility Guarantors party thereto, Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent and as Collateral Agent, the Lenders party thereto, Wells Fargo Retail Finance, LLC and Regions Bank, as Co-Syndication Agent, J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. and UBS Securities LLC, as Co-Documentation Agents and General Electric Capital Corporation, US Bank, National Association and Suntrust Bank as Senior Managing Agents.
  10.4 (12)   Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of September 2, 2011, among Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, as Lead Borrower, the Borrowers and the Facility Guarantors party thereto, Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent and as Collateral Agent, the Lenders party thereto, Wells Fargo Capital Finance, LLC and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as co-syndication agents, and Suntrust Bank and U.S. Bank, National Association, as co-documentation agents.
  10.5 (1)   Revolving Credit Note, dated as of April 13, 2006, by the Borrowers party thereto in favor of PNC Bank, National Association.
  10.6 (1)   Revolving Credit Note, dated as of April 13, 2006, by the Borrowers party thereto in favor of Siemens Financial Services, Inc.
  10.7 (8)  

Amended and Restated Revolving Credit Note, dated January 15, 2010, by the Borrowers party thereto

in favor of Wells Fargo Retail Finance, LLC.

  10.8 (1)   Revolving Credit Note, dated as of April 13, 2006, by the Borrowers party thereto in favor of National City Business Credit, Inc.
  10.9 (1)   Revolving Credit Note, dated as of April 13, 2006, by the Borrowers party thereto in favor of Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania.

 

130


Table of Contents
  10.10 (1)   Revolving Credit Note, dated as of April 13, 2006, by the Borrowers party thereto in favor of HSBC Business Credit (USA), Inc.
  10.11 (1)   Revolving Credit Note, dated as of April 13, 2006, by the Borrowers party thereto in favor of Sovereign Bank.
  10.12 (8)  

Amended and Restated Revolving Credit Note, dated January 15, 2010, by the Borrowers party thereto

in favor of Capital One Leverage Finance Corp.

  10.13 (1)   Form of Swingline Note.
  10.14 (1)   Guaranty, dated as of April 13, 2006, by the Facility Guarantors party thereto in favor of Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent and Bank of America, N.A., as Collateral Agent.
  10.15 (1)   Security Agreement, dated as of April 13, 2006, by and among each of the Borrowers party thereto, each of the Facility Guarantors party thereto, and Bank of America, N.A., as Collateral Agent.
  10.16 (1)   Intellectual Property Security Agreement, dated as of April 13, 2006, by and among each of the Borrowers party thereto, each of the Facility Guarantors party thereto, and Bank of America, N.A., as Collateral Agent.
  10.17 (1)   Pledge Agreement, dated as of April 13, 2006, by and between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc., Burlington Coat Factory Investments Holdings, Inc., Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, Burlington Coat Factory Realty Corp., Burlington Coat Factory Purchasing, Inc., K&T Acquisition Corp., Burlington Coat Factory of New York, LLC, Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse of Baytown, Inc., Burlington Coat Factory of Texas, Inc., as the Pledgors, and Bank of America, N.A., as Collateral Agent.
  10.18* (8)   Employment Agreement, dated as of October 13, 2009, by and between Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and Joyce Manning Magrini.
  10.18.1* (8)   Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated February 26, 2010, by and between Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and Joyce Manning Magrini.
  10.19* (2)   Employment Agreement, dated as of August 16, 2007, by and between Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and Todd Weyhrich.
  10.19.1* (3)   Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated as of June 27, 2008, by and between Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and Todd Weyhrich.
  10.20* (4)   Employment Agreement, dated as of December 2, 2008, by and among Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation, Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc., and Thomas A. Kingsbury.
  10.21*(9)   Employment Agreement, dated as of January 28, 2008, by and between Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and Fred Hand.
  10.22*   Employment Agreement, dated as of May 12, 2011, by and between Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and Hobart P. Sichel.
  10.23* (1)   Form of Restricted Stock Grant Agreement Pursuant to Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. 2006 Management Incentive Plan.
  10.24* (1)   Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement, dated as of April 13, 2006, between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees without Employment Agreements.
  10.25* (1)   Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement, dated as of April 13, 2006, between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees with Employment Agreements.
  10.26* (1)   Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. 2006 Management Incentive Plan.
  10.26.1* (4)   Amendment No. 1 to the Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. Management Incentive Plan dated as of December 2, 2008.
  10.26.2* (5)   Amendment No. 2 to the Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. 2006 Management Incentive Plan dated as of March 19, 2009.
  10.26.3* (7)   Amendment No. 3 to the Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. 2006 Management Incentive Plan dated as of September 14, 2009.

 

131


Table of Contents
  10.27* (5)   Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees with Employment Agreements.
  10.28* (5)   Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees without Employment Agreements.
  10.29* (5)   Form of Restricted Stock Grant Agreement between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees with Employment Agreements.
  10.30* (5)   Form of Restricted Stock Grant Agreement between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees without Employment Agreements.
  10.31* (5)   Form of Initial Amendment to Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees with Employment Agreements.
  10.32* (5)   Form of Initial Amendment to Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees without Employment Agreements.
  10.33* (5)   Form of Subsequent Amendment to Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees with Employment Agreements.
  10.34* (5)   Form of Subsequent Amendment to Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement between Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and Employees without Employment Agreements.
  10.35 (6)   Stockholders Agreement dated as of April 13, 2006 by and among Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc. and the Investors and Managers named therein.
  10.36 (1)   Advisory Agreement, dated as of April 13, 2006, by and among Burlington Coat Factory Holdings, Inc., Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and Bain Capital Partners, LLC.
  12   Statement re: Calculation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.
  21   Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
  31.1   Certification of Principal Executive Officer required by Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  31.2   Certification of Principal Financial Officer required by Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32.1   Certification of Principal Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32.2   Certification of Principal Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
101.INS   XBRL Instance Document
101.SCH   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema
101.CAL  

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase

101.DEF   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase
101.LAB   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase
101.PRE   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase

 

(1) Incorporated by reference to Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, No. 333-137916, filed on October 10, 2006.

 

132


Table of Contents
(2) Incorporated by reference to our Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 17, 2007.
(3) Incorporated by reference to our Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 27, 2008.
(4) Incorporated by reference to our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2009 filed on April 14, 2009.
(5) Incorporated by reference to our Current Report on Form 8-K filed on April 30, 2009.
(6) Incorporated by reference to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended May 30, 2009 filed on August 27, 2009.
(7) Incorporated by reference to our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended November 28, 2009 filed on January 12, 2010.
(8) Incorporated by reference to our Transition Report on Form 10-K/T for the transition period ended January 30, 2010 filed on April 30, 2010.
(9) Incorporated by reference to our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 1, 2008 filed on April 15, 2008.
(10) Incorporated by reference to our Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 24, 2011.
(11) Incorporated by reference to our Registration Statement on Form S-4, No. 333-175594, filed on July 15, 2011.
(12) Incorporated by reference to our Current Report on Form 8-K filed on September 9, 2011.
* Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Arrangement.

 

(c) Financial Statement Schedules

None.

 

133


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

BURLINGTON COAT FACTORY INVESTMENTS HOLDINGS, INC.
By:  

/s/    Thomas A. Kingsbury        

 

Thomas A. Kingsbury

President and Chief Executive Officer

Date: April 20, 2012

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated on the 20th day of April 2012.

 

Signature

  

Title

/s/ Thomas A. Kingsbury

Thomas A. Kingsbury

  

President and Chief Executive Officer and Director (Principal Executive Officer)

/s/ Todd Weyhrich

Todd Weyhrich

  

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer)

/s/ John Crimmins

John Crimmins

  

Senior Vice President and Chief Accounting Officer (Principal Accounting Officer)

/s/ Joshua Bekenstein

Joshua Bekenstein

   Director

/s/ Jordan Hitch

Jordan Hitch

   Director

/s/ David Humphrey

David Humphrey

   Director

/s/ Mark Verdi

Mark Verdi

   Director

/s/ Jay Margolis

Jay Margolis

   Director

 

134


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

Exhibit

  

Description

  10.22    Employment Agreement, dated as of May 12, 2011, by and between Burlington Coat Factory Warehouse Corporation and Hobart P. Sichel.
  12    Statement re: Calculation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.
  21    Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
  31.1    Certification of Principal Executive Officer required by Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  31.2    Certification of Principal Financial Officer required by Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32.1    Certification of Principal Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32.2    Certification of Principal Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
101.INS    XBRL Instance Document
101.SCH    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema
101.CAL    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase
101.DEF    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase
101.LAB    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase
101.PRE    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase

 

135